OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/open8_urisc/open8_urisc/trunk

Subversion Repositories open8_urisc

[/] [open8_urisc/] [trunk/] [gnu/] [binutils/] [gas/] [config/] [tc-ia64.c] - Blame information for rev 72

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 16 khays
/* tc-ia64.c -- Assembler for the HP/Intel IA-64 architecture.
2
   Copyright 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
3
   2008, 2009, 2011   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
   Contributed by David Mosberger-Tang <davidm@hpl.hp.com>
5
 
6
   This file is part of GAS, the GNU Assembler.
7
 
8
   GAS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9
   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10
   the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
11
   any later version.
12
 
13
   GAS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14
   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15
   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
16
   GNU General Public License for more details.
17
 
18
   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19
   along with GAS; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to
20
   the Free Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
21
   Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
22
 
23
/*
24
  TODO:
25
 
26
  - optional operands
27
  - directives:
28
        .eb
29
        .estate
30
        .lb
31
        .popsection
32
        .previous
33
        .psr
34
        .pushsection
35
  - labels are wrong if automatic alignment is introduced
36
    (e.g., checkout the second real10 definition in test-data.s)
37
  - DV-related stuff:
38
        <reg>.safe_across_calls and any other DV-related directives I don't
39
          have documentation for.
40
        verify mod-sched-brs reads/writes are checked/marked (and other
41
        notes)
42
 
43
 */
44
 
45
#include "as.h"
46
#include "safe-ctype.h"
47
#include "dwarf2dbg.h"
48
#include "subsegs.h"
49
 
50
#include "opcode/ia64.h"
51
 
52
#include "elf/ia64.h"
53
#include "bfdver.h"
54
#include <time.h>
55
 
56
#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
57
#include <limits.h>
58
#endif
59
 
60
#define NELEMS(a)       ((int) (sizeof (a)/sizeof ((a)[0])))
61
 
62
/* Some systems define MIN in, e.g., param.h.  */
63
#undef MIN
64
#define MIN(a,b)        ((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b))
65
 
66
#define NUM_SLOTS       4
67
#define PREV_SLOT       md.slot[(md.curr_slot + NUM_SLOTS - 1) % NUM_SLOTS]
68
#define CURR_SLOT       md.slot[md.curr_slot]
69
 
70
#define O_pseudo_fixup (O_max + 1)
71
 
72
enum special_section
73
  {
74
    /* IA-64 ABI section pseudo-ops.  */
75
    SPECIAL_SECTION_BSS = 0,
76
    SPECIAL_SECTION_SBSS,
77
    SPECIAL_SECTION_SDATA,
78
    SPECIAL_SECTION_RODATA,
79
    SPECIAL_SECTION_COMMENT,
80
    SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND,
81
    SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO,
82
    /* HPUX specific section pseudo-ops.  */
83
    SPECIAL_SECTION_INIT_ARRAY,
84
    SPECIAL_SECTION_FINI_ARRAY,
85
  };
86
 
87
enum reloc_func
88
  {
89
    FUNC_DTP_MODULE,
90
    FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE,
91
    FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE,
92
    FUNC_GP_RELATIVE,
93
    FUNC_LT_RELATIVE,
94
    FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X,
95
    FUNC_PC_RELATIVE,
96
    FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE,
97
    FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE,
98
    FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE,
99
    FUNC_TP_RELATIVE,
100
    FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE,
101
    FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE,
102
    FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE,
103
    FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE,
104
    FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE,
105
    FUNC_IPLT_RELOC,
106
#ifdef TE_VMS
107
    FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC,
108
#endif
109
  };
110
 
111
enum reg_symbol
112
  {
113
    REG_GR      = 0,
114
    REG_FR      = (REG_GR + 128),
115
    REG_AR      = (REG_FR + 128),
116
    REG_CR      = (REG_AR + 128),
117
    REG_P       = (REG_CR + 128),
118
    REG_BR      = (REG_P  + 64),
119
    REG_IP      = (REG_BR + 8),
120
    REG_CFM,
121
    REG_PR,
122
    REG_PR_ROT,
123
    REG_PSR,
124
    REG_PSR_L,
125
    REG_PSR_UM,
126
    /* The following are pseudo-registers for use by gas only.  */
127
    IND_CPUID,
128
    IND_DBR,
129
    IND_DTR,
130
    IND_ITR,
131
    IND_IBR,
132
    IND_MSR,
133
    IND_PKR,
134
    IND_PMC,
135
    IND_PMD,
136
    IND_RR,
137
    /* The following pseudo-registers are used for unwind directives only:  */
138
    REG_PSP,
139
    REG_PRIUNAT,
140
    REG_NUM
141
  };
142
 
143
enum dynreg_type
144
  {
145
    DYNREG_GR = 0,       /* dynamic general purpose register */
146
    DYNREG_FR,          /* dynamic floating point register */
147
    DYNREG_PR,          /* dynamic predicate register */
148
    DYNREG_NUM_TYPES
149
  };
150
 
151
enum operand_match_result
152
  {
153
    OPERAND_MATCH,
154
    OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE,
155
    OPERAND_MISMATCH
156
  };
157
 
158
/* On the ia64, we can't know the address of a text label until the
159
   instructions are packed into a bundle.  To handle this, we keep
160
   track of the list of labels that appear in front of each
161
   instruction.  */
162
struct label_fix
163
{
164
  struct label_fix *next;
165
  struct symbol *sym;
166
  bfd_boolean dw2_mark_labels;
167
};
168
 
169
#ifdef TE_VMS
170
/* An internally used relocation.  */
171
#define DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT      (BFD_RELOC_UNUSED + 1)
172
#endif
173
 
174
/* This is the endianness of the current section.  */
175
extern int target_big_endian;
176
 
177
/* This is the default endianness.  */
178
static int default_big_endian = TARGET_BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN;
179
 
180
void (*ia64_number_to_chars) (char *, valueT, int);
181
 
182
static void ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian (char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int);
183
static void ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian (char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int);
184
 
185
static void (*ia64_float_to_chars) (char *, LITTLENUM_TYPE *, int);
186
 
187
static struct hash_control *alias_hash;
188
static struct hash_control *alias_name_hash;
189
static struct hash_control *secalias_hash;
190
static struct hash_control *secalias_name_hash;
191
 
192
/* List of chars besides those in app.c:symbol_chars that can start an
193
   operand.  Used to prevent the scrubber eating vital white-space.  */
194
const char ia64_symbol_chars[] = "@?";
195
 
196
/* Characters which always start a comment.  */
197
const char comment_chars[] = "";
198
 
199
/* Characters which start a comment at the beginning of a line.  */
200
const char line_comment_chars[] = "#";
201
 
202
/* Characters which may be used to separate multiple commands on a
203
   single line.  */
204
const char line_separator_chars[] = ";{}";
205
 
206
/* Characters which are used to indicate an exponent in a floating
207
   point number.  */
208
const char EXP_CHARS[] = "eE";
209
 
210
/* Characters which mean that a number is a floating point constant,
211
   as in 0d1.0.  */
212
const char FLT_CHARS[] = "rRsSfFdDxXpP";
213
 
214
/* ia64-specific option processing:  */
215
 
216
const char *md_shortopts = "m:N:x::";
217
 
218
struct option md_longopts[] =
219
  {
220
#define OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP (OPTION_MD_BASE + 1)
221
    {"mconstant-gp", no_argument, NULL, OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP},
222
#define OPTION_MAUTO_PIC (OPTION_MD_BASE + 2)
223
    {"mauto-pic", no_argument, NULL, OPTION_MAUTO_PIC}
224
  };
225
 
226
size_t md_longopts_size = sizeof (md_longopts);
227
 
228
static struct
229
  {
230
    struct hash_control *pseudo_hash;   /* pseudo opcode hash table */
231
    struct hash_control *reg_hash;      /* register name hash table */
232
    struct hash_control *dynreg_hash;   /* dynamic register hash table */
233
    struct hash_control *const_hash;    /* constant hash table */
234
    struct hash_control *entry_hash;    /* code entry hint hash table */
235
 
236
    /* If X_op is != O_absent, the registername for the instruction's
237
       qualifying predicate.  If NULL, p0 is assumed for instructions
238
       that are predictable.  */
239
    expressionS qp;
240
 
241
    /* Optimize for which CPU.  */
242
    enum
243
      {
244
        itanium1,
245
        itanium2
246
      } tune;
247
 
248
    /* What to do when hint.b is used.  */
249
    enum
250
      {
251
        hint_b_error,
252
        hint_b_warning,
253
        hint_b_ok
254
      } hint_b;
255
 
256
    unsigned int
257
      manual_bundling : 1,
258
      debug_dv: 1,
259
      detect_dv: 1,
260
      explicit_mode : 1,            /* which mode we're in */
261
      default_explicit_mode : 1,    /* which mode is the default */
262
      mode_explicitly_set : 1,      /* was the current mode explicitly set? */
263
      auto_align : 1,
264
      keep_pending_output : 1;
265
 
266
    /* What to do when something is wrong with unwind directives.  */
267
    enum
268
      {
269
        unwind_check_warning,
270
        unwind_check_error
271
      } unwind_check;
272
 
273
    /* Each bundle consists of up to three instructions.  We keep
274
       track of four most recent instructions so we can correctly set
275
       the end_of_insn_group for the last instruction in a bundle.  */
276
    int curr_slot;
277
    int num_slots_in_use;
278
    struct slot
279
      {
280
        unsigned int
281
          end_of_insn_group : 1,
282
          manual_bundling_on : 1,
283
          manual_bundling_off : 1,
284
          loc_directive_seen : 1;
285
        signed char user_template;      /* user-selected template, if any */
286
        unsigned char qp_regno;         /* qualifying predicate */
287
        /* This duplicates a good fraction of "struct fix" but we
288
           can't use a "struct fix" instead since we can't call
289
           fix_new_exp() until we know the address of the instruction.  */
290
        int num_fixups;
291
        struct insn_fix
292
          {
293
            bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
294
            enum ia64_opnd opnd;        /* type of operand in need of fix */
295
            unsigned int is_pcrel : 1;  /* is operand pc-relative? */
296
            expressionS expr;           /* the value to be inserted */
297
          }
298
        fixup[2];                       /* at most two fixups per insn */
299
        struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
300
        struct label_fix *label_fixups;
301
        struct label_fix *tag_fixups;
302
        struct unw_rec_list *unwind_record;     /* Unwind directive.  */
303
        expressionS opnd[6];
304
        char *src_file;
305
        unsigned int src_line;
306
        struct dwarf2_line_info debug_line;
307
      }
308
    slot[NUM_SLOTS];
309
 
310
    segT last_text_seg;
311
 
312
    struct dynreg
313
      {
314
        struct dynreg *next;            /* next dynamic register */
315
        const char *name;
316
        unsigned short base;            /* the base register number */
317
        unsigned short num_regs;        /* # of registers in this set */
318
      }
319
    *dynreg[DYNREG_NUM_TYPES], in, loc, out, rot;
320
 
321
    flagword flags;                     /* ELF-header flags */
322
 
323
    struct mem_offset {
324
      unsigned hint:1;              /* is this hint currently valid? */
325
      bfd_vma offset;               /* mem.offset offset */
326
      bfd_vma base;                 /* mem.offset base */
327
    } mem_offset;
328
 
329
    int path;                       /* number of alt. entry points seen */
330
    const char **entry_labels;      /* labels of all alternate paths in
331
                                       the current DV-checking block.  */
332
    int maxpaths;                   /* size currently allocated for
333
                                       entry_labels */
334
 
335
    int pointer_size;       /* size in bytes of a pointer */
336
    int pointer_size_shift; /* shift size of a pointer for alignment */
337
 
338
    symbolS *indregsym[IND_RR - IND_CPUID + 1];
339
  }
340
md;
341
 
342
/* These are not const, because they are modified to MMI for non-itanium1
343
   targets below.  */
344
/* MFI bundle of nops.  */
345
static unsigned char le_nop[16] =
346
{
347
  0x0c, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,
348
  0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x00
349
};
350
/* MFI bundle of nops with stop-bit.  */
351
static unsigned char le_nop_stop[16] =
352
{
353
  0x0d, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x01, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00,
354
  0x00, 0x02, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x00, 0x04, 0x00
355
};
356
 
357
/* application registers:  */
358
 
359
#define AR_K0           0
360
#define AR_K7           7
361
#define AR_RSC          16
362
#define AR_BSP          17
363
#define AR_BSPSTORE     18
364
#define AR_RNAT         19
365
#define AR_FCR          21
366
#define AR_EFLAG        24
367
#define AR_CSD          25
368
#define AR_SSD          26
369
#define AR_CFLG         27
370
#define AR_FSR          28
371
#define AR_FIR          29
372
#define AR_FDR          30
373
#define AR_CCV          32
374
#define AR_UNAT         36
375
#define AR_FPSR         40
376
#define AR_ITC          44
377
#define AR_RUC          45
378
#define AR_PFS          64
379
#define AR_LC           65
380
#define AR_EC           66
381
 
382
static const struct
383
  {
384
    const char *name;
385
    unsigned int regnum;
386
  }
387
ar[] =
388
  {
389
    {"ar.k0",           AR_K0},         {"ar.k1",       AR_K0 + 1},
390
    {"ar.k2",           AR_K0 + 2},     {"ar.k3",       AR_K0 + 3},
391
    {"ar.k4",           AR_K0 + 4},     {"ar.k5",       AR_K0 + 5},
392
    {"ar.k6",           AR_K0 + 6},     {"ar.k7",       AR_K7},
393
    {"ar.rsc",          AR_RSC},        {"ar.bsp",      AR_BSP},
394
    {"ar.bspstore",     AR_BSPSTORE},   {"ar.rnat",     AR_RNAT},
395
    {"ar.fcr",          AR_FCR},        {"ar.eflag",    AR_EFLAG},
396
    {"ar.csd",          AR_CSD},        {"ar.ssd",      AR_SSD},
397
    {"ar.cflg",         AR_CFLG},       {"ar.fsr",      AR_FSR},
398
    {"ar.fir",          AR_FIR},        {"ar.fdr",      AR_FDR},
399
    {"ar.ccv",          AR_CCV},        {"ar.unat",     AR_UNAT},
400
    {"ar.fpsr",         AR_FPSR},       {"ar.itc",      AR_ITC},
401
    {"ar.ruc",          AR_RUC},        {"ar.pfs",      AR_PFS},
402
    {"ar.lc",           AR_LC},         {"ar.ec",       AR_EC},
403
  };
404
 
405
/* control registers:  */
406
 
407
#define CR_DCR           0
408
#define CR_ITM           1
409
#define CR_IVA           2
410
#define CR_PTA           8
411
#define CR_GPTA          9
412
#define CR_IPSR         16
413
#define CR_ISR          17
414
#define CR_IIP          19
415
#define CR_IFA          20
416
#define CR_ITIR         21
417
#define CR_IIPA         22
418
#define CR_IFS          23
419
#define CR_IIM          24
420
#define CR_IHA          25
421
#define CR_IIB0         26
422
#define CR_IIB1         27
423
#define CR_LID          64
424
#define CR_IVR          65
425
#define CR_TPR          66
426
#define CR_EOI          67
427
#define CR_IRR0         68
428
#define CR_IRR3         71
429
#define CR_ITV          72
430
#define CR_PMV          73
431
#define CR_CMCV         74
432
#define CR_LRR0         80
433
#define CR_LRR1         81
434
 
435
static const struct
436
  {
437
    const char *name;
438
    unsigned int regnum;
439
  }
440
cr[] =
441
  {
442
    {"cr.dcr",  CR_DCR},
443
    {"cr.itm",  CR_ITM},
444
    {"cr.iva",  CR_IVA},
445
    {"cr.pta",  CR_PTA},
446
    {"cr.gpta", CR_GPTA},
447
    {"cr.ipsr", CR_IPSR},
448
    {"cr.isr",  CR_ISR},
449
    {"cr.iip",  CR_IIP},
450
    {"cr.ifa",  CR_IFA},
451
    {"cr.itir", CR_ITIR},
452
    {"cr.iipa", CR_IIPA},
453
    {"cr.ifs",  CR_IFS},
454
    {"cr.iim",  CR_IIM},
455
    {"cr.iha",  CR_IHA},
456
    {"cr.iib0", CR_IIB0},
457
    {"cr.iib1", CR_IIB1},
458
    {"cr.lid",  CR_LID},
459
    {"cr.ivr",  CR_IVR},
460
    {"cr.tpr",  CR_TPR},
461
    {"cr.eoi",  CR_EOI},
462
    {"cr.irr0", CR_IRR0},
463
    {"cr.irr1", CR_IRR0 + 1},
464
    {"cr.irr2", CR_IRR0 + 2},
465
    {"cr.irr3", CR_IRR3},
466
    {"cr.itv",  CR_ITV},
467
    {"cr.pmv",  CR_PMV},
468
    {"cr.cmcv", CR_CMCV},
469
    {"cr.lrr0", CR_LRR0},
470
    {"cr.lrr1", CR_LRR1}
471
  };
472
 
473
#define PSR_MFL         4
474
#define PSR_IC          13
475
#define PSR_DFL         18
476
#define PSR_CPL         32
477
 
478
static const struct const_desc
479
  {
480
    const char *name;
481
    valueT value;
482
  }
483
const_bits[] =
484
  {
485
    /* PSR constant masks:  */
486
 
487
    /* 0: reserved */
488
    {"psr.be",  ((valueT) 1) << 1},
489
    {"psr.up",  ((valueT) 1) << 2},
490
    {"psr.ac",  ((valueT) 1) << 3},
491
    {"psr.mfl", ((valueT) 1) << 4},
492
    {"psr.mfh", ((valueT) 1) << 5},
493
    /* 6-12: reserved */
494
    {"psr.ic",  ((valueT) 1) << 13},
495
    {"psr.i",   ((valueT) 1) << 14},
496
    {"psr.pk",  ((valueT) 1) << 15},
497
    /* 16: reserved */
498
    {"psr.dt",  ((valueT) 1) << 17},
499
    {"psr.dfl", ((valueT) 1) << 18},
500
    {"psr.dfh", ((valueT) 1) << 19},
501
    {"psr.sp",  ((valueT) 1) << 20},
502
    {"psr.pp",  ((valueT) 1) << 21},
503
    {"psr.di",  ((valueT) 1) << 22},
504
    {"psr.si",  ((valueT) 1) << 23},
505
    {"psr.db",  ((valueT) 1) << 24},
506
    {"psr.lp",  ((valueT) 1) << 25},
507
    {"psr.tb",  ((valueT) 1) << 26},
508
    {"psr.rt",  ((valueT) 1) << 27},
509
    /* 28-31: reserved */
510
    /* 32-33: cpl (current privilege level) */
511
    {"psr.is",  ((valueT) 1) << 34},
512
    {"psr.mc",  ((valueT) 1) << 35},
513
    {"psr.it",  ((valueT) 1) << 36},
514
    {"psr.id",  ((valueT) 1) << 37},
515
    {"psr.da",  ((valueT) 1) << 38},
516
    {"psr.dd",  ((valueT) 1) << 39},
517
    {"psr.ss",  ((valueT) 1) << 40},
518
    /* 41-42: ri (restart instruction) */
519
    {"psr.ed",  ((valueT) 1) << 43},
520
    {"psr.bn",  ((valueT) 1) << 44},
521
  };
522
 
523
/* indirect register-sets/memory:  */
524
 
525
static const struct
526
  {
527
    const char *name;
528
    unsigned int regnum;
529
  }
530
indirect_reg[] =
531
  {
532
    { "CPUID",  IND_CPUID },
533
    { "cpuid",  IND_CPUID },
534
    { "dbr",    IND_DBR },
535
    { "dtr",    IND_DTR },
536
    { "itr",    IND_ITR },
537
    { "ibr",    IND_IBR },
538
    { "msr",    IND_MSR },
539
    { "pkr",    IND_PKR },
540
    { "pmc",    IND_PMC },
541
    { "pmd",    IND_PMD },
542
    { "rr",     IND_RR },
543
  };
544
 
545
/* Pseudo functions used to indicate relocation types (these functions
546
   start with an at sign (@).  */
547
static struct
548
  {
549
    const char *name;
550
    enum pseudo_type
551
      {
552
        PSEUDO_FUNC_NONE,
553
        PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC,
554
        PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,
555
        PSEUDO_FUNC_REG,
556
        PSEUDO_FUNC_FLOAT
557
      }
558
    type;
559
    union
560
      {
561
        unsigned long ival;
562
        symbolS *sym;
563
      }
564
    u;
565
  }
566
pseudo_func[] =
567
  {
568
    /* reloc pseudo functions (these must come first!):  */
569
    { "dtpmod", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
570
    { "dtprel", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
571
    { "fptr",   PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
572
    { "gprel",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
573
    { "ltoff",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
574
    { "ltoffx", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
575
    { "pcrel",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
576
    { "pltoff", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
577
    { "secrel", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
578
    { "segrel", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
579
    { "tprel",  PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
580
    { "ltv",    PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
581
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE */
582
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE */
583
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE */
584
    { NULL, 0, { 0 } },   /* placeholder for FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE */
585
    { "iplt",   PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
586
#ifdef TE_VMS
587
    { "slotcount", PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC, { 0 } },
588
#endif
589
 
590
    /* mbtype4 constants:  */
591
    { "alt",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0xa } },
592
    { "brcst",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x0 } },
593
    { "mix",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x8 } },
594
    { "rev",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0xb } },
595
    { "shuf",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x9 } },
596
 
597
    /* fclass constants:  */
598
    { "nat",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x100 } },
599
    { "qnan",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x080 } },
600
    { "snan",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x040 } },
601
    { "pos",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x001 } },
602
    { "neg",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x002 } },
603
    { "zero",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x004 } },
604
    { "unorm",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x008 } },
605
    { "norm",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x010 } },
606
    { "inf",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x020 } },
607
 
608
    { "natval", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x100 } }, /* old usage */
609
 
610
    /* hint constants: */
611
    { "pause",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST, { 0x0 } },
612
 
613
    /* unwind-related constants:  */
614
    { "svr4",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_NONE } },
615
    { "hpux",   PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_HPUX } },
616
    { "nt",     PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { 2 } },                /* conflicts w/ELFOSABI_NETBSD */
617
    { "linux",  PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_LINUX } },
618
    { "freebsd", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,     { ELFOSABI_FREEBSD } },
619
    { "openvms", PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,     { ELFOSABI_OPENVMS } },
620
    { "nsk",    PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST,      { ELFOSABI_NSK } },
621
 
622
    /* unwind-related registers:  */
623
    { "priunat",PSEUDO_FUNC_REG, { REG_PRIUNAT } }
624
  };
625
 
626
/* 41-bit nop opcodes (one per unit):  */
627
static const bfd_vma nop[IA64_NUM_UNITS] =
628
  {
629
    0x0000000000LL,     /* NIL => break 0 */
630
    0x0008000000LL,     /* I-unit nop */
631
    0x0008000000LL,     /* M-unit nop */
632
    0x4000000000LL,     /* B-unit nop */
633
    0x0008000000LL,     /* F-unit nop */
634
    0x0000000000LL,     /* L-"unit" nop immediate */
635
    0x0008000000LL,     /* X-unit nop */
636
  };
637
 
638
/* Can't be `const' as it's passed to input routines (which have the
639
   habit of setting temporary sentinels.  */
640
static char special_section_name[][20] =
641
  {
642
    {".bss"}, {".sbss"}, {".sdata"}, {".rodata"}, {".comment"},
643
    {".IA_64.unwind"}, {".IA_64.unwind_info"},
644
    {".init_array"}, {".fini_array"}
645
  };
646
 
647
/* The best template for a particular sequence of up to three
648
   instructions:  */
649
#define N       IA64_NUM_TYPES
650
static unsigned char best_template[N][N][N];
651
#undef N
652
 
653
/* Resource dependencies currently in effect */
654
static struct rsrc {
655
  int depind;                       /* dependency index */
656
  const struct ia64_dependency *dependency; /* actual dependency */
657
  unsigned specific:1,              /* is this a specific bit/regno? */
658
    link_to_qp_branch:1;           /* will a branch on the same QP clear it?*/
659
  int index;                        /* specific regno/bit within dependency */
660
  int note;                         /* optional qualifying note (0 if none) */
661
#define STATE_NONE 0
662
#define STATE_STOP 1
663
#define STATE_SRLZ 2
664
  int insn_srlz;                    /* current insn serialization state */
665
  int data_srlz;                    /* current data serialization state */
666
  int qp_regno;                     /* qualifying predicate for this usage */
667
  char *file;                       /* what file marked this dependency */
668
  unsigned int line;                /* what line marked this dependency */
669
  struct mem_offset mem_offset;     /* optional memory offset hint */
670
  enum { CMP_NONE, CMP_OR, CMP_AND } cmp_type; /* OR or AND compare? */
671
  int path;                         /* corresponding code entry index */
672
} *regdeps = NULL;
673
static int regdepslen = 0;
674
static int regdepstotlen = 0;
675
static const char *dv_mode[] = { "RAW", "WAW", "WAR" };
676
static const char *dv_sem[] = { "none", "implied", "impliedf",
677
                                "data", "instr", "specific", "stop", "other" };
678
static const char *dv_cmp_type[] = { "none", "OR", "AND" };
679
 
680
/* Current state of PR mutexation */
681
static struct qpmutex {
682
  valueT prmask;
683
  int path;
684
} *qp_mutexes = NULL;          /* QP mutex bitmasks */
685
static int qp_mutexeslen = 0;
686
static int qp_mutexestotlen = 0;
687
static valueT qp_safe_across_calls = 0;
688
 
689
/* Current state of PR implications */
690
static struct qp_imply {
691
  unsigned p1:6;
692
  unsigned p2:6;
693
  unsigned p2_branched:1;
694
  int path;
695
} *qp_implies = NULL;
696
static int qp_implieslen = 0;
697
static int qp_impliestotlen = 0;
698
 
699
/* Keep track of static GR values so that indirect register usage can
700
   sometimes be tracked.  */
701
static struct gr {
702
  unsigned known:1;
703
  int path;
704
  valueT value;
705
} gr_values[128] = {
706
  {
707
    1,
708
#ifdef INT_MAX
709
    INT_MAX,
710
#else
711
    (((1 << (8 * sizeof(gr_values->path) - 2)) - 1) << 1) + 1,
712
#endif
713
 
714
  }
715
};
716
 
717
/* Remember the alignment frag.  */
718
static fragS *align_frag;
719
 
720
/* These are the routines required to output the various types of
721
   unwind records.  */
722
 
723
/* A slot_number is a frag address plus the slot index (0-2).  We use the
724
   frag address here so that if there is a section switch in the middle of
725
   a function, then instructions emitted to a different section are not
726
   counted.  Since there may be more than one frag for a function, this
727
   means we also need to keep track of which frag this address belongs to
728
   so we can compute inter-frag distances.  This also nicely solves the
729
   problem with nops emitted for align directives, which can't easily be
730
   counted, but can easily be derived from frag sizes.  */
731
 
732
typedef struct unw_rec_list {
733
  unwind_record r;
734
  unsigned long slot_number;
735
  fragS *slot_frag;
736
  struct unw_rec_list *next;
737
} unw_rec_list;
738
 
739
#define SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET        (unsigned)-1
740
 
741
/* Linked list of saved prologue counts.  A very poor
742
   implementation of a map from label numbers to prologue counts.  */
743
typedef struct label_prologue_count
744
{
745
  struct label_prologue_count *next;
746
  unsigned long label_number;
747
  unsigned int prologue_count;
748
} label_prologue_count;
749
 
750
typedef struct proc_pending
751
{
752
  symbolS *sym;
753
  struct proc_pending *next;
754
} proc_pending;
755
 
756
static struct
757
{
758
  /* Maintain a list of unwind entries for the current function.  */
759
  unw_rec_list *list;
760
  unw_rec_list *tail;
761
 
762
  /* Any unwind entries that should be attached to the current slot
763
     that an insn is being constructed for.  */
764
  unw_rec_list *current_entry;
765
 
766
  /* These are used to create the unwind table entry for this function.  */
767
  proc_pending proc_pending;
768
  symbolS *info;                /* pointer to unwind info */
769
  symbolS *personality_routine;
770
  segT saved_text_seg;
771
  subsegT saved_text_subseg;
772
  unsigned int force_unwind_entry : 1;  /* force generation of unwind entry? */
773
 
774
  /* TRUE if processing unwind directives in a prologue region.  */
775
  unsigned int prologue : 1;
776
  unsigned int prologue_mask : 4;
777
  unsigned int prologue_gr : 7;
778
  unsigned int body : 1;
779
  unsigned int insn : 1;
780
  unsigned int prologue_count;  /* number of .prologues seen so far */
781
  /* Prologue counts at previous .label_state directives.  */
782
  struct label_prologue_count * saved_prologue_counts;
783
 
784
  /* List of split up .save-s.  */
785
  unw_p_record *pending_saves;
786
} unwind;
787
 
788
/* The input value is a negated offset from psp, and specifies an address
789
   psp - offset.  The encoded value is psp + 16 - (4 * offset).  Thus we
790
   must add 16 and divide by 4 to get the encoded value.  */
791
 
792
#define ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET(OFFSET) (((OFFSET) + 16) / 4)
793
 
794
typedef void (*vbyte_func) (int, char *, char *);
795
 
796
/* Forward declarations:  */
797
static void dot_alias (int);
798
static int parse_operand_and_eval (expressionS *, int);
799
static void emit_one_bundle (void);
800
static bfd_reloc_code_real_type ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (struct symbol *,
801
                                                          bfd_reloc_code_real_type);
802
static void insn_group_break (int, int, int);
803
static void add_qp_mutex (valueT);
804
static void add_qp_imply (int, int);
805
static void clear_qp_mutex (valueT);
806
static void clear_qp_implies (valueT, valueT);
807
static void print_dependency (const char *, int);
808
static void instruction_serialization (void);
809
static void data_serialization (void);
810
static void output_R3_format (vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long);
811
static void output_B3_format (vbyte_func, unsigned long, unsigned long);
812
static void output_B4_format (vbyte_func, unw_record_type, unsigned long);
813
static void free_saved_prologue_counts (void);
814
 
815
/* Determine if application register REGNUM resides only in the integer
816
   unit (as opposed to the memory unit).  */
817
static int
818
ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (int reg)
819
{
820
  reg -= REG_AR;
821
  return reg >= 64 && reg <= 111;
822
}
823
 
824
/* Determine if application register REGNUM resides only in the memory
825
   unit (as opposed to the integer unit).  */
826
static int
827
ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (int reg)
828
{
829
  reg -= REG_AR;
830
  return reg >= 0 && reg <= 47;
831
}
832
 
833
/* Switch to section NAME and create section if necessary.  It's
834
   rather ugly that we have to manipulate input_line_pointer but I
835
   don't see any other way to accomplish the same thing without
836
   changing obj-elf.c (which may be the Right Thing, in the end).  */
837
static void
838
set_section (char *name)
839
{
840
  char *saved_input_line_pointer;
841
 
842
  saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
843
  input_line_pointer = name;
844
  obj_elf_section (0);
845
  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
846
}
847
 
848
/* Map 's' to SHF_IA_64_SHORT.  */
849
 
850
bfd_vma
851
ia64_elf_section_letter (int letter, char **ptr_msg)
852
{
853
  if (letter == 's')
854
    return SHF_IA_64_SHORT;
855
  else if (letter == 'o')
856
    return SHF_LINK_ORDER;
857
#ifdef TE_VMS
858
  else if (letter == 'O')
859
    return SHF_IA_64_VMS_OVERLAID;
860
  else if (letter == 'g')
861
    return SHF_IA_64_VMS_GLOBAL;
862
#endif
863
 
864
  *ptr_msg = _("bad .section directive: want a,o,s,w,x,M,S,G,T in string");
865
  return -1;
866
}
867
 
868
/* Map SHF_IA_64_SHORT to SEC_SMALL_DATA.  */
869
 
870
flagword
871
ia64_elf_section_flags (flagword flags,
872
                        bfd_vma attr,
873
                        int type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
874
{
875
  if (attr & SHF_IA_64_SHORT)
876
    flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
877
  return flags;
878
}
879
 
880
int
881
ia64_elf_section_type (const char *str, size_t len)
882
{
883
#define STREQ(s) ((len == sizeof (s) - 1) && (strncmp (str, s, sizeof (s) - 1) == 0))
884
 
885
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_info))
886
    return SHT_PROGBITS;
887
 
888
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_info_once))
889
    return SHT_PROGBITS;
890
 
891
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind))
892
    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
893
 
894
  if (STREQ (ELF_STRING_ia64_unwind_once))
895
    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
896
 
897
  if (STREQ ("unwind"))
898
    return SHT_IA_64_UNWIND;
899
 
900
  return -1;
901
#undef STREQ
902
}
903
 
904
static unsigned int
905
set_regstack (unsigned int ins,
906
              unsigned int locs,
907
              unsigned int outs,
908
              unsigned int rots)
909
{
910
  /* Size of frame.  */
911
  unsigned int sof;
912
 
913
  sof = ins + locs + outs;
914
  if (sof > 96)
915
    {
916
      as_bad (_("Size of frame exceeds maximum of 96 registers"));
917
      return 0;
918
    }
919
  if (rots > sof)
920
    {
921
      as_warn (_("Size of rotating registers exceeds frame size"));
922
      return 0;
923
    }
924
  md.in.base = REG_GR + 32;
925
  md.loc.base = md.in.base + ins;
926
  md.out.base = md.loc.base + locs;
927
 
928
  md.in.num_regs  = ins;
929
  md.loc.num_regs = locs;
930
  md.out.num_regs = outs;
931
  md.rot.num_regs = rots;
932
  return sof;
933
}
934
 
935
void
936
ia64_flush_insns (void)
937
{
938
  struct label_fix *lfix;
939
  segT saved_seg;
940
  subsegT saved_subseg;
941
  unw_rec_list *ptr;
942
  bfd_boolean mark;
943
 
944
  if (!md.last_text_seg)
945
    return;
946
 
947
  saved_seg = now_seg;
948
  saved_subseg = now_subseg;
949
 
950
  subseg_set (md.last_text_seg, 0);
951
 
952
  while (md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
953
    emit_one_bundle ();         /* force out queued instructions */
954
 
955
  /* In case there are labels following the last instruction, resolve
956
     those now.  */
957
  mark = FALSE;
958
  for (lfix = CURR_SLOT.label_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
959
    {
960
      symbol_set_value_now (lfix->sym);
961
      mark |= lfix->dw2_mark_labels;
962
    }
963
  if (mark)
964
    {
965
      dwarf2_where (&CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
966
      CURR_SLOT.debug_line.flags |= DWARF2_FLAG_BASIC_BLOCK;
967
      dwarf2_gen_line_info (frag_now_fix (), &CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
968
      dwarf2_consume_line_info ();
969
    }
970
  CURR_SLOT.label_fixups = 0;
971
 
972
  for (lfix = CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
973
    symbol_set_value_now (lfix->sym);
974
  CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups = 0;
975
 
976
  /* In case there are unwind directives following the last instruction,
977
     resolve those now.  We only handle prologue, body, and endp directives
978
     here.  Give an error for others.  */
979
  for (ptr = unwind.current_entry; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
980
    {
981
      switch (ptr->r.type)
982
        {
983
        case prologue:
984
        case prologue_gr:
985
        case body:
986
        case endp:
987
          ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) frag_more (0);
988
          ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
989
          break;
990
 
991
          /* Allow any record which doesn't have a "t" field (i.e.,
992
             doesn't relate to a particular instruction).  */
993
        case unwabi:
994
        case br_gr:
995
        case copy_state:
996
        case fr_mem:
997
        case frgr_mem:
998
        case gr_gr:
999
        case gr_mem:
1000
        case label_state:
1001
        case rp_br:
1002
        case spill_base:
1003
        case spill_mask:
1004
          /* nothing */
1005
          break;
1006
 
1007
        default:
1008
          as_bad (_("Unwind directive not followed by an instruction."));
1009
          break;
1010
        }
1011
    }
1012
  unwind.current_entry = NULL;
1013
 
1014
  subseg_set (saved_seg, saved_subseg);
1015
 
1016
  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
1017
    as_bad (_("qualifying predicate not followed by instruction"));
1018
}
1019
 
1020
static void
1021
ia64_do_align (int nbytes)
1022
{
1023
  char *saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
1024
 
1025
  input_line_pointer = "";
1026
  s_align_bytes (nbytes);
1027
  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
1028
}
1029
 
1030
void
1031
ia64_cons_align (int nbytes)
1032
{
1033
  if (md.auto_align)
1034
    {
1035
      char *saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
1036
      input_line_pointer = "";
1037
      s_align_bytes (nbytes);
1038
      input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
1039
    }
1040
}
1041
 
1042
/* Output COUNT bytes to a memory location.  */
1043
static char *vbyte_mem_ptr = NULL;
1044
 
1045
static void
1046
output_vbyte_mem (int count, char *ptr, char *comment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1047
{
1048
  int x;
1049
  if (vbyte_mem_ptr == NULL)
1050
    abort ();
1051
 
1052
  if (count == 0)
1053
    return;
1054
  for (x = 0; x < count; x++)
1055
    *(vbyte_mem_ptr++) = ptr[x];
1056
}
1057
 
1058
/* Count the number of bytes required for records.  */
1059
static int vbyte_count = 0;
1060
static void
1061
count_output (int count,
1062
              char *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1063
              char *comment ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1064
{
1065
  vbyte_count += count;
1066
}
1067
 
1068
static void
1069
output_R1_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, int rlen)
1070
{
1071
  int r = 0;
1072
  char byte;
1073
  if (rlen > 0x1f)
1074
    {
1075
      output_R3_format (f, rtype, rlen);
1076
      return;
1077
    }
1078
 
1079
  if (rtype == body)
1080
    r = 1;
1081
  else if (rtype != prologue)
1082
    as_bad (_("record type is not valid"));
1083
 
1084
  byte = UNW_R1 | (r << 5) | (rlen & 0x1f);
1085
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1086
}
1087
 
1088
static void
1089
output_R2_format (vbyte_func f, int mask, int grsave, unsigned long rlen)
1090
{
1091
  char bytes[20];
1092
  int count = 2;
1093
  mask = (mask & 0x0f);
1094
  grsave = (grsave & 0x7f);
1095
 
1096
  bytes[0] = (UNW_R2 | (mask >> 1));
1097
  bytes[1] = (((mask & 0x01) << 7) | grsave);
1098
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, rlen, 0);
1099
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1100
}
1101
 
1102
static void
1103
output_R3_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long rlen)
1104
{
1105
  int r = 0, count;
1106
  char bytes[20];
1107
  if (rlen <= 0x1f)
1108
    {
1109
      output_R1_format (f, rtype, rlen);
1110
      return;
1111
    }
1112
 
1113
  if (rtype == body)
1114
    r = 1;
1115
  else if (rtype != prologue)
1116
    as_bad (_("record type is not valid"));
1117
  bytes[0] = (UNW_R3 | r);
1118
  count = output_leb128 (bytes + 1, rlen, 0);
1119
  (*f) (count + 1, bytes, NULL);
1120
}
1121
 
1122
static void
1123
output_P1_format (vbyte_func f, int brmask)
1124
{
1125
  char byte;
1126
  byte = UNW_P1 | (brmask & 0x1f);
1127
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1128
}
1129
 
1130
static void
1131
output_P2_format (vbyte_func f, int brmask, int gr)
1132
{
1133
  char bytes[2];
1134
  brmask = (brmask & 0x1f);
1135
  bytes[0] = UNW_P2 | (brmask >> 1);
1136
  bytes[1] = (((brmask & 1) << 7) | gr);
1137
  (*f) (2, bytes, NULL);
1138
}
1139
 
1140
static void
1141
output_P3_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, int reg)
1142
{
1143
  char bytes[2];
1144
  int r = 0;
1145
  reg = (reg & 0x7f);
1146
  switch (rtype)
1147
    {
1148
    case psp_gr:
1149
      r = 0;
1150
      break;
1151
    case rp_gr:
1152
      r = 1;
1153
      break;
1154
    case pfs_gr:
1155
      r = 2;
1156
      break;
1157
    case preds_gr:
1158
      r = 3;
1159
      break;
1160
    case unat_gr:
1161
      r = 4;
1162
      break;
1163
    case lc_gr:
1164
      r = 5;
1165
      break;
1166
    case rp_br:
1167
      r = 6;
1168
      break;
1169
    case rnat_gr:
1170
      r = 7;
1171
      break;
1172
    case bsp_gr:
1173
      r = 8;
1174
      break;
1175
    case bspstore_gr:
1176
      r = 9;
1177
      break;
1178
    case fpsr_gr:
1179
      r = 10;
1180
      break;
1181
    case priunat_gr:
1182
      r = 11;
1183
      break;
1184
    default:
1185
      as_bad (_("Invalid record type for P3 format."));
1186
    }
1187
  bytes[0] = (UNW_P3 | (r >> 1));
1188
  bytes[1] = (((r & 1) << 7) | reg);
1189
  (*f) (2, bytes, NULL);
1190
}
1191
 
1192
static void
1193
output_P4_format (vbyte_func f, unsigned char *imask, unsigned long imask_size)
1194
{
1195
  imask[0] = UNW_P4;
1196
  (*f) (imask_size, (char *) imask, NULL);
1197
}
1198
 
1199
static void
1200
output_P5_format (vbyte_func f, int grmask, unsigned long frmask)
1201
{
1202
  char bytes[4];
1203
  grmask = (grmask & 0x0f);
1204
 
1205
  bytes[0] = UNW_P5;
1206
  bytes[1] = ((grmask << 4) | ((frmask & 0x000f0000) >> 16));
1207
  bytes[2] = ((frmask & 0x0000ff00) >> 8);
1208
  bytes[3] = (frmask & 0x000000ff);
1209
  (*f) (4, bytes, NULL);
1210
}
1211
 
1212
static void
1213
output_P6_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, int rmask)
1214
{
1215
  char byte;
1216
  int r = 0;
1217
 
1218
  if (rtype == gr_mem)
1219
    r = 1;
1220
  else if (rtype != fr_mem)
1221
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format P6"));
1222
  byte = (UNW_P6 | (r << 4) | (rmask & 0x0f));
1223
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1224
}
1225
 
1226
static void
1227
output_P7_format (vbyte_func f,
1228
                  unw_record_type rtype,
1229
                  unsigned long w1,
1230
                  unsigned long w2)
1231
{
1232
  char bytes[20];
1233
  int count = 1;
1234
  int r = 0;
1235
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, w1, 0);
1236
  switch (rtype)
1237
    {
1238
    case mem_stack_f:
1239
      r = 0;
1240
      count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w2 >> 4, 0);
1241
      break;
1242
    case mem_stack_v:
1243
      r = 1;
1244
      break;
1245
    case spill_base:
1246
      r = 2;
1247
      break;
1248
    case psp_sprel:
1249
      r = 3;
1250
      break;
1251
    case rp_when:
1252
      r = 4;
1253
      break;
1254
    case rp_psprel:
1255
      r = 5;
1256
      break;
1257
    case pfs_when:
1258
      r = 6;
1259
      break;
1260
    case pfs_psprel:
1261
      r = 7;
1262
      break;
1263
    case preds_when:
1264
      r = 8;
1265
      break;
1266
    case preds_psprel:
1267
      r = 9;
1268
      break;
1269
    case lc_when:
1270
      r = 10;
1271
      break;
1272
    case lc_psprel:
1273
      r = 11;
1274
      break;
1275
    case unat_when:
1276
      r = 12;
1277
      break;
1278
    case unat_psprel:
1279
      r = 13;
1280
      break;
1281
    case fpsr_when:
1282
      r = 14;
1283
      break;
1284
    case fpsr_psprel:
1285
      r = 15;
1286
      break;
1287
    default:
1288
      break;
1289
    }
1290
  bytes[0] = (UNW_P7 | r);
1291
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1292
}
1293
 
1294
static void
1295
output_P8_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long t)
1296
{
1297
  char bytes[20];
1298
  int r = 0;
1299
  int count = 2;
1300
  bytes[0] = UNW_P8;
1301
  switch (rtype)
1302
    {
1303
    case rp_sprel:
1304
      r = 1;
1305
      break;
1306
    case pfs_sprel:
1307
      r = 2;
1308
      break;
1309
    case preds_sprel:
1310
      r = 3;
1311
      break;
1312
    case lc_sprel:
1313
      r = 4;
1314
      break;
1315
    case unat_sprel:
1316
      r = 5;
1317
      break;
1318
    case fpsr_sprel:
1319
      r = 6;
1320
      break;
1321
    case bsp_when:
1322
      r = 7;
1323
      break;
1324
    case bsp_psprel:
1325
      r = 8;
1326
      break;
1327
    case bsp_sprel:
1328
      r = 9;
1329
      break;
1330
    case bspstore_when:
1331
      r = 10;
1332
      break;
1333
    case bspstore_psprel:
1334
      r = 11;
1335
      break;
1336
    case bspstore_sprel:
1337
      r = 12;
1338
      break;
1339
    case rnat_when:
1340
      r = 13;
1341
      break;
1342
    case rnat_psprel:
1343
      r = 14;
1344
      break;
1345
    case rnat_sprel:
1346
      r = 15;
1347
      break;
1348
    case priunat_when_gr:
1349
      r = 16;
1350
      break;
1351
    case priunat_psprel:
1352
      r = 17;
1353
      break;
1354
    case priunat_sprel:
1355
      r = 18;
1356
      break;
1357
    case priunat_when_mem:
1358
      r = 19;
1359
      break;
1360
    default:
1361
      break;
1362
    }
1363
  bytes[1] = r;
1364
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, t, 0);
1365
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1366
}
1367
 
1368
static void
1369
output_P9_format (vbyte_func f, int grmask, int gr)
1370
{
1371
  char bytes[3];
1372
  bytes[0] = UNW_P9;
1373
  bytes[1] = (grmask & 0x0f);
1374
  bytes[2] = (gr & 0x7f);
1375
  (*f) (3, bytes, NULL);
1376
}
1377
 
1378
static void
1379
output_P10_format (vbyte_func f, int abi, int context)
1380
{
1381
  char bytes[3];
1382
  bytes[0] = UNW_P10;
1383
  bytes[1] = (abi & 0xff);
1384
  bytes[2] = (context & 0xff);
1385
  (*f) (3, bytes, NULL);
1386
}
1387
 
1388
static void
1389
output_B1_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long label)
1390
{
1391
  char byte;
1392
  int r = 0;
1393
  if (label > 0x1f)
1394
    {
1395
      output_B4_format (f, rtype, label);
1396
      return;
1397
    }
1398
  if (rtype == copy_state)
1399
    r = 1;
1400
  else if (rtype != label_state)
1401
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format B1"));
1402
 
1403
  byte = (UNW_B1 | (r << 5) | (label & 0x1f));
1404
  (*f) (1, &byte, NULL);
1405
}
1406
 
1407
static void
1408
output_B2_format (vbyte_func f, unsigned long ecount, unsigned long t)
1409
{
1410
  char bytes[20];
1411
  int count = 1;
1412
  if (ecount > 0x1f)
1413
    {
1414
      output_B3_format (f, ecount, t);
1415
      return;
1416
    }
1417
  bytes[0] = (UNW_B2 | (ecount & 0x1f));
1418
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, t, 0);
1419
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1420
}
1421
 
1422
static void
1423
output_B3_format (vbyte_func f, unsigned long ecount, unsigned long t)
1424
{
1425
  char bytes[20];
1426
  int count = 1;
1427
  if (ecount <= 0x1f)
1428
    {
1429
      output_B2_format (f, ecount, t);
1430
      return;
1431
    }
1432
  bytes[0] = UNW_B3;
1433
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, t, 0);
1434
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, ecount, 0);
1435
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1436
}
1437
 
1438
static void
1439
output_B4_format (vbyte_func f, unw_record_type rtype, unsigned long label)
1440
{
1441
  char bytes[20];
1442
  int r = 0;
1443
  int count = 1;
1444
  if (label <= 0x1f)
1445
    {
1446
      output_B1_format (f, rtype, label);
1447
      return;
1448
    }
1449
 
1450
  if (rtype == copy_state)
1451
    r = 1;
1452
  else if (rtype != label_state)
1453
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format B1"));
1454
 
1455
  bytes[0] = (UNW_B4 | (r << 3));
1456
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 1, label, 0);
1457
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1458
}
1459
 
1460
static char
1461
format_ab_reg (int ab, int reg)
1462
{
1463
  int ret;
1464
  ab = (ab & 3);
1465
  reg = (reg & 0x1f);
1466
  ret = (ab << 5) | reg;
1467
  return ret;
1468
}
1469
 
1470
static void
1471
output_X1_format (vbyte_func f,
1472
                  unw_record_type rtype,
1473
                  int ab,
1474
                  int reg,
1475
                  unsigned long t,
1476
                  unsigned long w1)
1477
{
1478
  char bytes[20];
1479
  int r = 0;
1480
  int count = 2;
1481
  bytes[0] = UNW_X1;
1482
 
1483
  if (rtype == spill_sprel)
1484
    r = 1;
1485
  else if (rtype != spill_psprel)
1486
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format X1"));
1487
  bytes[1] = ((r << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1488
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 2, t, 0);
1489
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w1, 0);
1490
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1491
}
1492
 
1493
static void
1494
output_X2_format (vbyte_func f,
1495
                  int ab,
1496
                  int reg,
1497
                  int x,
1498
                  int y,
1499
                  int treg,
1500
                  unsigned long t)
1501
{
1502
  char bytes[20];
1503
  int count = 3;
1504
  bytes[0] = UNW_X2;
1505
  bytes[1] = (((x & 1) << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1506
  bytes[2] = (((y & 1) << 7) | (treg & 0x7f));
1507
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 3, t, 0);
1508
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1509
}
1510
 
1511
static void
1512
output_X3_format (vbyte_func f,
1513
                  unw_record_type rtype,
1514
                  int qp,
1515
                  int ab,
1516
                  int reg,
1517
                  unsigned long t,
1518
                  unsigned long w1)
1519
{
1520
  char bytes[20];
1521
  int r = 0;
1522
  int count = 3;
1523
  bytes[0] = UNW_X3;
1524
 
1525
  if (rtype == spill_sprel_p)
1526
    r = 1;
1527
  else if (rtype != spill_psprel_p)
1528
    as_bad (_("Invalid record type for format X3"));
1529
  bytes[1] = ((r << 7) | (qp & 0x3f));
1530
  bytes[2] = format_ab_reg (ab, reg);
1531
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 3, t, 0);
1532
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + count, w1, 0);
1533
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1534
}
1535
 
1536
static void
1537
output_X4_format (vbyte_func f,
1538
                  int qp,
1539
                  int ab,
1540
                  int reg,
1541
                  int x,
1542
                  int y,
1543
                  int treg,
1544
                  unsigned long t)
1545
{
1546
  char bytes[20];
1547
  int count = 4;
1548
  bytes[0] = UNW_X4;
1549
  bytes[1] = (qp & 0x3f);
1550
  bytes[2] = (((x & 1) << 7) | format_ab_reg (ab, reg));
1551
  bytes[3] = (((y & 1) << 7) | (treg & 0x7f));
1552
  count += output_leb128 (bytes + 4, t, 0);
1553
  (*f) (count, bytes, NULL);
1554
}
1555
 
1556
/* This function checks whether there are any outstanding .save-s and
1557
   discards them if so.  */
1558
 
1559
static void
1560
check_pending_save (void)
1561
{
1562
  if (unwind.pending_saves)
1563
    {
1564
      unw_rec_list *cur, *prev;
1565
 
1566
      as_warn (_("Previous .save incomplete"));
1567
      for (cur = unwind.list, prev = NULL; cur; )
1568
        if (&cur->r.record.p == unwind.pending_saves)
1569
          {
1570
            if (prev)
1571
              prev->next = cur->next;
1572
            else
1573
              unwind.list = cur->next;
1574
            if (cur == unwind.tail)
1575
              unwind.tail = prev;
1576
            if (cur == unwind.current_entry)
1577
              unwind.current_entry = cur->next;
1578
            /* Don't free the first discarded record, it's being used as
1579
               terminator for (currently) br_gr and gr_gr processing, and
1580
               also prevents leaving a dangling pointer to it in its
1581
               predecessor.  */
1582
            cur->r.record.p.grmask = 0;
1583
            cur->r.record.p.brmask = 0;
1584
            cur->r.record.p.frmask = 0;
1585
            prev = cur->r.record.p.next;
1586
            cur->r.record.p.next = NULL;
1587
            cur = prev;
1588
            break;
1589
          }
1590
        else
1591
          {
1592
            prev = cur;
1593
            cur = cur->next;
1594
          }
1595
      while (cur)
1596
        {
1597
          prev = cur;
1598
          cur = cur->r.record.p.next;
1599
          free (prev);
1600
        }
1601
      unwind.pending_saves = NULL;
1602
    }
1603
}
1604
 
1605
/* This function allocates a record list structure, and initializes fields.  */
1606
 
1607
static unw_rec_list *
1608
alloc_record (unw_record_type t)
1609
{
1610
  unw_rec_list *ptr;
1611
  ptr = xmalloc (sizeof (*ptr));
1612
  memset (ptr, 0, sizeof (*ptr));
1613
  ptr->slot_number = SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET;
1614
  ptr->r.type = t;
1615
  return ptr;
1616
}
1617
 
1618
/* Dummy unwind record used for calculating the length of the last prologue or
1619
   body region.  */
1620
 
1621
static unw_rec_list *
1622
output_endp (void)
1623
{
1624
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (endp);
1625
  return ptr;
1626
}
1627
 
1628
static unw_rec_list *
1629
output_prologue (void)
1630
{
1631
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (prologue);
1632
  memset (&ptr->r.record.r.mask, 0, sizeof (ptr->r.record.r.mask));
1633
  return ptr;
1634
}
1635
 
1636
static unw_rec_list *
1637
output_prologue_gr (unsigned int saved_mask, unsigned int reg)
1638
{
1639
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (prologue_gr);
1640
  memset (&ptr->r.record.r.mask, 0, sizeof (ptr->r.record.r.mask));
1641
  ptr->r.record.r.grmask = saved_mask;
1642
  ptr->r.record.r.grsave = reg;
1643
  return ptr;
1644
}
1645
 
1646
static unw_rec_list *
1647
output_body (void)
1648
{
1649
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (body);
1650
  return ptr;
1651
}
1652
 
1653
static unw_rec_list *
1654
output_mem_stack_f (unsigned int size)
1655
{
1656
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (mem_stack_f);
1657
  ptr->r.record.p.size = size;
1658
  return ptr;
1659
}
1660
 
1661
static unw_rec_list *
1662
output_mem_stack_v (void)
1663
{
1664
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (mem_stack_v);
1665
  return ptr;
1666
}
1667
 
1668
static unw_rec_list *
1669
output_psp_gr (unsigned int gr)
1670
{
1671
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (psp_gr);
1672
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1673
  return ptr;
1674
}
1675
 
1676
static unw_rec_list *
1677
output_psp_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1678
{
1679
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (psp_sprel);
1680
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1681
  return ptr;
1682
}
1683
 
1684
static unw_rec_list *
1685
output_rp_when (void)
1686
{
1687
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_when);
1688
  return ptr;
1689
}
1690
 
1691
static unw_rec_list *
1692
output_rp_gr (unsigned int gr)
1693
{
1694
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_gr);
1695
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1696
  return ptr;
1697
}
1698
 
1699
static unw_rec_list *
1700
output_rp_br (unsigned int br)
1701
{
1702
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_br);
1703
  ptr->r.record.p.r.br = br;
1704
  return ptr;
1705
}
1706
 
1707
static unw_rec_list *
1708
output_rp_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1709
{
1710
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_psprel);
1711
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1712
  return ptr;
1713
}
1714
 
1715
static unw_rec_list *
1716
output_rp_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1717
{
1718
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rp_sprel);
1719
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1720
  return ptr;
1721
}
1722
 
1723
static unw_rec_list *
1724
output_pfs_when (void)
1725
{
1726
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_when);
1727
  return ptr;
1728
}
1729
 
1730
static unw_rec_list *
1731
output_pfs_gr (unsigned int gr)
1732
{
1733
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_gr);
1734
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1735
  return ptr;
1736
}
1737
 
1738
static unw_rec_list *
1739
output_pfs_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1740
{
1741
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_psprel);
1742
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1743
  return ptr;
1744
}
1745
 
1746
static unw_rec_list *
1747
output_pfs_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1748
{
1749
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (pfs_sprel);
1750
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1751
  return ptr;
1752
}
1753
 
1754
static unw_rec_list *
1755
output_preds_when (void)
1756
{
1757
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_when);
1758
  return ptr;
1759
}
1760
 
1761
static unw_rec_list *
1762
output_preds_gr (unsigned int gr)
1763
{
1764
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_gr);
1765
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1766
  return ptr;
1767
}
1768
 
1769
static unw_rec_list *
1770
output_preds_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1771
{
1772
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_psprel);
1773
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1774
  return ptr;
1775
}
1776
 
1777
static unw_rec_list *
1778
output_preds_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1779
{
1780
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (preds_sprel);
1781
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1782
  return ptr;
1783
}
1784
 
1785
static unw_rec_list *
1786
output_fr_mem (unsigned int mask)
1787
{
1788
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fr_mem);
1789
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1790
 
1791
  ptr->r.record.p.frmask = mask;
1792
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1793
  for (;;)
1794
    {
1795
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1796
 
1797
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1798
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1799
      if (!mask)
1800
        return ptr;
1801
      cur = alloc_record (fr_mem);
1802
      cur->r.record.p.frmask = mask;
1803
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1804
      prev->r.record.p.frmask ^= mask;
1805
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1806
    }
1807
}
1808
 
1809
static unw_rec_list *
1810
output_frgr_mem (unsigned int gr_mask, unsigned int fr_mask)
1811
{
1812
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
1813
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1814
 
1815
  unwind.pending_saves = &cur->r.record.p;
1816
  cur->r.record.p.frmask = fr_mask;
1817
  while (fr_mask)
1818
    {
1819
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1820
 
1821
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1822
      fr_mask &= ~(fr_mask & (~fr_mask + 1));
1823
      if (!gr_mask && !fr_mask)
1824
        return ptr;
1825
      cur = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
1826
      cur->r.record.p.frmask = fr_mask;
1827
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1828
      prev->r.record.p.frmask ^= fr_mask;
1829
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1830
    }
1831
  cur->r.record.p.grmask = gr_mask;
1832
  for (;;)
1833
    {
1834
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1835
 
1836
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1837
      gr_mask &= ~(gr_mask & (~gr_mask + 1));
1838
      if (!gr_mask)
1839
        return ptr;
1840
      cur = alloc_record (frgr_mem);
1841
      cur->r.record.p.grmask = gr_mask;
1842
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1843
      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= gr_mask;
1844
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1845
    }
1846
}
1847
 
1848
static unw_rec_list *
1849
output_gr_gr (unsigned int mask, unsigned int reg)
1850
{
1851
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (gr_gr);
1852
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1853
 
1854
  ptr->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
1855
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = reg;
1856
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1857
  for (;;)
1858
    {
1859
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1860
 
1861
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1862
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1863
      if (!mask)
1864
        return ptr;
1865
      cur = alloc_record (gr_gr);
1866
      cur->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
1867
      /* Indicate this record shouldn't be output.  */
1868
      cur->r.record.p.r.gr = REG_NUM;
1869
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1870
      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= mask;
1871
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1872
    }
1873
}
1874
 
1875
static unw_rec_list *
1876
output_gr_mem (unsigned int mask)
1877
{
1878
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (gr_mem);
1879
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1880
 
1881
  ptr->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
1882
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1883
  for (;;)
1884
    {
1885
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1886
 
1887
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1888
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1889
      if (!mask)
1890
        return ptr;
1891
      cur = alloc_record (gr_mem);
1892
      cur->r.record.p.grmask = mask;
1893
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1894
      prev->r.record.p.grmask ^= mask;
1895
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1896
    }
1897
}
1898
 
1899
static unw_rec_list *
1900
output_br_mem (unsigned int mask)
1901
{
1902
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (br_mem);
1903
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1904
 
1905
  ptr->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
1906
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1907
  for (;;)
1908
    {
1909
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1910
 
1911
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1912
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1913
      if (!mask)
1914
        return ptr;
1915
      cur = alloc_record (br_mem);
1916
      cur->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
1917
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1918
      prev->r.record.p.brmask ^= mask;
1919
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1920
    }
1921
}
1922
 
1923
static unw_rec_list *
1924
output_br_gr (unsigned int mask, unsigned int reg)
1925
{
1926
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (br_gr);
1927
  unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
1928
 
1929
  ptr->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
1930
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = reg;
1931
  unwind.pending_saves = &ptr->r.record.p;
1932
  for (;;)
1933
    {
1934
      unw_rec_list *prev = cur;
1935
 
1936
      /* Clear least significant set bit.  */
1937
      mask &= ~(mask & (~mask + 1));
1938
      if (!mask)
1939
        return ptr;
1940
      cur = alloc_record (br_gr);
1941
      cur->r.record.p.brmask = mask;
1942
      /* Indicate this record shouldn't be output.  */
1943
      cur->r.record.p.r.gr = REG_NUM;
1944
      /* Retain only least significant bit.  */
1945
      prev->r.record.p.brmask ^= mask;
1946
      prev->r.record.p.next = cur;
1947
    }
1948
}
1949
 
1950
static unw_rec_list *
1951
output_spill_base (unsigned int offset)
1952
{
1953
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (spill_base);
1954
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1955
  return ptr;
1956
}
1957
 
1958
static unw_rec_list *
1959
output_unat_when (void)
1960
{
1961
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_when);
1962
  return ptr;
1963
}
1964
 
1965
static unw_rec_list *
1966
output_unat_gr (unsigned int gr)
1967
{
1968
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_gr);
1969
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
1970
  return ptr;
1971
}
1972
 
1973
static unw_rec_list *
1974
output_unat_psprel (unsigned int offset)
1975
{
1976
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_psprel);
1977
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
1978
  return ptr;
1979
}
1980
 
1981
static unw_rec_list *
1982
output_unat_sprel (unsigned int offset)
1983
{
1984
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unat_sprel);
1985
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
1986
  return ptr;
1987
}
1988
 
1989
static unw_rec_list *
1990
output_lc_when (void)
1991
{
1992
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_when);
1993
  return ptr;
1994
}
1995
 
1996
static unw_rec_list *
1997
output_lc_gr (unsigned int gr)
1998
{
1999
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_gr);
2000
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2001
  return ptr;
2002
}
2003
 
2004
static unw_rec_list *
2005
output_lc_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2006
{
2007
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_psprel);
2008
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2009
  return ptr;
2010
}
2011
 
2012
static unw_rec_list *
2013
output_lc_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2014
{
2015
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (lc_sprel);
2016
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2017
  return ptr;
2018
}
2019
 
2020
static unw_rec_list *
2021
output_fpsr_when (void)
2022
{
2023
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_when);
2024
  return ptr;
2025
}
2026
 
2027
static unw_rec_list *
2028
output_fpsr_gr (unsigned int gr)
2029
{
2030
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_gr);
2031
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2032
  return ptr;
2033
}
2034
 
2035
static unw_rec_list *
2036
output_fpsr_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2037
{
2038
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_psprel);
2039
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2040
  return ptr;
2041
}
2042
 
2043
static unw_rec_list *
2044
output_fpsr_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2045
{
2046
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (fpsr_sprel);
2047
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2048
  return ptr;
2049
}
2050
 
2051
static unw_rec_list *
2052
output_priunat_when_gr (void)
2053
{
2054
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_when_gr);
2055
  return ptr;
2056
}
2057
 
2058
static unw_rec_list *
2059
output_priunat_when_mem (void)
2060
{
2061
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_when_mem);
2062
  return ptr;
2063
}
2064
 
2065
static unw_rec_list *
2066
output_priunat_gr (unsigned int gr)
2067
{
2068
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_gr);
2069
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2070
  return ptr;
2071
}
2072
 
2073
static unw_rec_list *
2074
output_priunat_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2075
{
2076
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_psprel);
2077
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2078
  return ptr;
2079
}
2080
 
2081
static unw_rec_list *
2082
output_priunat_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2083
{
2084
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (priunat_sprel);
2085
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2086
  return ptr;
2087
}
2088
 
2089
static unw_rec_list *
2090
output_bsp_when (void)
2091
{
2092
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_when);
2093
  return ptr;
2094
}
2095
 
2096
static unw_rec_list *
2097
output_bsp_gr (unsigned int gr)
2098
{
2099
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_gr);
2100
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2101
  return ptr;
2102
}
2103
 
2104
static unw_rec_list *
2105
output_bsp_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2106
{
2107
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_psprel);
2108
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2109
  return ptr;
2110
}
2111
 
2112
static unw_rec_list *
2113
output_bsp_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2114
{
2115
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bsp_sprel);
2116
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2117
  return ptr;
2118
}
2119
 
2120
static unw_rec_list *
2121
output_bspstore_when (void)
2122
{
2123
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_when);
2124
  return ptr;
2125
}
2126
 
2127
static unw_rec_list *
2128
output_bspstore_gr (unsigned int gr)
2129
{
2130
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_gr);
2131
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2132
  return ptr;
2133
}
2134
 
2135
static unw_rec_list *
2136
output_bspstore_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2137
{
2138
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_psprel);
2139
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2140
  return ptr;
2141
}
2142
 
2143
static unw_rec_list *
2144
output_bspstore_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2145
{
2146
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (bspstore_sprel);
2147
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2148
  return ptr;
2149
}
2150
 
2151
static unw_rec_list *
2152
output_rnat_when (void)
2153
{
2154
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_when);
2155
  return ptr;
2156
}
2157
 
2158
static unw_rec_list *
2159
output_rnat_gr (unsigned int gr)
2160
{
2161
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_gr);
2162
  ptr->r.record.p.r.gr = gr;
2163
  return ptr;
2164
}
2165
 
2166
static unw_rec_list *
2167
output_rnat_psprel (unsigned int offset)
2168
{
2169
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_psprel);
2170
  ptr->r.record.p.off.psp = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2171
  return ptr;
2172
}
2173
 
2174
static unw_rec_list *
2175
output_rnat_sprel (unsigned int offset)
2176
{
2177
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (rnat_sprel);
2178
  ptr->r.record.p.off.sp = offset / 4;
2179
  return ptr;
2180
}
2181
 
2182
static unw_rec_list *
2183
output_unwabi (unsigned long abi, unsigned long context)
2184
{
2185
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (unwabi);
2186
  ptr->r.record.p.abi = abi;
2187
  ptr->r.record.p.context = context;
2188
  return ptr;
2189
}
2190
 
2191
static unw_rec_list *
2192
output_epilogue (unsigned long ecount)
2193
{
2194
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (epilogue);
2195
  ptr->r.record.b.ecount = ecount;
2196
  return ptr;
2197
}
2198
 
2199
static unw_rec_list *
2200
output_label_state (unsigned long label)
2201
{
2202
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (label_state);
2203
  ptr->r.record.b.label = label;
2204
  return ptr;
2205
}
2206
 
2207
static unw_rec_list *
2208
output_copy_state (unsigned long label)
2209
{
2210
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (copy_state);
2211
  ptr->r.record.b.label = label;
2212
  return ptr;
2213
}
2214
 
2215
static unw_rec_list *
2216
output_spill_psprel (unsigned int ab,
2217
                     unsigned int reg,
2218
                     unsigned int offset,
2219
                     unsigned int predicate)
2220
{
2221
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_psprel_p : spill_psprel);
2222
  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2223
  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2224
  ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff = ENCODED_PSP_OFFSET (offset);
2225
  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2226
  return ptr;
2227
}
2228
 
2229
static unw_rec_list *
2230
output_spill_sprel (unsigned int ab,
2231
                    unsigned int reg,
2232
                    unsigned int offset,
2233
                    unsigned int predicate)
2234
{
2235
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_sprel_p : spill_sprel);
2236
  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2237
  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2238
  ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff = offset / 4;
2239
  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2240
  return ptr;
2241
}
2242
 
2243
static unw_rec_list *
2244
output_spill_reg (unsigned int ab,
2245
                  unsigned int reg,
2246
                  unsigned int targ_reg,
2247
                  unsigned int xy,
2248
                  unsigned int predicate)
2249
{
2250
  unw_rec_list *ptr = alloc_record (predicate ? spill_reg_p : spill_reg);
2251
  ptr->r.record.x.ab = ab;
2252
  ptr->r.record.x.reg = reg;
2253
  ptr->r.record.x.where.reg = targ_reg;
2254
  ptr->r.record.x.xy = xy;
2255
  ptr->r.record.x.qp = predicate;
2256
  return ptr;
2257
}
2258
 
2259
/* Given a unw_rec_list process the correct format with the
2260
   specified function.  */
2261
 
2262
static void
2263
process_one_record (unw_rec_list *ptr, vbyte_func f)
2264
{
2265
  unsigned int fr_mask, gr_mask;
2266
 
2267
  switch (ptr->r.type)
2268
    {
2269
      /* This is a dummy record that takes up no space in the output.  */
2270
    case endp:
2271
      break;
2272
 
2273
    case gr_mem:
2274
    case fr_mem:
2275
    case br_mem:
2276
    case frgr_mem:
2277
      /* These are taken care of by prologue/prologue_gr.  */
2278
      break;
2279
 
2280
    case prologue_gr:
2281
    case prologue:
2282
      if (ptr->r.type == prologue_gr)
2283
        output_R2_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.grmask,
2284
                          ptr->r.record.r.grsave, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2285
      else
2286
        output_R1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2287
 
2288
      /* Output descriptor(s) for union of register spills (if any).  */
2289
      gr_mask = ptr->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem;
2290
      fr_mask = ptr->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem;
2291
      if (fr_mask)
2292
        {
2293
          if ((fr_mask & ~0xfUL) == 0)
2294
            output_P6_format (f, fr_mem, fr_mask);
2295
          else
2296
            {
2297
              output_P5_format (f, gr_mask, fr_mask);
2298
              gr_mask = 0;
2299
            }
2300
        }
2301
      if (gr_mask)
2302
        output_P6_format (f, gr_mem, gr_mask);
2303
      if (ptr->r.record.r.mask.br_mem)
2304
        output_P1_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.mask.br_mem);
2305
 
2306
      /* output imask descriptor if necessary:  */
2307
      if (ptr->r.record.r.mask.i)
2308
        output_P4_format (f, ptr->r.record.r.mask.i,
2309
                          ptr->r.record.r.imask_size);
2310
      break;
2311
 
2312
    case body:
2313
      output_R1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.r.rlen);
2314
      break;
2315
    case mem_stack_f:
2316
    case mem_stack_v:
2317
      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t,
2318
                        ptr->r.record.p.size);
2319
      break;
2320
    case psp_gr:
2321
    case rp_gr:
2322
    case pfs_gr:
2323
    case preds_gr:
2324
    case unat_gr:
2325
    case lc_gr:
2326
    case fpsr_gr:
2327
    case priunat_gr:
2328
    case bsp_gr:
2329
    case bspstore_gr:
2330
    case rnat_gr:
2331
      output_P3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2332
      break;
2333
    case rp_br:
2334
      output_P3_format (f, rp_br, ptr->r.record.p.r.br);
2335
      break;
2336
    case psp_sprel:
2337
      output_P7_format (f, psp_sprel, ptr->r.record.p.off.sp, 0);
2338
      break;
2339
    case rp_when:
2340
    case pfs_when:
2341
    case preds_when:
2342
    case unat_when:
2343
    case lc_when:
2344
    case fpsr_when:
2345
      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t, 0);
2346
      break;
2347
    case rp_psprel:
2348
    case pfs_psprel:
2349
    case preds_psprel:
2350
    case unat_psprel:
2351
    case lc_psprel:
2352
    case fpsr_psprel:
2353
    case spill_base:
2354
      output_P7_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.psp, 0);
2355
      break;
2356
    case rp_sprel:
2357
    case pfs_sprel:
2358
    case preds_sprel:
2359
    case unat_sprel:
2360
    case lc_sprel:
2361
    case fpsr_sprel:
2362
    case priunat_sprel:
2363
    case bsp_sprel:
2364
    case bspstore_sprel:
2365
    case rnat_sprel:
2366
      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.sp);
2367
      break;
2368
    case gr_gr:
2369
      if (ptr->r.record.p.r.gr < REG_NUM)
2370
        {
2371
          const unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2372
 
2373
          gr_mask = cur->r.record.p.grmask;
2374
          while ((cur = cur->r.record.p.next) != NULL)
2375
            gr_mask |= cur->r.record.p.grmask;
2376
          output_P9_format (f, gr_mask, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2377
        }
2378
      break;
2379
    case br_gr:
2380
      if (ptr->r.record.p.r.gr < REG_NUM)
2381
        {
2382
          const unw_rec_list *cur = ptr;
2383
 
2384
          gr_mask = cur->r.record.p.brmask;
2385
          while ((cur = cur->r.record.p.next) != NULL)
2386
            gr_mask |= cur->r.record.p.brmask;
2387
          output_P2_format (f, gr_mask, ptr->r.record.p.r.gr);
2388
        }
2389
      break;
2390
    case spill_mask:
2391
      as_bad (_("spill_mask record unimplemented."));
2392
      break;
2393
    case priunat_when_gr:
2394
    case priunat_when_mem:
2395
    case bsp_when:
2396
    case bspstore_when:
2397
    case rnat_when:
2398
      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.t);
2399
      break;
2400
    case priunat_psprel:
2401
    case bsp_psprel:
2402
    case bspstore_psprel:
2403
    case rnat_psprel:
2404
      output_P8_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.p.off.psp);
2405
      break;
2406
    case unwabi:
2407
      output_P10_format (f, ptr->r.record.p.abi, ptr->r.record.p.context);
2408
      break;
2409
    case epilogue:
2410
      output_B3_format (f, ptr->r.record.b.ecount, ptr->r.record.b.t);
2411
      break;
2412
    case label_state:
2413
    case copy_state:
2414
      output_B4_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.b.label);
2415
      break;
2416
    case spill_psprel:
2417
      output_X1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2418
                        ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t,
2419
                        ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff);
2420
      break;
2421
    case spill_sprel:
2422
      output_X1_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2423
                        ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t,
2424
                        ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff);
2425
      break;
2426
    case spill_reg:
2427
      output_X2_format (f, ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2428
                        ptr->r.record.x.xy >> 1, ptr->r.record.x.xy,
2429
                        ptr->r.record.x.where.reg, ptr->r.record.x.t);
2430
      break;
2431
    case spill_psprel_p:
2432
      output_X3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.qp,
2433
                        ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2434
                        ptr->r.record.x.t, ptr->r.record.x.where.pspoff);
2435
      break;
2436
    case spill_sprel_p:
2437
      output_X3_format (f, ptr->r.type, ptr->r.record.x.qp,
2438
                        ptr->r.record.x.ab, ptr->r.record.x.reg,
2439
                        ptr->r.record.x.t, ptr->r.record.x.where.spoff);
2440
      break;
2441
    case spill_reg_p:
2442
      output_X4_format (f, ptr->r.record.x.qp, ptr->r.record.x.ab,
2443
                        ptr->r.record.x.reg, ptr->r.record.x.xy >> 1,
2444
                        ptr->r.record.x.xy, ptr->r.record.x.where.reg,
2445
                        ptr->r.record.x.t);
2446
      break;
2447
    default:
2448
      as_bad (_("record_type_not_valid"));
2449
      break;
2450
    }
2451
}
2452
 
2453
/* Given a unw_rec_list list, process all the records with
2454
   the specified function.  */
2455
static void
2456
process_unw_records (unw_rec_list *list, vbyte_func f)
2457
{
2458
  unw_rec_list *ptr;
2459
  for (ptr = list; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
2460
    process_one_record (ptr, f);
2461
}
2462
 
2463
/* Determine the size of a record list in bytes.  */
2464
static int
2465
calc_record_size (unw_rec_list *list)
2466
{
2467
  vbyte_count = 0;
2468
  process_unw_records (list, count_output);
2469
  return vbyte_count;
2470
}
2471
 
2472
/* Return the number of bits set in the input value.
2473
   Perhaps this has a better place...  */
2474
#if __GNUC__ > 3 || (__GNUC__ == 3 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 4)
2475
# define popcount __builtin_popcount
2476
#else
2477
static int
2478
popcount (unsigned x)
2479
{
2480
  static const unsigned char popcnt[16] =
2481
    {
2482
      0, 1, 1, 2,
2483
      1, 2, 2, 3,
2484
      1, 2, 2, 3,
2485
      2, 3, 3, 4
2486
    };
2487
 
2488
  if (x < NELEMS (popcnt))
2489
    return popcnt[x];
2490
  return popcnt[x % NELEMS (popcnt)] + popcount (x / NELEMS (popcnt));
2491
}
2492
#endif
2493
 
2494
/* Update IMASK bitmask to reflect the fact that one or more registers
2495
   of type TYPE are saved starting at instruction with index T.  If N
2496
   bits are set in REGMASK, it is assumed that instructions T through
2497
   T+N-1 save these registers.
2498
 
2499
   TYPE values:
2500
        0: no save
2501
        1: instruction saves next fp reg
2502
        2: instruction saves next general reg
2503
        3: instruction saves next branch reg */
2504
static void
2505
set_imask (unw_rec_list *region,
2506
           unsigned long regmask,
2507
           unsigned long t,
2508
           unsigned int type)
2509
{
2510
  unsigned char *imask;
2511
  unsigned long imask_size;
2512
  unsigned int i;
2513
  int pos;
2514
 
2515
  imask = region->r.record.r.mask.i;
2516
  imask_size = region->r.record.r.imask_size;
2517
  if (!imask)
2518
    {
2519
      imask_size = (region->r.record.r.rlen * 2 + 7) / 8 + 1;
2520
      imask = xmalloc (imask_size);
2521
      memset (imask, 0, imask_size);
2522
 
2523
      region->r.record.r.imask_size = imask_size;
2524
      region->r.record.r.mask.i = imask;
2525
    }
2526
 
2527
  i = (t / 4) + 1;
2528
  pos = 2 * (3 - t % 4);
2529
  while (regmask)
2530
    {
2531
      if (i >= imask_size)
2532
        {
2533
          as_bad (_("Ignoring attempt to spill beyond end of region"));
2534
          return;
2535
        }
2536
 
2537
      imask[i] |= (type & 0x3) << pos;
2538
 
2539
      regmask &= (regmask - 1);
2540
      pos -= 2;
2541
      if (pos < 0)
2542
        {
2543
          pos = 0;
2544
          ++i;
2545
        }
2546
    }
2547
}
2548
 
2549
/* Return the number of instruction slots from FIRST_ADDR to SLOT_ADDR.
2550
   SLOT_FRAG is the frag containing SLOT_ADDR, and FIRST_FRAG is the frag
2551
   containing FIRST_ADDR.  If BEFORE_RELAX, then we use worst-case estimates
2552
   for frag sizes.  */
2553
 
2554
static unsigned long
2555
slot_index (unsigned long slot_addr,
2556
            fragS *slot_frag,
2557
            unsigned long first_addr,
2558
            fragS *first_frag,
2559
            int before_relax)
2560
{
2561
  unsigned long s_index = 0;
2562
 
2563
  /* First time we are called, the initial address and frag are invalid.  */
2564
  if (first_addr == 0)
2565
    return 0;
2566
 
2567
  /* If the two addresses are in different frags, then we need to add in
2568
     the remaining size of this frag, and then the entire size of intermediate
2569
     frags.  */
2570
  while (slot_frag != first_frag)
2571
    {
2572
      unsigned long start_addr = (unsigned long) &first_frag->fr_literal;
2573
 
2574
      if (! before_relax)
2575
        {
2576
          /* We can get the final addresses only during and after
2577
             relaxation.  */
2578
          if (first_frag->fr_next && first_frag->fr_next->fr_address)
2579
            s_index += 3 * ((first_frag->fr_next->fr_address
2580
                           - first_frag->fr_address
2581
                             - first_frag->fr_fix) >> 4);
2582
        }
2583
      else
2584
        /* We don't know what the final addresses will be. We try our
2585
           best to estimate.  */
2586
        switch (first_frag->fr_type)
2587
          {
2588
          default:
2589
            break;
2590
 
2591
          case rs_space:
2592
            as_fatal (_("Only constant space allocation is supported"));
2593
            break;
2594
 
2595
          case rs_align:
2596
          case rs_align_code:
2597
          case rs_align_test:
2598
            /* Take alignment into account.  Assume the worst case
2599
               before relaxation.  */
2600
            s_index += 3 * ((1 << first_frag->fr_offset) >> 4);
2601
            break;
2602
 
2603
          case rs_org:
2604
            if (first_frag->fr_symbol)
2605
              {
2606
                as_fatal (_("Only constant offsets are supported"));
2607
                break;
2608
              }
2609
          case rs_fill:
2610
            s_index += 3 * (first_frag->fr_offset >> 4);
2611
            break;
2612
          }
2613
 
2614
      /* Add in the full size of the frag converted to instruction slots.  */
2615
      s_index += 3 * (first_frag->fr_fix >> 4);
2616
      /* Subtract away the initial part before first_addr.  */
2617
      s_index -= (3 * ((first_addr >> 4) - (start_addr >> 4))
2618
                + ((first_addr & 0x3) - (start_addr & 0x3)));
2619
 
2620
      /* Move to the beginning of the next frag.  */
2621
      first_frag = first_frag->fr_next;
2622
      first_addr = (unsigned long) &first_frag->fr_literal;
2623
 
2624
      /* This can happen if there is section switching in the middle of a
2625
         function, causing the frag chain for the function to be broken.
2626
         It is too difficult to recover safely from this problem, so we just
2627
         exit with an error.  */
2628
      if (first_frag == NULL)
2629
        as_fatal (_("Section switching in code is not supported."));
2630
    }
2631
 
2632
  /* Add in the used part of the last frag.  */
2633
  s_index += (3 * ((slot_addr >> 4) - (first_addr >> 4))
2634
            + ((slot_addr & 0x3) - (first_addr & 0x3)));
2635
  return s_index;
2636
}
2637
 
2638
/* Optimize unwind record directives.  */
2639
 
2640
static unw_rec_list *
2641
optimize_unw_records (unw_rec_list *list)
2642
{
2643
  if (!list)
2644
    return NULL;
2645
 
2646
  /* If the only unwind record is ".prologue" or ".prologue" followed
2647
     by ".body", then we can optimize the unwind directives away.  */
2648
  if (list->r.type == prologue
2649
      && (list->next->r.type == endp
2650
          || (list->next->r.type == body && list->next->next->r.type == endp)))
2651
    return NULL;
2652
 
2653
  return list;
2654
}
2655
 
2656
/* Given a complete record list, process any records which have
2657
   unresolved fields, (ie length counts for a prologue).  After
2658
   this has been run, all necessary information should be available
2659
   within each record to generate an image.  */
2660
 
2661
static void
2662
fixup_unw_records (unw_rec_list *list, int before_relax)
2663
{
2664
  unw_rec_list *ptr, *region = 0;
2665
  unsigned long first_addr = 0, rlen = 0, t;
2666
  fragS *first_frag = 0;
2667
 
2668
  for (ptr = list; ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
2669
    {
2670
      if (ptr->slot_number == SLOT_NUM_NOT_SET)
2671
        as_bad (_(" Insn slot not set in unwind record."));
2672
      t = slot_index (ptr->slot_number, ptr->slot_frag,
2673
                      first_addr, first_frag, before_relax);
2674
      switch (ptr->r.type)
2675
        {
2676
        case prologue:
2677
        case prologue_gr:
2678
        case body:
2679
          {
2680
            unw_rec_list *last;
2681
            int size;
2682
            unsigned long last_addr = 0;
2683
            fragS *last_frag = NULL;
2684
 
2685
            first_addr = ptr->slot_number;
2686
            first_frag = ptr->slot_frag;
2687
            /* Find either the next body/prologue start, or the end of
2688
               the function, and determine the size of the region.  */
2689
            for (last = ptr->next; last != NULL; last = last->next)
2690
              if (last->r.type == prologue || last->r.type == prologue_gr
2691
                  || last->r.type == body || last->r.type == endp)
2692
                {
2693
                  last_addr = last->slot_number;
2694
                  last_frag = last->slot_frag;
2695
                  break;
2696
                }
2697
            size = slot_index (last_addr, last_frag, first_addr, first_frag,
2698
                               before_relax);
2699
            rlen = ptr->r.record.r.rlen = size;
2700
            if (ptr->r.type == body)
2701
              /* End of region.  */
2702
              region = 0;
2703
            else
2704
              region = ptr;
2705
            break;
2706
          }
2707
        case epilogue:
2708
          if (t < rlen)
2709
            ptr->r.record.b.t = rlen - 1 - t;
2710
          else
2711
            /* This happens when a memory-stack-less procedure uses a
2712
               ".restore sp" directive at the end of a region to pop
2713
               the frame state.  */
2714
            ptr->r.record.b.t = 0;
2715
          break;
2716
 
2717
        case mem_stack_f:
2718
        case mem_stack_v:
2719
        case rp_when:
2720
        case pfs_when:
2721
        case preds_when:
2722
        case unat_when:
2723
        case lc_when:
2724
        case fpsr_when:
2725
        case priunat_when_gr:
2726
        case priunat_when_mem:
2727
        case bsp_when:
2728
        case bspstore_when:
2729
        case rnat_when:
2730
          ptr->r.record.p.t = t;
2731
          break;
2732
 
2733
        case spill_reg:
2734
        case spill_sprel:
2735
        case spill_psprel:
2736
        case spill_reg_p:
2737
        case spill_sprel_p:
2738
        case spill_psprel_p:
2739
          ptr->r.record.x.t = t;
2740
          break;
2741
 
2742
        case frgr_mem:
2743
          if (!region)
2744
            {
2745
              as_bad (_("frgr_mem record before region record!"));
2746
              return;
2747
            }
2748
          region->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.frmask;
2749
          region->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.grmask;
2750
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.frmask, t, 1);
2751
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
2752
          break;
2753
        case fr_mem:
2754
          if (!region)
2755
            {
2756
              as_bad (_("fr_mem record before region record!"));
2757
              return;
2758
            }
2759
          region->r.record.r.mask.fr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.frmask;
2760
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.frmask, t, 1);
2761
          break;
2762
        case gr_mem:
2763
          if (!region)
2764
            {
2765
              as_bad (_("gr_mem record before region record!"));
2766
              return;
2767
            }
2768
          region->r.record.r.mask.gr_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.grmask;
2769
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
2770
          break;
2771
        case br_mem:
2772
          if (!region)
2773
            {
2774
              as_bad (_("br_mem record before region record!"));
2775
              return;
2776
            }
2777
          region->r.record.r.mask.br_mem |= ptr->r.record.p.brmask;
2778
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.brmask, t, 3);
2779
          break;
2780
 
2781
        case gr_gr:
2782
          if (!region)
2783
            {
2784
              as_bad (_("gr_gr record before region record!"));
2785
              return;
2786
            }
2787
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.grmask, t, 2);
2788
          break;
2789
        case br_gr:
2790
          if (!region)
2791
            {
2792
              as_bad (_("br_gr record before region record!"));
2793
              return;
2794
            }
2795
          set_imask (region, ptr->r.record.p.brmask, t, 3);
2796
          break;
2797
 
2798
        default:
2799
          break;
2800
        }
2801
    }
2802
}
2803
 
2804
/* Estimate the size of a frag before relaxing.  We only have one type of frag
2805
   to handle here, which is the unwind info frag.  */
2806
 
2807
int
2808
ia64_estimate_size_before_relax (fragS *frag,
2809
                                 asection *segtype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2810
{
2811
  unw_rec_list *list;
2812
  int len, size, pad;
2813
 
2814
  /* ??? This code is identical to the first part of ia64_convert_frag.  */
2815
  list = (unw_rec_list *) frag->fr_opcode;
2816
  fixup_unw_records (list, 0);
2817
 
2818
  len = calc_record_size (list);
2819
  /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
2820
  pad = len % md.pointer_size;
2821
  if (pad != 0)
2822
    len += md.pointer_size - pad;
2823
  /* Add 8 for the header.  */
2824
  size = len + 8;
2825
  /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
2826
  if (frag->fr_offset)
2827
    size += md.pointer_size;
2828
 
2829
  /* fr_var carries the max_chars that we created the fragment with.
2830
     We must, of course, have allocated enough memory earlier.  */
2831
  gas_assert (frag->fr_var >= size);
2832
 
2833
  return frag->fr_fix + size;
2834
}
2835
 
2836
/* This function converts a rs_machine_dependent variant frag into a
2837
  normal fill frag with the unwind image from the the record list.  */
2838
void
2839
ia64_convert_frag (fragS *frag)
2840
{
2841
  unw_rec_list *list;
2842
  int len, size, pad;
2843
  valueT flag_value;
2844
 
2845
  /* ??? This code is identical to ia64_estimate_size_before_relax.  */
2846
  list = (unw_rec_list *) frag->fr_opcode;
2847
  fixup_unw_records (list, 0);
2848
 
2849
  len = calc_record_size (list);
2850
  /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
2851
  pad = len % md.pointer_size;
2852
  if (pad != 0)
2853
    len += md.pointer_size - pad;
2854
  /* Add 8 for the header.  */
2855
  size = len + 8;
2856
  /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
2857
  if (frag->fr_offset)
2858
    size += md.pointer_size;
2859
 
2860
  /* fr_var carries the max_chars that we created the fragment with.
2861
     We must, of course, have allocated enough memory earlier.  */
2862
  gas_assert (frag->fr_var >= size);
2863
 
2864
  /* Initialize the header area. fr_offset is initialized with
2865
     unwind.personality_routine.  */
2866
  if (frag->fr_offset)
2867
    {
2868
      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
2869
        flag_value = (bfd_vma) 3 << 32;
2870
      else
2871
        /* 32-bit unwind info block.  */
2872
        flag_value = (bfd_vma) 0x1003 << 32;
2873
    }
2874
  else
2875
    flag_value = 0;
2876
 
2877
 md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal,
2878
                     (((bfd_vma) 1 << 48) /* Version.  */
2879
                      | flag_value        /* U & E handler flags.  */
2880
                      | (len / md.pointer_size)), /* Length.  */
2881
                     8);
2882
 
2883
  /* Skip the header.  */
2884
  vbyte_mem_ptr = frag->fr_literal + 8;
2885
  process_unw_records (list, output_vbyte_mem);
2886
 
2887
  /* Fill the padding bytes with zeros.  */
2888
  if (pad != 0)
2889
    md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal + len + 8 - md.pointer_size + pad, 0,
2890
                        md.pointer_size - pad);
2891
  /* Fill the unwind personality with zeros.  */
2892
  if (frag->fr_offset)
2893
    md_number_to_chars (frag->fr_literal + size - md.pointer_size, 0,
2894
                        md.pointer_size);
2895
 
2896
  frag->fr_fix += size;
2897
  frag->fr_type = rs_fill;
2898
  frag->fr_var = 0;
2899
  frag->fr_offset = 0;
2900
}
2901
 
2902
static int
2903
parse_predicate_and_operand (expressionS *e, unsigned *qp, const char *po)
2904
{
2905
  int sep = parse_operand_and_eval (e, ',');
2906
 
2907
  *qp = e->X_add_number - REG_P;
2908
  if (e->X_op != O_register || *qp > 63)
2909
    {
2910
      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s must be a predicate"), po);
2911
      *qp = 0;
2912
    }
2913
  else if (*qp == 0)
2914
    as_warn (_("Pointless use of p0 as first operand to .%s"), po);
2915
  if (sep == ',')
2916
    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (e, ',');
2917
  else
2918
    e->X_op = O_absent;
2919
  return sep;
2920
}
2921
 
2922
static void
2923
convert_expr_to_ab_reg (const expressionS *e,
2924
                        unsigned int *ab,
2925
                        unsigned int *regp,
2926
                        const char *po,
2927
                        int n)
2928
{
2929
  unsigned int reg = e->X_add_number;
2930
 
2931
  *ab = *regp = 0; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
2932
 
2933
  if (e->X_op != O_register)
2934
    reg = REG_GR; /* Anything invalid is good here.  */
2935
 
2936
  if (reg >= (REG_GR + 4) && reg <= (REG_GR + 7))
2937
    {
2938
      *ab = 0;
2939
      *regp = reg - REG_GR;
2940
    }
2941
  else if ((reg >= (REG_FR + 2) && reg <= (REG_FR + 5))
2942
           || (reg >= (REG_FR + 16) && reg <= (REG_FR + 31)))
2943
    {
2944
      *ab = 1;
2945
      *regp = reg - REG_FR;
2946
    }
2947
  else if (reg >= (REG_BR + 1) && reg <= (REG_BR + 5))
2948
    {
2949
      *ab = 2;
2950
      *regp = reg - REG_BR;
2951
    }
2952
  else
2953
    {
2954
      *ab = 3;
2955
      switch (reg)
2956
        {
2957
        case REG_PR:            *regp =  0; break;
2958
        case REG_PSP:           *regp =  1; break;
2959
        case REG_PRIUNAT:       *regp =  2; break;
2960
        case REG_BR + 0: *regp =  3; break;
2961
        case REG_AR + AR_BSP:   *regp =  4; break;
2962
        case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE: *regp = 5; break;
2963
        case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:  *regp =  6; break;
2964
        case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:  *regp =  7; break;
2965
        case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:  *regp =  8; break;
2966
        case REG_AR + AR_PFS:   *regp =  9; break;
2967
        case REG_AR + AR_LC:    *regp = 10; break;
2968
 
2969
        default:
2970
          as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a preserved register"), n, po);
2971
          break;
2972
        }
2973
    }
2974
}
2975
 
2976
static void
2977
convert_expr_to_xy_reg (const expressionS *e,
2978
                        unsigned int *xy,
2979
                        unsigned int *regp,
2980
                        const char *po,
2981
                        int n)
2982
{
2983
  unsigned int reg = e->X_add_number;
2984
 
2985
  *xy = *regp = 0; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
2986
 
2987
  if (e->X_op != O_register)
2988
    reg = REG_GR; /* Anything invalid is good here.  */
2989
 
2990
  if (reg >= (REG_GR + 1) && reg <= (REG_GR + 127))
2991
    {
2992
      *xy = 0;
2993
      *regp = reg - REG_GR;
2994
    }
2995
  else if (reg >= (REG_FR + 2) && reg <= (REG_FR + 127))
2996
    {
2997
      *xy = 1;
2998
      *regp = reg - REG_FR;
2999
    }
3000
  else if (reg >= REG_BR && reg <= (REG_BR + 7))
3001
    {
3002
      *xy = 2;
3003
      *regp = reg - REG_BR;
3004
    }
3005
  else
3006
    as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a writable register"), n, po);
3007
}
3008
 
3009
static void
3010
dot_align (int arg)
3011
{
3012
  /* The current frag is an alignment frag.  */
3013
  align_frag = frag_now;
3014
  s_align_bytes (arg);
3015
}
3016
 
3017
static void
3018
dot_radix (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3019
{
3020
  char *radix;
3021
  int ch;
3022
 
3023
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
3024
 
3025
  if (is_it_end_of_statement ())
3026
    return;
3027
  radix = input_line_pointer;
3028
  ch = get_symbol_end ();
3029
  ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (radix);
3030
  if (strcasecmp (radix, "C"))
3031
    as_bad (_("Radix `%s' unsupported or invalid"), radix);
3032
  *input_line_pointer = ch;
3033
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3034
}
3035
 
3036
/* Helper function for .loc directives.  If the assembler is not generating
3037
   line number info, then we need to remember which instructions have a .loc
3038
   directive, and only call dwarf2_gen_line_info for those instructions.  */
3039
 
3040
static void
3041
dot_loc (int x)
3042
{
3043
  CURR_SLOT.loc_directive_seen = 1;
3044
  dwarf2_directive_loc (x);
3045
}
3046
 
3047
/* .sbss, .bss etc. are macros that expand into ".section SECNAME".  */
3048
static void
3049
dot_special_section (int which)
3050
{
3051
  set_section ((char *) special_section_name[which]);
3052
}
3053
 
3054
/* Return -1 for warning and 0 for error.  */
3055
 
3056
static int
3057
unwind_diagnostic (const char * region, const char *directive)
3058
{
3059
  if (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning)
3060
    {
3061
      as_warn (_(".%s outside of %s"), directive, region);
3062
      return -1;
3063
    }
3064
  else
3065
    {
3066
      as_bad (_(".%s outside of %s"), directive, region);
3067
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
3068
      return 0;
3069
    }
3070
}
3071
 
3072
/* Return 1 if a directive is in a procedure, -1 if a directive isn't in
3073
   a procedure but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3074
   a directive isn't in a procedure and the unwind directive check is set
3075
   to error.  */
3076
 
3077
static int
3078
in_procedure (const char *directive)
3079
{
3080
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym
3081
      && (!unwind.saved_text_seg || strcmp (directive, "endp") == 0))
3082
    return 1;
3083
  return unwind_diagnostic ("procedure", directive);
3084
}
3085
 
3086
/* Return 1 if a directive is in a prologue, -1 if a directive isn't in
3087
   a prologue but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3088
   a directive isn't in a prologue and the unwind directive check is set
3089
   to error.  */
3090
 
3091
static int
3092
in_prologue (const char *directive)
3093
{
3094
  int in = in_procedure (directive);
3095
 
3096
  if (in > 0 && !unwind.prologue)
3097
    in = unwind_diagnostic ("prologue", directive);
3098
  check_pending_save ();
3099
  return in;
3100
}
3101
 
3102
/* Return 1 if a directive is in a body, -1 if a directive isn't in
3103
   a body but the unwind directive check is set to warning, 0 if
3104
   a directive isn't in a body and the unwind directive check is set
3105
   to error.  */
3106
 
3107
static int
3108
in_body (const char *directive)
3109
{
3110
  int in = in_procedure (directive);
3111
 
3112
  if (in > 0 && !unwind.body)
3113
    in = unwind_diagnostic ("body region", directive);
3114
  return in;
3115
}
3116
 
3117
static void
3118
add_unwind_entry (unw_rec_list *ptr, int sep)
3119
{
3120
  if (ptr)
3121
    {
3122
      if (unwind.tail)
3123
        unwind.tail->next = ptr;
3124
      else
3125
        unwind.list = ptr;
3126
      unwind.tail = ptr;
3127
 
3128
      /* The current entry can in fact be a chain of unwind entries.  */
3129
      if (unwind.current_entry == NULL)
3130
        unwind.current_entry = ptr;
3131
    }
3132
 
3133
  /* The current entry can in fact be a chain of unwind entries.  */
3134
  if (unwind.current_entry == NULL)
3135
    unwind.current_entry = ptr;
3136
 
3137
  if (sep == ',')
3138
    {
3139
      /* Parse a tag permitted for the current directive.  */
3140
      int ch;
3141
 
3142
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
3143
      ch = get_symbol_end ();
3144
      /* FIXME: For now, just issue a warning that this isn't implemented.  */
3145
      {
3146
        static int warned;
3147
 
3148
        if (!warned)
3149
          {
3150
            warned = 1;
3151
            as_warn (_("Tags on unwind pseudo-ops aren't supported, yet"));
3152
          }
3153
      }
3154
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
3155
    }
3156
  if (sep != NOT_A_CHAR)
3157
    demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3158
}
3159
 
3160
static void
3161
dot_fframe (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3162
{
3163
  expressionS e;
3164
  int sep;
3165
 
3166
  if (!in_prologue ("fframe"))
3167
    return;
3168
 
3169
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3170
 
3171
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3172
    {
3173
      as_bad (_("First operand to .fframe must be a constant"));
3174
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3175
    }
3176
  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_f (e.X_add_number), sep);
3177
}
3178
 
3179
static void
3180
dot_vframe (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3181
{
3182
  expressionS e;
3183
  unsigned reg;
3184
  int sep;
3185
 
3186
  if (!in_prologue ("vframe"))
3187
    return;
3188
 
3189
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3190
  reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3191
  if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3192
    {
3193
      as_bad (_("First operand to .vframe must be a general register"));
3194
      reg = 0;
3195
    }
3196
  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_v (), sep);
3197
  if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 2))
3198
    add_unwind_entry (output_psp_gr (reg), NOT_A_CHAR);
3199
  else if (reg != unwind.prologue_gr
3200
                  + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & (-2 << 1)))
3201
    as_warn (_("Operand of .vframe contradicts .prologue"));
3202
}
3203
 
3204
static void
3205
dot_vframesp (int psp)
3206
{
3207
  expressionS e;
3208
  int sep;
3209
 
3210
  if (psp)
3211
    as_warn (_(".vframepsp is meaningless, assuming .vframesp was meant"));
3212
 
3213
  if (!in_prologue ("vframesp"))
3214
    return;
3215
 
3216
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3217
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3218
    {
3219
      as_bad (_("Operand to .vframesp must be a constant (sp-relative offset)"));
3220
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3221
    }
3222
  add_unwind_entry (output_mem_stack_v (), sep);
3223
  add_unwind_entry (output_psp_sprel (e.X_add_number), NOT_A_CHAR);
3224
}
3225
 
3226
static void
3227
dot_save (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3228
{
3229
  expressionS e1, e2;
3230
  unsigned reg1, reg2;
3231
  int sep;
3232
 
3233
  if (!in_prologue ("save"))
3234
    return;
3235
 
3236
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
3237
  if (sep == ',')
3238
    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, ',');
3239
  else
3240
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3241
 
3242
  reg1 = e1.X_add_number;
3243
  /* Make sure its a valid ar.xxx reg, OR its br0, aka 'rp'.  */
3244
  if (e1.X_op != O_register)
3245
    {
3246
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save not a register"));
3247
      reg1 = REG_PR; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3248
    }
3249
  reg2 = e2.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3250
  if (e2.X_op != O_register || reg2 > 127)
3251
    {
3252
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .save not a valid register"));
3253
      reg2 = 0;
3254
    }
3255
  switch (reg1)
3256
    {
3257
    case REG_AR + AR_BSP:
3258
      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_when (), sep);
3259
      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3260
      break;
3261
    case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE:
3262
      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_when (), sep);
3263
      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3264
      break;
3265
    case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:
3266
      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_when (), sep);
3267
      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3268
      break;
3269
    case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:
3270
      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_when (), sep);
3271
      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3272
      break;
3273
    case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:
3274
      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_when (), sep);
3275
      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3276
      break;
3277
    case REG_AR + AR_PFS:
3278
      add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_when (), sep);
3279
      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 4))
3280
        add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3281
      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr
3282
                       + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & (-4 << 1)))
3283
        as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3284
      break;
3285
    case REG_AR + AR_LC:
3286
      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_when (), sep);
3287
      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3288
      break;
3289
    case REG_BR:
3290
      add_unwind_entry (output_rp_when (), sep);
3291
      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 8))
3292
        add_unwind_entry (output_rp_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3293
      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr)
3294
        as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3295
      break;
3296
    case REG_PR:
3297
      add_unwind_entry (output_preds_when (), sep);
3298
      if (! (unwind.prologue_mask & 1))
3299
        add_unwind_entry (output_preds_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3300
      else if (reg2 != unwind.prologue_gr
3301
                       + (unsigned) popcount (unwind.prologue_mask & (-1 << 1)))
3302
        as_warn (_("Second operand of .save contradicts .prologue"));
3303
      break;
3304
    case REG_PRIUNAT:
3305
      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_when_gr (), sep);
3306
      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_gr (reg2), NOT_A_CHAR);
3307
      break;
3308
    default:
3309
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save not a valid register"));
3310
      add_unwind_entry (NULL, sep);
3311
      break;
3312
    }
3313
}
3314
 
3315
static void
3316
dot_restore (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3317
{
3318
  expressionS e1;
3319
  unsigned long ecount; /* # of _additional_ regions to pop */
3320
  int sep;
3321
 
3322
  if (!in_body ("restore"))
3323
    return;
3324
 
3325
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
3326
  if (e1.X_op != O_register || e1.X_add_number != REG_GR + 12)
3327
    as_bad (_("First operand to .restore must be stack pointer (sp)"));
3328
 
3329
  if (sep == ',')
3330
    {
3331
      expressionS e2;
3332
 
3333
      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, ',');
3334
      if (e2.X_op != O_constant || e2.X_add_number < 0)
3335
        {
3336
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .restore must be a constant >= 0"));
3337
          e2.X_add_number = 0;
3338
        }
3339
      ecount = e2.X_add_number;
3340
    }
3341
  else
3342
    ecount = unwind.prologue_count - 1;
3343
 
3344
  if (ecount >= unwind.prologue_count)
3345
    {
3346
      as_bad (_("Epilogue count of %lu exceeds number of nested prologues (%u)"),
3347
              ecount + 1, unwind.prologue_count);
3348
      ecount = 0;
3349
    }
3350
 
3351
  add_unwind_entry (output_epilogue (ecount), sep);
3352
 
3353
  if (ecount < unwind.prologue_count)
3354
    unwind.prologue_count -= ecount + 1;
3355
  else
3356
    unwind.prologue_count = 0;
3357
}
3358
 
3359
static void
3360
dot_restorereg (int pred)
3361
{
3362
  unsigned int qp, ab, reg;
3363
  expressionS e;
3364
  int sep;
3365
  const char * const po = pred ? "restorereg.p" : "restorereg";
3366
 
3367
  if (!in_procedure (po))
3368
    return;
3369
 
3370
  if (pred)
3371
    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
3372
  else
3373
    {
3374
      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3375
      qp = 0;
3376
    }
3377
  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
3378
 
3379
  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_reg (ab, reg, 0, 0, qp), sep);
3380
}
3381
 
3382
static char *special_linkonce_name[] =
3383
  {
3384
    ".gnu.linkonce.ia64unw.", ".gnu.linkonce.ia64unwi."
3385
  };
3386
 
3387
static void
3388
start_unwind_section (const segT text_seg, int sec_index)
3389
{
3390
  /*
3391
    Use a slightly ugly scheme to derive the unwind section names from
3392
    the text section name:
3393
 
3394
    text sect.  unwind table sect.
3395
    name:       name:                      comments:
3396
    ----------  -----------------          --------------------------------
3397
    .text       .IA_64.unwind
3398
    .text.foo   .IA_64.unwind.text.foo
3399
    .foo        .IA_64.unwind.foo
3400
    .gnu.linkonce.t.foo
3401
                .gnu.linkonce.ia64unw.foo
3402
    _info       .IA_64.unwind_info         gas issues error message (ditto)
3403
    _infoFOO    .IA_64.unwind_infoFOO      gas issues error message (ditto)
3404
 
3405
    This mapping is done so that:
3406
 
3407
        (a) An object file with unwind info only in .text will use
3408
            unwind section names .IA_64.unwind and .IA_64.unwind_info.
3409
            This follows the letter of the ABI and also ensures backwards
3410
            compatibility with older toolchains.
3411
 
3412
        (b) An object file with unwind info in multiple text sections
3413
            will use separate unwind sections for each text section.
3414
            This allows us to properly set the "sh_info" and "sh_link"
3415
            fields in SHT_IA_64_UNWIND as required by the ABI and also
3416
            lets GNU ld support programs with multiple segments
3417
            containing unwind info (as might be the case for certain
3418
            embedded applications).
3419
 
3420
        (c) An error is issued if there would be a name clash.
3421
  */
3422
 
3423
  const char *text_name, *sec_text_name;
3424
  char *sec_name;
3425
  const char *prefix = special_section_name [sec_index];
3426
  const char *suffix;
3427
  size_t prefix_len, suffix_len, sec_name_len;
3428
 
3429
  sec_text_name = segment_name (text_seg);
3430
  text_name = sec_text_name;
3431
  if (strncmp (text_name, "_info", 5) == 0)
3432
    {
3433
      as_bad (_("Illegal section name `%s' (causes unwind section name clash)"),
3434
              text_name);
3435
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
3436
      return;
3437
    }
3438
  if (strcmp (text_name, ".text") == 0)
3439
    text_name = "";
3440
 
3441
  /* Build the unwind section name by appending the (possibly stripped)
3442
     text section name to the unwind prefix.  */
3443
  suffix = text_name;
3444
  if (strncmp (text_name, ".gnu.linkonce.t.",
3445
               sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.t.") - 1) == 0)
3446
    {
3447
      prefix = special_linkonce_name [sec_index - SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND];
3448
      suffix += sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.t.") - 1;
3449
    }
3450
 
3451
  prefix_len = strlen (prefix);
3452
  suffix_len = strlen (suffix);
3453
  sec_name_len = prefix_len + suffix_len;
3454
  sec_name = alloca (sec_name_len + 1);
3455
  memcpy (sec_name, prefix, prefix_len);
3456
  memcpy (sec_name + prefix_len, suffix, suffix_len);
3457
  sec_name [sec_name_len] = '\0';
3458
 
3459
  /* Handle COMDAT group.  */
3460
  if ((text_seg->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE) != 0
3461
      && (elf_section_flags (text_seg) & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
3462
    {
3463
      char *section;
3464
      size_t len, group_name_len;
3465
      const char *group_name = elf_group_name (text_seg);
3466
 
3467
      if (group_name == NULL)
3468
        {
3469
          as_bad (_("Group section `%s' has no group signature"),
3470
                  sec_text_name);
3471
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
3472
          return;
3473
        }
3474
      /* We have to construct a fake section directive. */
3475
      group_name_len = strlen (group_name);
3476
      len = (sec_name_len
3477
             + 16                       /* ,"aG",@progbits,  */
3478
             + group_name_len           /* ,group_name  */
3479
             + 7);                      /* ,comdat  */
3480
 
3481
      section = alloca (len + 1);
3482
      memcpy (section, sec_name, sec_name_len);
3483
      memcpy (section + sec_name_len, ",\"aG\",@progbits,", 16);
3484
      memcpy (section + sec_name_len + 16, group_name, group_name_len);
3485
      memcpy (section + len - 7, ",comdat", 7);
3486
      section [len] = '\0';
3487
      set_section (section);
3488
    }
3489
  else
3490
    {
3491
      set_section (sec_name);
3492
      bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg,
3493
                             SEC_LOAD | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY);
3494
    }
3495
 
3496
  elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) = text_seg;
3497
}
3498
 
3499
static void
3500
generate_unwind_image (const segT text_seg)
3501
{
3502
  int size, pad;
3503
  unw_rec_list *list;
3504
 
3505
  /* Mark the end of the unwind info, so that we can compute the size of the
3506
     last unwind region.  */
3507
  add_unwind_entry (output_endp (), NOT_A_CHAR);
3508
 
3509
  /* Force out pending instructions, to make sure all unwind records have
3510
     a valid slot_number field.  */
3511
  ia64_flush_insns ();
3512
 
3513
  /* Generate the unwind record.  */
3514
  list = optimize_unw_records (unwind.list);
3515
  fixup_unw_records (list, 1);
3516
  size = calc_record_size (list);
3517
 
3518
  if (size > 0 || unwind.force_unwind_entry)
3519
    {
3520
      unwind.force_unwind_entry = 0;
3521
      /* pad to pointer-size boundary.  */
3522
      pad = size % md.pointer_size;
3523
      if (pad != 0)
3524
        size += md.pointer_size - pad;
3525
      /* Add 8 for the header.  */
3526
      size += 8;
3527
      /* Add a pointer for the personality offset.  */
3528
      if (unwind.personality_routine)
3529
        size += md.pointer_size;
3530
    }
3531
 
3532
  /* If there are unwind records, switch sections, and output the info.  */
3533
  if (size != 0)
3534
    {
3535
      expressionS exp;
3536
      bfd_reloc_code_real_type reloc;
3537
 
3538
      start_unwind_section (text_seg, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO);
3539
 
3540
      /* Make sure the section has 4 byte alignment for ILP32 and
3541
         8 byte alignment for LP64.  */
3542
      frag_align (md.pointer_size_shift, 0, 0);
3543
      record_alignment (now_seg, md.pointer_size_shift);
3544
 
3545
      /* Set expression which points to start of unwind descriptor area.  */
3546
      unwind.info = expr_build_dot ();
3547
 
3548
      frag_var (rs_machine_dependent, size, size, 0, 0,
3549
                (offsetT) (long) unwind.personality_routine,
3550
                (char *) list);
3551
 
3552
      /* Add the personality address to the image.  */
3553
      if (unwind.personality_routine != 0)
3554
        {
3555
          exp.X_op = O_symbol;
3556
          exp.X_add_symbol = unwind.personality_routine;
3557
          exp.X_add_number = 0;
3558
 
3559
          if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_BE)
3560
            {
3561
              if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3562
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64MSB;
3563
              else
3564
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32MSB;
3565
            }
3566
          else
3567
            {
3568
              if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
3569
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64LSB;
3570
              else
3571
                reloc = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32LSB;
3572
            }
3573
 
3574
          fix_new_exp (frag_now, frag_now_fix () - md.pointer_size,
3575
                       md.pointer_size, &exp, 0, reloc);
3576
          unwind.personality_routine = 0;
3577
        }
3578
    }
3579
 
3580
  free_saved_prologue_counts ();
3581
  unwind.list = unwind.tail = unwind.current_entry = NULL;
3582
}
3583
 
3584
static void
3585
dot_handlerdata (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3586
{
3587
  if (!in_procedure ("handlerdata"))
3588
    return;
3589
  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
3590
 
3591
  /* Remember which segment we're in so we can switch back after .endp */
3592
  unwind.saved_text_seg = now_seg;
3593
  unwind.saved_text_subseg = now_subseg;
3594
 
3595
  /* Generate unwind info into unwind-info section and then leave that
3596
     section as the currently active one so dataXX directives go into
3597
     the language specific data area of the unwind info block.  */
3598
  generate_unwind_image (now_seg);
3599
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3600
}
3601
 
3602
static void
3603
dot_unwentry (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3604
{
3605
  if (!in_procedure ("unwentry"))
3606
    return;
3607
  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
3608
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
3609
}
3610
 
3611
static void
3612
dot_altrp (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3613
{
3614
  expressionS e;
3615
  unsigned reg;
3616
 
3617
  if (!in_prologue ("altrp"))
3618
    return;
3619
 
3620
  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3621
  reg = e.X_add_number - REG_BR;
3622
  if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 7)
3623
    {
3624
      as_bad (_("First operand to .altrp not a valid branch register"));
3625
      reg = 0;
3626
    }
3627
  add_unwind_entry (output_rp_br (reg), 0);
3628
}
3629
 
3630
static void
3631
dot_savemem (int psprel)
3632
{
3633
  expressionS e1, e2;
3634
  int sep;
3635
  int reg1, val;
3636
  const char * const po = psprel ? "savepsp" : "savesp";
3637
 
3638
  if (!in_prologue (po))
3639
    return;
3640
 
3641
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
3642
  if (sep == ',')
3643
    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, ',');
3644
  else
3645
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3646
 
3647
  reg1 = e1.X_add_number;
3648
  val = e2.X_add_number;
3649
 
3650
  /* Make sure its a valid ar.xxx reg, OR its br0, aka 'rp'.  */
3651
  if (e1.X_op != O_register)
3652
    {
3653
      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s not a register"), po);
3654
      reg1 = REG_PR; /* Anything valid is good here.  */
3655
    }
3656
  if (e2.X_op != O_constant)
3657
    {
3658
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .%s not a constant"), po);
3659
      val = 0;
3660
    }
3661
 
3662
  switch (reg1)
3663
    {
3664
    case REG_AR + AR_BSP:
3665
      add_unwind_entry (output_bsp_when (), sep);
3666
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3667
                         ? output_bsp_psprel
3668
                         : output_bsp_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3669
      break;
3670
    case REG_AR + AR_BSPSTORE:
3671
      add_unwind_entry (output_bspstore_when (), sep);
3672
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3673
                         ? output_bspstore_psprel
3674
                         : output_bspstore_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3675
      break;
3676
    case REG_AR + AR_RNAT:
3677
      add_unwind_entry (output_rnat_when (), sep);
3678
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3679
                         ? output_rnat_psprel
3680
                         : output_rnat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3681
      break;
3682
    case REG_AR + AR_UNAT:
3683
      add_unwind_entry (output_unat_when (), sep);
3684
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3685
                         ? output_unat_psprel
3686
                         : output_unat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3687
      break;
3688
    case REG_AR + AR_FPSR:
3689
      add_unwind_entry (output_fpsr_when (), sep);
3690
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3691
                         ? output_fpsr_psprel
3692
                         : output_fpsr_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3693
      break;
3694
    case REG_AR + AR_PFS:
3695
      add_unwind_entry (output_pfs_when (), sep);
3696
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3697
                         ? output_pfs_psprel
3698
                         : output_pfs_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3699
      break;
3700
    case REG_AR + AR_LC:
3701
      add_unwind_entry (output_lc_when (), sep);
3702
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3703
                         ? output_lc_psprel
3704
                         : output_lc_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3705
      break;
3706
    case REG_BR:
3707
      add_unwind_entry (output_rp_when (), sep);
3708
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3709
                         ? output_rp_psprel
3710
                         : output_rp_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3711
      break;
3712
    case REG_PR:
3713
      add_unwind_entry (output_preds_when (), sep);
3714
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3715
                         ? output_preds_psprel
3716
                         : output_preds_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3717
      break;
3718
    case REG_PRIUNAT:
3719
      add_unwind_entry (output_priunat_when_mem (), sep);
3720
      add_unwind_entry ((psprel
3721
                         ? output_priunat_psprel
3722
                         : output_priunat_sprel) (val), NOT_A_CHAR);
3723
      break;
3724
    default:
3725
      as_bad (_("First operand to .%s not a valid register"), po);
3726
      add_unwind_entry (NULL, sep);
3727
      break;
3728
    }
3729
}
3730
 
3731
static void
3732
dot_saveg (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3733
{
3734
  expressionS e;
3735
  unsigned grmask;
3736
  int sep;
3737
 
3738
  if (!in_prologue ("save.g"))
3739
    return;
3740
 
3741
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3742
 
3743
  grmask = e.X_add_number;
3744
  if (e.X_op != O_constant
3745
      || e.X_add_number <= 0
3746
      || e.X_add_number > 0xf)
3747
    {
3748
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.g must be a positive 4-bit constant"));
3749
      grmask = 0;
3750
    }
3751
 
3752
  if (sep == ',')
3753
    {
3754
      unsigned reg;
3755
      int n = popcount (grmask);
3756
 
3757
      parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3758
      reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3759
      if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3760
        {
3761
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.g must be a general register"));
3762
          reg = 0;
3763
        }
3764
      else if (reg > 128U - n)
3765
        {
3766
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.g must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
3767
          reg = 0;
3768
        }
3769
      add_unwind_entry (output_gr_gr (grmask, reg), 0);
3770
    }
3771
  else
3772
    add_unwind_entry (output_gr_mem (grmask), 0);
3773
}
3774
 
3775
static void
3776
dot_savef (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3777
{
3778
  expressionS e;
3779
 
3780
  if (!in_prologue ("save.f"))
3781
    return;
3782
 
3783
  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3784
 
3785
  if (e.X_op != O_constant
3786
      || e.X_add_number <= 0
3787
      || e.X_add_number > 0xfffff)
3788
    {
3789
      as_bad (_("Operand to .save.f must be a positive 20-bit constant"));
3790
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3791
    }
3792
  add_unwind_entry (output_fr_mem (e.X_add_number), 0);
3793
}
3794
 
3795
static void
3796
dot_saveb (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3797
{
3798
  expressionS e;
3799
  unsigned brmask;
3800
  int sep;
3801
 
3802
  if (!in_prologue ("save.b"))
3803
    return;
3804
 
3805
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3806
 
3807
  brmask = e.X_add_number;
3808
  if (e.X_op != O_constant
3809
      || e.X_add_number <= 0
3810
      || e.X_add_number > 0x1f)
3811
    {
3812
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.b must be a positive 5-bit constant"));
3813
      brmask = 0;
3814
    }
3815
 
3816
  if (sep == ',')
3817
    {
3818
      unsigned reg;
3819
      int n = popcount (brmask);
3820
 
3821
      parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3822
      reg = e.X_add_number - REG_GR;
3823
      if (e.X_op != O_register || reg > 127)
3824
        {
3825
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.b must be a general register"));
3826
          reg = 0;
3827
        }
3828
      else if (reg > 128U - n)
3829
        {
3830
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.b must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
3831
          reg = 0;
3832
        }
3833
      add_unwind_entry (output_br_gr (brmask, reg), 0);
3834
    }
3835
  else
3836
    add_unwind_entry (output_br_mem (brmask), 0);
3837
}
3838
 
3839
static void
3840
dot_savegf (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3841
{
3842
  expressionS e1, e2;
3843
 
3844
  if (!in_prologue ("save.gf"))
3845
    return;
3846
 
3847
  if (parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',') == ',')
3848
    parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, 0);
3849
  else
3850
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
3851
 
3852
  if (e1.X_op != O_constant
3853
      || e1.X_add_number < 0
3854
      || e1.X_add_number > 0xf)
3855
    {
3856
      as_bad (_("First operand to .save.gf must be a non-negative 4-bit constant"));
3857
      e1.X_op = O_absent;
3858
      e1.X_add_number = 0;
3859
    }
3860
  if (e2.X_op != O_constant
3861
      || e2.X_add_number < 0
3862
      || e2.X_add_number > 0xfffff)
3863
    {
3864
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .save.gf must be a non-negative 20-bit constant"));
3865
      e2.X_op = O_absent;
3866
      e2.X_add_number = 0;
3867
    }
3868
  if (e1.X_op == O_constant
3869
      && e2.X_op == O_constant
3870
      && e1.X_add_number == 0
3871
      && e2.X_add_number == 0)
3872
    as_bad (_("Operands to .save.gf may not be both zero"));
3873
 
3874
  add_unwind_entry (output_frgr_mem (e1.X_add_number, e2.X_add_number), 0);
3875
}
3876
 
3877
static void
3878
dot_spill (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3879
{
3880
  expressionS e;
3881
 
3882
  if (!in_prologue ("spill"))
3883
    return;
3884
 
3885
  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
3886
 
3887
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3888
    {
3889
      as_bad (_("Operand to .spill must be a constant"));
3890
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3891
    }
3892
  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_base (e.X_add_number), 0);
3893
}
3894
 
3895
static void
3896
dot_spillreg (int pred)
3897
{
3898
  int sep;
3899
  unsigned int qp, ab, xy, reg, treg;
3900
  expressionS e;
3901
  const char * const po = pred ? "spillreg.p" : "spillreg";
3902
 
3903
  if (!in_procedure (po))
3904
    return;
3905
 
3906
  if (pred)
3907
    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
3908
  else
3909
    {
3910
      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3911
      qp = 0;
3912
    }
3913
  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
3914
 
3915
  if (sep == ',')
3916
    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3917
  else
3918
    e.X_op = O_absent;
3919
  convert_expr_to_xy_reg (&e, &xy, &treg, po, 2 + pred);
3920
 
3921
  add_unwind_entry (output_spill_reg (ab, reg, treg, xy, qp), sep);
3922
}
3923
 
3924
static void
3925
dot_spillmem (int psprel)
3926
{
3927
  expressionS e;
3928
  int pred = (psprel < 0), sep;
3929
  unsigned int qp, ab, reg;
3930
  const char * po;
3931
 
3932
  if (pred)
3933
    {
3934
      psprel = ~psprel;
3935
      po = psprel ? "spillpsp.p" : "spillsp.p";
3936
    }
3937
  else
3938
    po = psprel ? "spillpsp" : "spillsp";
3939
 
3940
  if (!in_procedure (po))
3941
    return;
3942
 
3943
  if (pred)
3944
    sep = parse_predicate_and_operand (&e, &qp, po);
3945
  else
3946
    {
3947
      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3948
      qp = 0;
3949
    }
3950
  convert_expr_to_ab_reg (&e, &ab, &reg, po, 1 + pred);
3951
 
3952
  if (sep == ',')
3953
    sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
3954
  else
3955
    e.X_op = O_absent;
3956
  if (e.X_op != O_constant)
3957
    {
3958
      as_bad (_("Operand %d to .%s must be a constant"), 2 + pred, po);
3959
      e.X_add_number = 0;
3960
    }
3961
 
3962
  if (psprel)
3963
    add_unwind_entry (output_spill_psprel (ab, reg, e.X_add_number, qp), sep);
3964
  else
3965
    add_unwind_entry (output_spill_sprel (ab, reg, e.X_add_number, qp), sep);
3966
}
3967
 
3968
static unsigned int
3969
get_saved_prologue_count (unsigned long lbl)
3970
{
3971
  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
3972
 
3973
  while (lpc != NULL && lpc->label_number != lbl)
3974
    lpc = lpc->next;
3975
 
3976
  if (lpc != NULL)
3977
    return lpc->prologue_count;
3978
 
3979
  as_bad (_("Missing .label_state %ld"), lbl);
3980
  return 1;
3981
}
3982
 
3983
static void
3984
save_prologue_count (unsigned long lbl, unsigned int count)
3985
{
3986
  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
3987
 
3988
  while (lpc != NULL && lpc->label_number != lbl)
3989
    lpc = lpc->next;
3990
 
3991
  if (lpc != NULL)
3992
    lpc->prologue_count = count;
3993
  else
3994
    {
3995
      label_prologue_count *new_lpc = xmalloc (sizeof (* new_lpc));
3996
 
3997
      new_lpc->next = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
3998
      new_lpc->label_number = lbl;
3999
      new_lpc->prologue_count = count;
4000
      unwind.saved_prologue_counts = new_lpc;
4001
    }
4002
}
4003
 
4004
static void
4005
free_saved_prologue_counts ()
4006
{
4007
  label_prologue_count *lpc = unwind.saved_prologue_counts;
4008
  label_prologue_count *next;
4009
 
4010
  while (lpc != NULL)
4011
    {
4012
      next = lpc->next;
4013
      free (lpc);
4014
      lpc = next;
4015
    }
4016
 
4017
  unwind.saved_prologue_counts = NULL;
4018
}
4019
 
4020
static void
4021
dot_label_state (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4022
{
4023
  expressionS e;
4024
 
4025
  if (!in_body ("label_state"))
4026
    return;
4027
 
4028
  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4029
  if (e.X_op == O_constant)
4030
    save_prologue_count (e.X_add_number, unwind.prologue_count);
4031
  else
4032
    {
4033
      as_bad (_("Operand to .label_state must be a constant"));
4034
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4035
    }
4036
  add_unwind_entry (output_label_state (e.X_add_number), 0);
4037
}
4038
 
4039
static void
4040
dot_copy_state (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4041
{
4042
  expressionS e;
4043
 
4044
  if (!in_body ("copy_state"))
4045
    return;
4046
 
4047
  parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4048
  if (e.X_op == O_constant)
4049
    unwind.prologue_count = get_saved_prologue_count (e.X_add_number);
4050
  else
4051
    {
4052
      as_bad (_("Operand to .copy_state must be a constant"));
4053
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4054
    }
4055
  add_unwind_entry (output_copy_state (e.X_add_number), 0);
4056
}
4057
 
4058
static void
4059
dot_unwabi (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4060
{
4061
  expressionS e1, e2;
4062
  unsigned char sep;
4063
 
4064
  if (!in_prologue ("unwabi"))
4065
    return;
4066
 
4067
  sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e1, ',');
4068
  if (sep == ',')
4069
    parse_operand_and_eval (&e2, 0);
4070
  else
4071
    e2.X_op = O_absent;
4072
 
4073
  if (e1.X_op != O_constant)
4074
    {
4075
      as_bad (_("First operand to .unwabi must be a constant"));
4076
      e1.X_add_number = 0;
4077
    }
4078
 
4079
  if (e2.X_op != O_constant)
4080
    {
4081
      as_bad (_("Second operand to .unwabi must be a constant"));
4082
      e2.X_add_number = 0;
4083
    }
4084
 
4085
  add_unwind_entry (output_unwabi (e1.X_add_number, e2.X_add_number), 0);
4086
}
4087
 
4088
static void
4089
dot_personality (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4090
{
4091
  char *name, *p, c;
4092
  if (!in_procedure ("personality"))
4093
    return;
4094
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4095
  name = input_line_pointer;
4096
  c = get_symbol_end ();
4097
  p = input_line_pointer;
4098
  unwind.personality_routine = symbol_find_or_make (name);
4099
  unwind.force_unwind_entry = 1;
4100
  *p = c;
4101
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4102
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4103
}
4104
 
4105
static void
4106
dot_proc (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4107
{
4108
  char *name, *p, c;
4109
  symbolS *sym;
4110
  proc_pending *pending, *last_pending;
4111
 
4112
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4113
    {
4114
      (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning
4115
       ? as_warn
4116
       : as_bad) (_("Missing .endp after previous .proc"));
4117
      while (unwind.proc_pending.next)
4118
        {
4119
          pending = unwind.proc_pending.next;
4120
          unwind.proc_pending.next = pending->next;
4121
          free (pending);
4122
        }
4123
    }
4124
  last_pending = NULL;
4125
 
4126
  /* Parse names of main and alternate entry points and mark them as
4127
     function symbols:  */
4128
  while (1)
4129
    {
4130
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4131
      name = input_line_pointer;
4132
      c = get_symbol_end ();
4133
      p = input_line_pointer;
4134
      if (!*name)
4135
        as_bad (_("Empty argument of .proc"));
4136
      else
4137
        {
4138
          sym = symbol_find_or_make (name);
4139
          if (S_IS_DEFINED (sym))
4140
            as_bad (_("`%s' was already defined"), name);
4141
          else if (!last_pending)
4142
            {
4143
              unwind.proc_pending.sym = sym;
4144
              last_pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4145
            }
4146
          else
4147
            {
4148
              pending = xmalloc (sizeof (*pending));
4149
              pending->sym = sym;
4150
              last_pending = last_pending->next = pending;
4151
            }
4152
          symbol_get_bfdsym (sym)->flags |= BSF_FUNCTION;
4153
        }
4154
      *p = c;
4155
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4156
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4157
        break;
4158
      ++input_line_pointer;
4159
    }
4160
  if (!last_pending)
4161
    {
4162
      unwind.proc_pending.sym = expr_build_dot ();
4163
      last_pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4164
    }
4165
  last_pending->next = NULL;
4166
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4167
  ia64_do_align (16);
4168
 
4169
  unwind.prologue = 0;
4170
  unwind.prologue_count = 0;
4171
  unwind.body = 0;
4172
  unwind.insn = 0;
4173
  unwind.list = unwind.tail = unwind.current_entry = NULL;
4174
  unwind.personality_routine = 0;
4175
}
4176
 
4177
static void
4178
dot_body (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4179
{
4180
  if (!in_procedure ("body"))
4181
    return;
4182
  if (!unwind.prologue && !unwind.body && unwind.insn)
4183
    as_warn (_("Initial .body should precede any instructions"));
4184
  check_pending_save ();
4185
 
4186
  unwind.prologue = 0;
4187
  unwind.prologue_mask = 0;
4188
  unwind.body = 1;
4189
 
4190
  add_unwind_entry (output_body (), 0);
4191
}
4192
 
4193
static void
4194
dot_prologue (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4195
{
4196
  unsigned mask = 0, grsave = 0;
4197
 
4198
  if (!in_procedure ("prologue"))
4199
    return;
4200
  if (unwind.prologue)
4201
    {
4202
      as_bad (_(".prologue within prologue"));
4203
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4204
      return;
4205
    }
4206
  if (!unwind.body && unwind.insn)
4207
    as_warn (_("Initial .prologue should precede any instructions"));
4208
 
4209
  if (!is_it_end_of_statement ())
4210
    {
4211
      expressionS e;
4212
      int n, sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&e, ',');
4213
 
4214
      if (e.X_op != O_constant
4215
          || e.X_add_number < 0
4216
          || e.X_add_number > 0xf)
4217
        as_bad (_("First operand to .prologue must be a positive 4-bit constant"));
4218
      else if (e.X_add_number == 0)
4219
        as_warn (_("Pointless use of zero first operand to .prologue"));
4220
      else
4221
        mask = e.X_add_number;
4222
        n = popcount (mask);
4223
 
4224
      if (sep == ',')
4225
        parse_operand_and_eval (&e, 0);
4226
      else
4227
        e.X_op = O_absent;
4228
      if (e.X_op == O_constant
4229
          && e.X_add_number >= 0
4230
          && e.X_add_number < 128)
4231
        {
4232
          if (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_error)
4233
            as_warn (_("Using a constant as second operand to .prologue is deprecated"));
4234
          grsave = e.X_add_number;
4235
        }
4236
      else if (e.X_op != O_register
4237
               || (grsave = e.X_add_number - REG_GR) > 127)
4238
        {
4239
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .prologue must be a general register"));
4240
          grsave = 0;
4241
        }
4242
      else if (grsave > 128U - n)
4243
        {
4244
          as_bad (_("Second operand to .prologue must be the first of %d general registers"), n);
4245
          grsave = 0;
4246
        }
4247
 
4248
    }
4249
 
4250
  if (mask)
4251
    add_unwind_entry (output_prologue_gr (mask, grsave), 0);
4252
  else
4253
    add_unwind_entry (output_prologue (), 0);
4254
 
4255
  unwind.prologue = 1;
4256
  unwind.prologue_mask = mask;
4257
  unwind.prologue_gr = grsave;
4258
  unwind.body = 0;
4259
  ++unwind.prologue_count;
4260
}
4261
 
4262
static void
4263
dot_endp (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4264
{
4265
  expressionS e;
4266
  int bytes_per_address;
4267
  long where;
4268
  segT saved_seg;
4269
  subsegT saved_subseg;
4270
  proc_pending *pending;
4271
  int unwind_check = md.unwind_check;
4272
 
4273
  md.unwind_check = unwind_check_error;
4274
  if (!in_procedure ("endp"))
4275
    return;
4276
  md.unwind_check = unwind_check;
4277
 
4278
  if (unwind.saved_text_seg)
4279
    {
4280
      saved_seg = unwind.saved_text_seg;
4281
      saved_subseg = unwind.saved_text_subseg;
4282
      unwind.saved_text_seg = NULL;
4283
    }
4284
  else
4285
    {
4286
      saved_seg = now_seg;
4287
      saved_subseg = now_subseg;
4288
    }
4289
 
4290
  insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4291
 
4292
  /* If there wasn't a .handlerdata, we haven't generated an image yet.  */
4293
  if (!unwind.info)
4294
    generate_unwind_image (saved_seg);
4295
 
4296
  if (unwind.info || unwind.force_unwind_entry)
4297
    {
4298
      symbolS *proc_end;
4299
 
4300
      subseg_set (md.last_text_seg, 0);
4301
      proc_end = expr_build_dot ();
4302
 
4303
      start_unwind_section (saved_seg, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND);
4304
 
4305
      /* Make sure that section has 4 byte alignment for ILP32 and
4306
         8 byte alignment for LP64.  */
4307
      record_alignment (now_seg, md.pointer_size_shift);
4308
 
4309
      /* Need space for 3 pointers for procedure start, procedure end,
4310
         and unwind info.  */
4311
      memset (frag_more (3 * md.pointer_size), 0, 3 * md.pointer_size);
4312
      where = frag_now_fix () - (3 * md.pointer_size);
4313
      bytes_per_address = bfd_arch_bits_per_address (stdoutput) / 8;
4314
 
4315
      /* Issue the values of  a) Proc Begin, b) Proc End, c) Unwind Record.  */
4316
      e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4317
      e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4318
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4319
      if (!S_IS_LOCAL (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4320
          && S_IS_DEFINED (unwind.proc_pending.sym))
4321
        e.X_add_symbol = symbol_temp_new (S_GET_SEGMENT (unwind.proc_pending.sym),
4322
                                          S_GET_VALUE (unwind.proc_pending.sym),
4323
                                          symbol_get_frag (unwind.proc_pending.sym));
4324
      else
4325
        e.X_add_symbol = unwind.proc_pending.sym;
4326
      ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where, bytes_per_address, &e);
4327
 
4328
      e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4329
      e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4330
      e.X_add_number = 0;
4331
      e.X_add_symbol = proc_end;
4332
      ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where + bytes_per_address,
4333
                         bytes_per_address, &e);
4334
 
4335
      if (unwind.info)
4336
        {
4337
          e.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
4338
          e.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym;
4339
          e.X_add_number = 0;
4340
          e.X_add_symbol = unwind.info;
4341
          ia64_cons_fix_new (frag_now, where + (bytes_per_address * 2),
4342
                             bytes_per_address, &e);
4343
        }
4344
    }
4345
  subseg_set (saved_seg, saved_subseg);
4346
 
4347
  /* Set symbol sizes.  */
4348
  pending = &unwind.proc_pending;
4349
  if (S_GET_NAME (pending->sym))
4350
    {
4351
      do
4352
        {
4353
          symbolS *sym = pending->sym;
4354
 
4355
          if (!S_IS_DEFINED (sym))
4356
            as_bad (_("`%s' was not defined within procedure"), S_GET_NAME (sym));
4357
          else if (S_GET_SIZE (sym) == 0
4358
                   && symbol_get_obj (sym)->size == NULL)
4359
            {
4360
              fragS *frag = symbol_get_frag (sym);
4361
 
4362
              if (frag)
4363
                {
4364
                  if (frag == frag_now && SEG_NORMAL (now_seg))
4365
                    S_SET_SIZE (sym, frag_now_fix () - S_GET_VALUE (sym));
4366
                  else
4367
                    {
4368
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size =
4369
                        (expressionS *) xmalloc (sizeof (expressionS));
4370
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_op = O_subtract;
4371
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_add_symbol
4372
                        = symbol_new (FAKE_LABEL_NAME, now_seg,
4373
                                      frag_now_fix (), frag_now);
4374
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_op_symbol = sym;
4375
                      symbol_get_obj (sym)->size->X_add_number = 0;
4376
                    }
4377
                }
4378
            }
4379
        } while ((pending = pending->next) != NULL);
4380
    }
4381
 
4382
  /* Parse names of main and alternate entry points.  */
4383
  while (1)
4384
    {
4385
      char *name, *p, c;
4386
 
4387
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4388
      name = input_line_pointer;
4389
      c = get_symbol_end ();
4390
      p = input_line_pointer;
4391
      if (!*name)
4392
        (md.unwind_check == unwind_check_warning
4393
         ? as_warn
4394
         : as_bad) (_("Empty argument of .endp"));
4395
      else
4396
        {
4397
          symbolS *sym = symbol_find (name);
4398
 
4399
          for (pending = &unwind.proc_pending; pending; pending = pending->next)
4400
            {
4401
              if (sym == pending->sym)
4402
                {
4403
                  pending->sym = NULL;
4404
                  break;
4405
                }
4406
            }
4407
          if (!sym || !pending)
4408
            as_warn (_("`%s' was not specified with previous .proc"), name);
4409
        }
4410
      *p = c;
4411
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4412
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4413
        break;
4414
      ++input_line_pointer;
4415
    }
4416
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4417
 
4418
  /* Deliberately only checking for the main entry point here; the
4419
     language spec even says all arguments to .endp are ignored.  */
4420
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym
4421
      && S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym)
4422
      && strcmp (S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym), FAKE_LABEL_NAME))
4423
    as_warn (_("`%s' should be an operand to this .endp"),
4424
             S_GET_NAME (unwind.proc_pending.sym));
4425
  while (unwind.proc_pending.next)
4426
    {
4427
      pending = unwind.proc_pending.next;
4428
      unwind.proc_pending.next = pending->next;
4429
      free (pending);
4430
    }
4431
  unwind.proc_pending.sym = unwind.info = NULL;
4432
}
4433
 
4434
static void
4435
dot_template (int template_val)
4436
{
4437
  CURR_SLOT.user_template = template_val;
4438
}
4439
 
4440
static void
4441
dot_regstk (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4442
{
4443
  int ins, locs, outs, rots;
4444
 
4445
  if (is_it_end_of_statement ())
4446
    ins = locs = outs = rots = 0;
4447
  else
4448
    {
4449
      ins = get_absolute_expression ();
4450
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4451
        goto err;
4452
      locs = get_absolute_expression ();
4453
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4454
        goto err;
4455
      outs = get_absolute_expression ();
4456
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4457
        goto err;
4458
      rots = get_absolute_expression ();
4459
    }
4460
  set_regstack (ins, locs, outs, rots);
4461
  return;
4462
 
4463
 err:
4464
  as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
4465
  ignore_rest_of_line ();
4466
}
4467
 
4468
static void
4469
dot_rot (int type)
4470
{
4471
  offsetT num_regs;
4472
  valueT num_alloced = 0;
4473
  struct dynreg **drpp, *dr;
4474
  int ch, base_reg = 0;
4475
  char *name, *start;
4476
  size_t len;
4477
 
4478
  switch (type)
4479
    {
4480
    case DYNREG_GR: base_reg = REG_GR + 32; break;
4481
    case DYNREG_FR: base_reg = REG_FR + 32; break;
4482
    case DYNREG_PR: base_reg = REG_P + 16; break;
4483
    default: break;
4484
    }
4485
 
4486
  /* First, remove existing names from hash table.  */
4487
  for (dr = md.dynreg[type]; dr && dr->num_regs; dr = dr->next)
4488
    {
4489
      hash_delete (md.dynreg_hash, dr->name, FALSE);
4490
      /* FIXME: Free dr->name.  */
4491
      dr->num_regs = 0;
4492
    }
4493
 
4494
  drpp = &md.dynreg[type];
4495
  while (1)
4496
    {
4497
      start = input_line_pointer;
4498
      ch = get_symbol_end ();
4499
      len = strlen (ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (start));
4500
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
4501
 
4502
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4503
      if (*input_line_pointer != '[')
4504
        {
4505
          as_bad (_("Expected '['"));
4506
          goto err;
4507
        }
4508
      ++input_line_pointer;     /* skip '[' */
4509
 
4510
      num_regs = get_absolute_expression ();
4511
 
4512
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ']')
4513
        {
4514
          as_bad (_("Expected ']'"));
4515
          goto err;
4516
        }
4517
      if (num_regs <= 0)
4518
        {
4519
          as_bad (_("Number of elements must be positive"));
4520
          goto err;
4521
        }
4522
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4523
 
4524
      num_alloced += num_regs;
4525
      switch (type)
4526
        {
4527
        case DYNREG_GR:
4528
          if (num_alloced > md.rot.num_regs)
4529
            {
4530
              as_bad (_("Used more than the declared %d rotating registers"),
4531
                      md.rot.num_regs);
4532
              goto err;
4533
            }
4534
          break;
4535
        case DYNREG_FR:
4536
          if (num_alloced > 96)
4537
            {
4538
              as_bad (_("Used more than the available 96 rotating registers"));
4539
              goto err;
4540
            }
4541
          break;
4542
        case DYNREG_PR:
4543
          if (num_alloced > 48)
4544
            {
4545
              as_bad (_("Used more than the available 48 rotating registers"));
4546
              goto err;
4547
            }
4548
          break;
4549
 
4550
        default:
4551
          break;
4552
        }
4553
 
4554
      if (!*drpp)
4555
        {
4556
          *drpp = obstack_alloc (&notes, sizeof (*dr));
4557
          memset (*drpp, 0, sizeof (*dr));
4558
        }
4559
 
4560
      name = obstack_alloc (&notes, len + 1);
4561
      memcpy (name, start, len);
4562
      name[len] = '\0';
4563
 
4564
      dr = *drpp;
4565
      dr->name = name;
4566
      dr->num_regs = num_regs;
4567
      dr->base = base_reg;
4568
      drpp = &dr->next;
4569
      base_reg += num_regs;
4570
 
4571
      if (hash_insert (md.dynreg_hash, name, dr))
4572
        {
4573
          as_bad (_("Attempt to redefine register set `%s'"), name);
4574
          obstack_free (&notes, name);
4575
          goto err;
4576
        }
4577
 
4578
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4579
        break;
4580
      ++input_line_pointer;     /* skip comma */
4581
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4582
    }
4583
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4584
  return;
4585
 
4586
 err:
4587
  ignore_rest_of_line ();
4588
}
4589
 
4590
static void
4591
dot_byteorder (int byteorder)
4592
{
4593
  segment_info_type *seginfo = seg_info (now_seg);
4594
 
4595
  if (byteorder == -1)
4596
    {
4597
      if (seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian == 0)
4598
        seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian = default_big_endian ? 1 : 2;
4599
      byteorder = seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian == 1;
4600
    }
4601
  else
4602
    seginfo->tc_segment_info_data.endian = byteorder ? 1 : 2;
4603
 
4604
  if (target_big_endian != byteorder)
4605
    {
4606
      target_big_endian = byteorder;
4607
      if (target_big_endian)
4608
        {
4609
          ia64_number_to_chars = number_to_chars_bigendian;
4610
          ia64_float_to_chars = ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian;
4611
        }
4612
      else
4613
        {
4614
          ia64_number_to_chars = number_to_chars_littleendian;
4615
          ia64_float_to_chars = ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian;
4616
        }
4617
    }
4618
}
4619
 
4620
static void
4621
dot_psr (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4622
{
4623
  char *option;
4624
  int ch;
4625
 
4626
  while (1)
4627
    {
4628
      option = input_line_pointer;
4629
      ch = get_symbol_end ();
4630
      if (strcmp (option, "lsb") == 0)
4631
        md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_BE;
4632
      else if (strcmp (option, "msb") == 0)
4633
        md.flags |= EF_IA_64_BE;
4634
      else if (strcmp (option, "abi32") == 0)
4635
        md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_ABI64;
4636
      else if (strcmp (option, "abi64") == 0)
4637
        md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ABI64;
4638
      else
4639
        as_bad (_("Unknown psr option `%s'"), option);
4640
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
4641
 
4642
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4643
      if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4644
        break;
4645
 
4646
      ++input_line_pointer;
4647
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4648
    }
4649
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4650
}
4651
 
4652
static void
4653
dot_ln (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4654
{
4655
  new_logical_line (0, get_absolute_expression ());
4656
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4657
}
4658
 
4659
static void
4660
cross_section (int ref, void (*builder) (int), int ua)
4661
{
4662
  char *start, *end;
4663
  int saved_auto_align;
4664
  unsigned int section_count;
4665
 
4666
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4667
  start = input_line_pointer;
4668
  if (*start == '"')
4669
    {
4670
      int len;
4671
      char *name;
4672
 
4673
      name = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
4674
      obstack_free(&notes, name);
4675
      if (!name)
4676
        {
4677
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
4678
          return;
4679
        }
4680
    }
4681
  else
4682
    {
4683
      char c = get_symbol_end ();
4684
 
4685
      if (input_line_pointer == start)
4686
        {
4687
          as_bad (_("Missing section name"));
4688
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
4689
          return;
4690
        }
4691
      *input_line_pointer = c;
4692
    }
4693
  end = input_line_pointer;
4694
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4695
  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
4696
    {
4697
      as_bad (_("Comma expected after section name"));
4698
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4699
      return;
4700
    }
4701
  *end = '\0';
4702
  end = input_line_pointer + 1;         /* skip comma */
4703
  input_line_pointer = start;
4704
  md.keep_pending_output = 1;
4705
  section_count = bfd_count_sections (stdoutput);
4706
  obj_elf_section (0);
4707
  if (section_count != bfd_count_sections (stdoutput))
4708
    as_warn (_("Creating sections with .xdataN/.xrealN/.xstringZ is deprecated."));
4709
  input_line_pointer = end;
4710
  saved_auto_align = md.auto_align;
4711
  if (ua)
4712
    md.auto_align = 0;
4713
  (*builder) (ref);
4714
  if (ua)
4715
    md.auto_align = saved_auto_align;
4716
  obj_elf_previous (0);
4717
  md.keep_pending_output = 0;
4718
}
4719
 
4720
static void
4721
dot_xdata (int size)
4722
{
4723
  cross_section (size, cons, 0);
4724
}
4725
 
4726
/* Why doesn't float_cons() call md_cons_align() the way cons() does?  */
4727
 
4728
static void
4729
stmt_float_cons (int kind)
4730
{
4731
  size_t alignment;
4732
 
4733
  switch (kind)
4734
    {
4735
    case 'd':
4736
      alignment = 8;
4737
      break;
4738
 
4739
    case 'x':
4740
    case 'X':
4741
      alignment = 16;
4742
      break;
4743
 
4744
    case 'f':
4745
    default:
4746
      alignment = 4;
4747
      break;
4748
    }
4749
  ia64_do_align (alignment);
4750
  float_cons (kind);
4751
}
4752
 
4753
static void
4754
stmt_cons_ua (int size)
4755
{
4756
  int saved_auto_align = md.auto_align;
4757
 
4758
  md.auto_align = 0;
4759
  cons (size);
4760
  md.auto_align = saved_auto_align;
4761
}
4762
 
4763
static void
4764
dot_xfloat_cons (int kind)
4765
{
4766
  cross_section (kind, stmt_float_cons, 0);
4767
}
4768
 
4769
static void
4770
dot_xstringer (int zero)
4771
{
4772
  cross_section (zero, stringer, 0);
4773
}
4774
 
4775
static void
4776
dot_xdata_ua (int size)
4777
{
4778
  cross_section (size, cons, 1);
4779
}
4780
 
4781
static void
4782
dot_xfloat_cons_ua (int kind)
4783
{
4784
  cross_section (kind, float_cons, 1);
4785
}
4786
 
4787
/* .reg.val <regname>,value */
4788
 
4789
static void
4790
dot_reg_val (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4791
{
4792
  expressionS reg;
4793
 
4794
  expression_and_evaluate (&reg);
4795
  if (reg.X_op != O_register)
4796
    {
4797
      as_bad (_("Register name expected"));
4798
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4799
    }
4800
  else if (*input_line_pointer++ != ',')
4801
    {
4802
      as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
4803
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
4804
    }
4805
  else
4806
    {
4807
      valueT value = get_absolute_expression ();
4808
      int regno = reg.X_add_number;
4809
      if (regno <= REG_GR || regno > REG_GR + 127)
4810
        as_warn (_("Register value annotation ignored"));
4811
      else
4812
        {
4813
          gr_values[regno - REG_GR].known = 1;
4814
          gr_values[regno - REG_GR].value = value;
4815
          gr_values[regno - REG_GR].path = md.path;
4816
        }
4817
    }
4818
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4819
}
4820
 
4821
/*
4822
  .serialize.data
4823
  .serialize.instruction
4824
 */
4825
static void
4826
dot_serialize (int type)
4827
{
4828
  insn_group_break (0, 0, 0);
4829
  if (type)
4830
    instruction_serialization ();
4831
  else
4832
    data_serialization ();
4833
  insn_group_break (0, 0, 0);
4834
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
4835
}
4836
 
4837
/* select dv checking mode
4838
   .auto
4839
   .explicit
4840
   .default
4841
 
4842
   A stop is inserted when changing modes
4843
 */
4844
 
4845
static void
4846
dot_dv_mode (int type)
4847
{
4848
  if (md.manual_bundling)
4849
    as_warn (_("Directive invalid within a bundle"));
4850
 
4851
  if (type == 'E' || type == 'A')
4852
    md.mode_explicitly_set = 0;
4853
  else
4854
    md.mode_explicitly_set = 1;
4855
 
4856
  md.detect_dv = 1;
4857
  switch (type)
4858
    {
4859
    case 'A':
4860
    case 'a':
4861
      if (md.explicit_mode)
4862
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4863
      md.explicit_mode = 0;
4864
      break;
4865
    case 'E':
4866
    case 'e':
4867
      if (!md.explicit_mode)
4868
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4869
      md.explicit_mode = 1;
4870
      break;
4871
    default:
4872
    case 'd':
4873
      if (md.explicit_mode != md.default_explicit_mode)
4874
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
4875
      md.explicit_mode = md.default_explicit_mode;
4876
      md.mode_explicitly_set = 0;
4877
      break;
4878
    }
4879
}
4880
 
4881
static void
4882
print_prmask (valueT mask)
4883
{
4884
  int regno;
4885
  char *comma = "";
4886
  for (regno = 0; regno < 64; regno++)
4887
    {
4888
      if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << regno))
4889
        {
4890
          fprintf (stderr, "%s p%d", comma, regno);
4891
          comma = ",";
4892
        }
4893
    }
4894
}
4895
 
4896
/*
4897
  .pred.rel.clear [p1 [,p2 [,...]]]     (also .pred.rel "clear" or @clear)
4898
  .pred.rel.imply p1, p2                (also .pred.rel "imply" or @imply)
4899
  .pred.rel.mutex p1, p2 [,...]         (also .pred.rel "mutex" or @mutex)
4900
  .pred.safe_across_calls p1 [, p2 [,...]]
4901
 */
4902
 
4903
static void
4904
dot_pred_rel (int type)
4905
{
4906
  valueT mask = 0;
4907
  int count = 0;
4908
  int p1 = -1, p2 = -1;
4909
 
4910
  if (type == 0)
4911
    {
4912
      if (*input_line_pointer == '"')
4913
        {
4914
          int len;
4915
          char *form = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
4916
 
4917
          if (strcmp (form, "mutex") == 0)
4918
            type = 'm';
4919
          else if (strcmp (form, "clear") == 0)
4920
            type = 'c';
4921
          else if (strcmp (form, "imply") == 0)
4922
            type = 'i';
4923
          obstack_free (&notes, form);
4924
        }
4925
      else if (*input_line_pointer == '@')
4926
        {
4927
          char *form = ++input_line_pointer;
4928
          char c = get_symbol_end();
4929
 
4930
          if (strcmp (form, "mutex") == 0)
4931
            type = 'm';
4932
          else if (strcmp (form, "clear") == 0)
4933
            type = 'c';
4934
          else if (strcmp (form, "imply") == 0)
4935
            type = 'i';
4936
          *input_line_pointer = c;
4937
        }
4938
      else
4939
        {
4940
          as_bad (_("Missing predicate relation type"));
4941
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
4942
          return;
4943
        }
4944
      if (type == 0)
4945
        {
4946
          as_bad (_("Unrecognized predicate relation type"));
4947
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
4948
          return;
4949
        }
4950
      if (*input_line_pointer == ',')
4951
        ++input_line_pointer;
4952
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
4953
    }
4954
 
4955
  while (1)
4956
    {
4957
      valueT bits = 1;
4958
      int sep, regno;
4959
      expressionS pr, *pr1, *pr2;
4960
 
4961
      sep = parse_operand_and_eval (&pr, ',');
4962
      if (pr.X_op == O_register
4963
          && pr.X_add_number >= REG_P
4964
          && pr.X_add_number <= REG_P + 63)
4965
        {
4966
          regno = pr.X_add_number - REG_P;
4967
          bits <<= regno;
4968
          count++;
4969
          if (p1 == -1)
4970
            p1 = regno;
4971
          else if (p2 == -1)
4972
            p2 = regno;
4973
        }
4974
      else if (type != 'i'
4975
          && pr.X_op == O_subtract
4976
          && (pr1 = symbol_get_value_expression (pr.X_add_symbol))
4977
          && pr1->X_op == O_register
4978
          && pr1->X_add_number >= REG_P
4979
          && pr1->X_add_number <= REG_P + 63
4980
          && (pr2 = symbol_get_value_expression (pr.X_op_symbol))
4981
          && pr2->X_op == O_register
4982
          && pr2->X_add_number >= REG_P
4983
          && pr2->X_add_number <= REG_P + 63)
4984
        {
4985
          /* It's a range.  */
4986
          int stop;
4987
 
4988
          regno = pr1->X_add_number - REG_P;
4989
          stop = pr2->X_add_number - REG_P;
4990
          if (regno >= stop)
4991
            {
4992
              as_bad (_("Bad register range"));
4993
              ignore_rest_of_line ();
4994
              return;
4995
            }
4996
          bits = ((bits << stop) << 1) - (bits << regno);
4997
          count += stop - regno + 1;
4998
        }
4999
      else
5000
        {
5001
          as_bad (_("Predicate register expected"));
5002
          ignore_rest_of_line ();
5003
          return;
5004
        }
5005
      if (mask & bits)
5006
        as_warn (_("Duplicate predicate register ignored"));
5007
      mask |= bits;
5008
      if (sep != ',')
5009
        break;
5010
    }
5011
 
5012
  switch (type)
5013
    {
5014
    case 'c':
5015
      if (count == 0)
5016
        mask = ~(valueT) 0;
5017
      clear_qp_mutex (mask);
5018
      clear_qp_implies (mask, (valueT) 0);
5019
      break;
5020
    case 'i':
5021
      if (count != 2 || p1 == -1 || p2 == -1)
5022
        as_bad (_("Predicate source and target required"));
5023
      else if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
5024
        as_bad (_("Use of p0 is not valid in this context"));
5025
      else
5026
        add_qp_imply (p1, p2);
5027
      break;
5028
    case 'm':
5029
      if (count < 2)
5030
        {
5031
          as_bad (_("At least two PR arguments expected"));
5032
          break;
5033
        }
5034
      else if (mask & 1)
5035
        {
5036
          as_bad (_("Use of p0 is not valid in this context"));
5037
          break;
5038
        }
5039
      add_qp_mutex (mask);
5040
      break;
5041
    case 's':
5042
      /* note that we don't override any existing relations */
5043
      if (count == 0)
5044
        {
5045
          as_bad (_("At least one PR argument expected"));
5046
          break;
5047
        }
5048
      if (md.debug_dv)
5049
        {
5050
          fprintf (stderr, "Safe across calls: ");
5051
          print_prmask (mask);
5052
          fprintf (stderr, "\n");
5053
        }
5054
      qp_safe_across_calls = mask;
5055
      break;
5056
    }
5057
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5058
}
5059
 
5060
/* .entry label [, label [, ...]]
5061
   Hint to DV code that the given labels are to be considered entry points.
5062
   Otherwise, only global labels are considered entry points.  */
5063
 
5064
static void
5065
dot_entry (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5066
{
5067
  const char *err;
5068
  char *name;
5069
  int c;
5070
  symbolS *symbolP;
5071
 
5072
  do
5073
    {
5074
      name = input_line_pointer;
5075
      c = get_symbol_end ();
5076
      symbolP = symbol_find_or_make (name);
5077
 
5078
      err = hash_insert (md.entry_hash, S_GET_NAME (symbolP), (void *) symbolP);
5079
      if (err)
5080
        as_fatal (_("Inserting \"%s\" into entry hint table failed: %s"),
5081
                  name, err);
5082
 
5083
      *input_line_pointer = c;
5084
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5085
      c = *input_line_pointer;
5086
      if (c == ',')
5087
        {
5088
          input_line_pointer++;
5089
          SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5090
          if (*input_line_pointer == '\n')
5091
            c = '\n';
5092
        }
5093
    }
5094
  while (c == ',');
5095
 
5096
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5097
}
5098
 
5099
/* .mem.offset offset, base
5100
   "base" is used to distinguish between offsets from a different base.  */
5101
 
5102
static void
5103
dot_mem_offset (int dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5104
{
5105
  md.mem_offset.hint = 1;
5106
  md.mem_offset.offset = get_absolute_expression ();
5107
  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
5108
    {
5109
      as_bad (_("Comma expected"));
5110
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
5111
      return;
5112
    }
5113
  ++input_line_pointer;
5114
  md.mem_offset.base = get_absolute_expression ();
5115
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
5116
}
5117
 
5118
/* ia64-specific pseudo-ops:  */
5119
const pseudo_typeS md_pseudo_table[] =
5120
  {
5121
    { "radix", dot_radix, 0 },
5122
    { "lcomm", s_lcomm_bytes, 1 },
5123
    { "loc", dot_loc, 0 },
5124
    { "bss", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_BSS },
5125
    { "sbss", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_SBSS },
5126
    { "sdata", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_SDATA },
5127
    { "rodata", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_RODATA },
5128
    { "comment", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_COMMENT },
5129
    { "ia_64.unwind", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND },
5130
    { "ia_64.unwind_info", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_UNWIND_INFO },
5131
    { "init_array", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_INIT_ARRAY },
5132
    { "fini_array", dot_special_section, SPECIAL_SECTION_FINI_ARRAY },
5133
    { "proc", dot_proc, 0 },
5134
    { "body", dot_body, 0 },
5135
    { "prologue", dot_prologue, 0 },
5136
    { "endp", dot_endp, 0 },
5137
 
5138
    { "fframe", dot_fframe, 0 },
5139
    { "vframe", dot_vframe, 0 },
5140
    { "vframesp", dot_vframesp, 0 },
5141
    { "vframepsp", dot_vframesp, 1 },
5142
    { "save", dot_save, 0 },
5143
    { "restore", dot_restore, 0 },
5144
    { "restorereg", dot_restorereg, 0 },
5145
    { "restorereg.p", dot_restorereg, 1 },
5146
    { "handlerdata", dot_handlerdata, 0 },
5147
    { "unwentry", dot_unwentry, 0 },
5148
    { "altrp", dot_altrp, 0 },
5149
    { "savesp", dot_savemem, 0 },
5150
    { "savepsp", dot_savemem, 1 },
5151
    { "save.g", dot_saveg, 0 },
5152
    { "save.f", dot_savef, 0 },
5153
    { "save.b", dot_saveb, 0 },
5154
    { "save.gf", dot_savegf, 0 },
5155
    { "spill", dot_spill, 0 },
5156
    { "spillreg", dot_spillreg, 0 },
5157
    { "spillsp", dot_spillmem, 0 },
5158
    { "spillpsp", dot_spillmem, 1 },
5159
    { "spillreg.p", dot_spillreg, 1 },
5160
    { "spillsp.p", dot_spillmem, ~0 },
5161
    { "spillpsp.p", dot_spillmem, ~1 },
5162
    { "label_state", dot_label_state, 0 },
5163
    { "copy_state", dot_copy_state, 0 },
5164
    { "unwabi", dot_unwabi, 0 },
5165
    { "personality", dot_personality, 0 },
5166
    { "mii", dot_template, 0x0 },
5167
    { "mli", dot_template, 0x2 }, /* old format, for compatibility */
5168
    { "mlx", dot_template, 0x2 },
5169
    { "mmi", dot_template, 0x4 },
5170
    { "mfi", dot_template, 0x6 },
5171
    { "mmf", dot_template, 0x7 },
5172
    { "mib", dot_template, 0x8 },
5173
    { "mbb", dot_template, 0x9 },
5174
    { "bbb", dot_template, 0xb },
5175
    { "mmb", dot_template, 0xc },
5176
    { "mfb", dot_template, 0xe },
5177
    { "align", dot_align, 0 },
5178
    { "regstk", dot_regstk, 0 },
5179
    { "rotr", dot_rot, DYNREG_GR },
5180
    { "rotf", dot_rot, DYNREG_FR },
5181
    { "rotp", dot_rot, DYNREG_PR },
5182
    { "lsb", dot_byteorder, 0 },
5183
    { "msb", dot_byteorder, 1 },
5184
    { "psr", dot_psr, 0 },
5185
    { "alias", dot_alias, 0 },
5186
    { "secalias", dot_alias, 1 },
5187
    { "ln", dot_ln, 0 },         /* source line info (for debugging) */
5188
 
5189
    { "xdata1", dot_xdata, 1 },
5190
    { "xdata2", dot_xdata, 2 },
5191
    { "xdata4", dot_xdata, 4 },
5192
    { "xdata8", dot_xdata, 8 },
5193
    { "xdata16", dot_xdata, 16 },
5194
    { "xreal4", dot_xfloat_cons, 'f' },
5195
    { "xreal8", dot_xfloat_cons, 'd' },
5196
    { "xreal10", dot_xfloat_cons, 'x' },
5197
    { "xreal16", dot_xfloat_cons, 'X' },
5198
    { "xstring", dot_xstringer, 8 + 0 },
5199
    { "xstringz", dot_xstringer, 8 + 1 },
5200
 
5201
    /* unaligned versions:  */
5202
    { "xdata2.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 2 },
5203
    { "xdata4.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 4 },
5204
    { "xdata8.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 8 },
5205
    { "xdata16.ua", dot_xdata_ua, 16 },
5206
    { "xreal4.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'f' },
5207
    { "xreal8.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'd' },
5208
    { "xreal10.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'x' },
5209
    { "xreal16.ua", dot_xfloat_cons_ua, 'X' },
5210
 
5211
    /* annotations/DV checking support */
5212
    { "entry", dot_entry, 0 },
5213
    { "mem.offset", dot_mem_offset, 0 },
5214
    { "pred.rel", dot_pred_rel, 0 },
5215
    { "pred.rel.clear", dot_pred_rel, 'c' },
5216
    { "pred.rel.imply", dot_pred_rel, 'i' },
5217
    { "pred.rel.mutex", dot_pred_rel, 'm' },
5218
    { "pred.safe_across_calls", dot_pred_rel, 's' },
5219
    { "reg.val", dot_reg_val, 0 },
5220
    { "serialize.data", dot_serialize, 0 },
5221
    { "serialize.instruction", dot_serialize, 1 },
5222
    { "auto", dot_dv_mode, 'a' },
5223
    { "explicit", dot_dv_mode, 'e' },
5224
    { "default", dot_dv_mode, 'd' },
5225
 
5226
    /* ??? These are needed to make gas/testsuite/gas/elf/ehopt.s work.
5227
       IA-64 aligns data allocation pseudo-ops by default, so we have to
5228
       tell it that these ones are supposed to be unaligned.  Long term,
5229
       should rewrite so that only IA-64 specific data allocation pseudo-ops
5230
       are aligned by default.  */
5231
    {"2byte", stmt_cons_ua, 2},
5232
    {"4byte", stmt_cons_ua, 4},
5233
    {"8byte", stmt_cons_ua, 8},
5234
 
5235
    { NULL, 0, 0 }
5236
  };
5237
 
5238
static const struct pseudo_opcode
5239
  {
5240
    const char *name;
5241
    void (*handler) (int);
5242
    int arg;
5243
  }
5244
pseudo_opcode[] =
5245
  {
5246
    /* these are more like pseudo-ops, but don't start with a dot */
5247
    { "data1", cons, 1 },
5248
    { "data2", cons, 2 },
5249
    { "data4", cons, 4 },
5250
    { "data8", cons, 8 },
5251
    { "data16", cons, 16 },
5252
    { "real4", stmt_float_cons, 'f' },
5253
    { "real8", stmt_float_cons, 'd' },
5254
    { "real10", stmt_float_cons, 'x' },
5255
    { "real16", stmt_float_cons, 'X' },
5256
    { "string", stringer, 8 + 0 },
5257
    { "stringz", stringer, 8 + 1 },
5258
 
5259
    /* unaligned versions:  */
5260
    { "data2.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 2 },
5261
    { "data4.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 4 },
5262
    { "data8.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 8 },
5263
    { "data16.ua", stmt_cons_ua, 16 },
5264
    { "real4.ua", float_cons, 'f' },
5265
    { "real8.ua", float_cons, 'd' },
5266
    { "real10.ua", float_cons, 'x' },
5267
    { "real16.ua", float_cons, 'X' },
5268
  };
5269
 
5270
/* Declare a register by creating a symbol for it and entering it in
5271
   the symbol table.  */
5272
 
5273
static symbolS *
5274
declare_register (const char *name, unsigned int regnum)
5275
{
5276
  const char *err;
5277
  symbolS *sym;
5278
 
5279
  sym = symbol_create (name, reg_section, regnum, &zero_address_frag);
5280
 
5281
  err = hash_insert (md.reg_hash, S_GET_NAME (sym), (void *) sym);
5282
  if (err)
5283
    as_fatal ("Inserting \"%s\" into register table failed: %s",
5284
              name, err);
5285
 
5286
  return sym;
5287
}
5288
 
5289
static void
5290
declare_register_set (const char *prefix,
5291
                      unsigned int num_regs,
5292
                      unsigned int base_regnum)
5293
{
5294
  char name[8];
5295
  unsigned int i;
5296
 
5297
  for (i = 0; i < num_regs; ++i)
5298
    {
5299
      snprintf (name, sizeof (name), "%s%u", prefix, i);
5300
      declare_register (name, base_regnum + i);
5301
    }
5302
}
5303
 
5304
static unsigned int
5305
operand_width (enum ia64_opnd opnd)
5306
{
5307
  const struct ia64_operand *odesc = &elf64_ia64_operands[opnd];
5308
  unsigned int bits = 0;
5309
  int i;
5310
 
5311
  bits = 0;
5312
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (odesc->field) && odesc->field[i].bits; ++i)
5313
    bits += odesc->field[i].bits;
5314
 
5315
  return bits;
5316
}
5317
 
5318
static enum operand_match_result
5319
operand_match (const struct ia64_opcode *idesc, int res_index, expressionS *e)
5320
{
5321
  enum ia64_opnd opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5322
  int bits, relocatable = 0;
5323
  struct insn_fix *fix;
5324
  bfd_signed_vma val;
5325
 
5326
  switch (opnd)
5327
    {
5328
      /* constants:  */
5329
 
5330
    case IA64_OPND_AR_CCV:
5331
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 32)
5332
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5333
      break;
5334
 
5335
    case IA64_OPND_AR_CSD:
5336
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 25)
5337
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5338
      break;
5339
 
5340
    case IA64_OPND_AR_PFS:
5341
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_AR + 64)
5342
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5343
      break;
5344
 
5345
    case IA64_OPND_GR0:
5346
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_GR + 0)
5347
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5348
      break;
5349
 
5350
    case IA64_OPND_IP:
5351
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_IP)
5352
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5353
      break;
5354
 
5355
    case IA64_OPND_PR:
5356
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PR)
5357
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5358
      break;
5359
 
5360
    case IA64_OPND_PR_ROT:
5361
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PR_ROT)
5362
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5363
      break;
5364
 
5365
    case IA64_OPND_PSR:
5366
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR)
5367
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5368
      break;
5369
 
5370
    case IA64_OPND_PSR_L:
5371
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR_L)
5372
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5373
      break;
5374
 
5375
    case IA64_OPND_PSR_UM:
5376
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number == REG_PSR_UM)
5377
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5378
      break;
5379
 
5380
    case IA64_OPND_C1:
5381
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5382
        {
5383
          if (e->X_add_number == 1)
5384
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5385
          else
5386
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5387
        }
5388
      break;
5389
 
5390
    case IA64_OPND_C8:
5391
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5392
        {
5393
          if (e->X_add_number == 8)
5394
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5395
          else
5396
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5397
        }
5398
      break;
5399
 
5400
    case IA64_OPND_C16:
5401
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5402
        {
5403
          if (e->X_add_number == 16)
5404
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5405
          else
5406
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5407
        }
5408
      break;
5409
 
5410
      /* register operands:  */
5411
 
5412
    case IA64_OPND_AR3:
5413
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_AR
5414
          && e->X_add_number < REG_AR + 128)
5415
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5416
      break;
5417
 
5418
    case IA64_OPND_B1:
5419
    case IA64_OPND_B2:
5420
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_BR
5421
          && e->X_add_number < REG_BR + 8)
5422
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5423
      break;
5424
 
5425
    case IA64_OPND_CR3:
5426
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_CR
5427
          && e->X_add_number < REG_CR + 128)
5428
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5429
      break;
5430
 
5431
    case IA64_OPND_F1:
5432
    case IA64_OPND_F2:
5433
    case IA64_OPND_F3:
5434
    case IA64_OPND_F4:
5435
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_FR
5436
          && e->X_add_number < REG_FR + 128)
5437
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5438
      break;
5439
 
5440
    case IA64_OPND_P1:
5441
    case IA64_OPND_P2:
5442
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_P
5443
          && e->X_add_number < REG_P + 64)
5444
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5445
      break;
5446
 
5447
    case IA64_OPND_R1:
5448
    case IA64_OPND_R2:
5449
    case IA64_OPND_R3:
5450
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_GR
5451
          && e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 128)
5452
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5453
      break;
5454
 
5455
    case IA64_OPND_R3_2:
5456
      if (e->X_op == O_register && e->X_add_number >= REG_GR)
5457
        {
5458
          if (e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 4)
5459
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5460
          else if (e->X_add_number < REG_GR + 128)
5461
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5462
        }
5463
      break;
5464
 
5465
      /* indirect operands:  */
5466
    case IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3:
5467
    case IA64_OPND_DBR_R3:
5468
    case IA64_OPND_DTR_R3:
5469
    case IA64_OPND_ITR_R3:
5470
    case IA64_OPND_IBR_R3:
5471
    case IA64_OPND_MSR_R3:
5472
    case IA64_OPND_PKR_R3:
5473
    case IA64_OPND_PMC_R3:
5474
    case IA64_OPND_PMD_R3:
5475
    case IA64_OPND_RR_R3:
5476
      if (e->X_op == O_index && e->X_op_symbol
5477
          && (S_GET_VALUE (e->X_op_symbol) - IND_CPUID
5478
              == opnd - IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3))
5479
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5480
      break;
5481
 
5482
    case IA64_OPND_MR3:
5483
      if (e->X_op == O_index && !e->X_op_symbol)
5484
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5485
      break;
5486
 
5487
      /* immediate operands:  */
5488
    case IA64_OPND_CNT2a:
5489
    case IA64_OPND_LEN4:
5490
    case IA64_OPND_LEN6:
5491
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5492
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5493
        {
5494
          if ((bfd_vma) (e->X_add_number - 1) < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5495
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5496
          else
5497
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5498
        }
5499
      break;
5500
 
5501
    case IA64_OPND_CNT2b:
5502
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5503
        {
5504
          if ((bfd_vma) (e->X_add_number - 1) < 3)
5505
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5506
          else
5507
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5508
        }
5509
      break;
5510
 
5511
    case IA64_OPND_CNT2c:
5512
      val = e->X_add_number;
5513
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5514
        {
5515
          if ((val == 0 || val == 7 || val == 15 || val == 16))
5516
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5517
          else
5518
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5519
        }
5520
      break;
5521
 
5522
    case IA64_OPND_SOR:
5523
      /* SOR must be an integer multiple of 8 */
5524
      if (e->X_op == O_constant && e->X_add_number & 0x7)
5525
        return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5526
    case IA64_OPND_SOF:
5527
    case IA64_OPND_SOL:
5528
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5529
        {
5530
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number <= 96)
5531
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5532
          else
5533
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5534
        }
5535
      break;
5536
 
5537
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU62:
5538
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5539
        {
5540
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 62))
5541
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5542
          else
5543
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5544
        }
5545
      else
5546
        {
5547
          /* FIXME -- need 62-bit relocation type */
5548
          as_bad (_("62-bit relocation not yet implemented"));
5549
        }
5550
      break;
5551
 
5552
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
5553
      if (e->X_op == O_symbol || e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
5554
          || e->X_op == O_subtract)
5555
        {
5556
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5557
          fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64;
5558
          if (e->X_op != O_subtract)
5559
            {
5560
              fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5561
              if (e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
5562
                e->X_op = O_symbol;
5563
            }
5564
 
5565
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5566
          fix->expr = *e;
5567
          fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5568
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5569
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
5570
        }
5571
      else if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5572
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5573
      break;
5574
 
5575
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU5b:
5576
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5577
        {
5578
          val = e->X_add_number;
5579
          if (val >= 32 && val <= 63)
5580
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5581
          else
5582
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5583
        }
5584
      break;
5585
 
5586
    case IA64_OPND_CCNT5:
5587
    case IA64_OPND_CNT5:
5588
    case IA64_OPND_CNT6:
5589
    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6a:
5590
    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6b:
5591
    case IA64_OPND_CPOS6c:
5592
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU2:
5593
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU7a:
5594
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU7b:
5595
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU21:
5596
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU24:
5597
    case IA64_OPND_MBTYPE4:
5598
    case IA64_OPND_MHTYPE8:
5599
    case IA64_OPND_POS6:
5600
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5601
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5602
        {
5603
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5604
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5605
          else
5606
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5607
        }
5608
      break;
5609
 
5610
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU9:
5611
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5612
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5613
        {
5614
          if ((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << bits))
5615
            {
5616
              int lobits = e->X_add_number & 0x3;
5617
              if (((bfd_vma) e->X_add_number & 0x3C) != 0 && lobits == 0)
5618
                e->X_add_number |= (bfd_vma) 0x3;
5619
              return OPERAND_MATCH;
5620
            }
5621
          else
5622
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5623
        }
5624
      break;
5625
 
5626
    case IA64_OPND_IMM44:
5627
      /* least 16 bits must be zero */
5628
      if ((e->X_add_number & 0xffff) != 0)
5629
        /* XXX technically, this is wrong: we should not be issuing warning
5630
           messages until we're sure this instruction pattern is going to
5631
           be used! */
5632
        as_warn (_("lower 16 bits of mask ignored"));
5633
 
5634
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5635
        {
5636
          if (((e->X_add_number >= 0
5637
                && (bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 44))
5638
               || (e->X_add_number < 0
5639
                   && (bfd_vma) -e->X_add_number <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << 44))))
5640
            {
5641
              /* sign-extend */
5642
              if (e->X_add_number >= 0
5643
                  && (e->X_add_number & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 43)) != 0)
5644
                {
5645
                  e->X_add_number |= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << 44) - 1);
5646
                }
5647
              return OPERAND_MATCH;
5648
            }
5649
          else
5650
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5651
        }
5652
      break;
5653
 
5654
    case IA64_OPND_IMM17:
5655
      /* bit 0 is a don't care (pr0 is hardwired to 1) */
5656
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5657
        {
5658
          if (((e->X_add_number >= 0
5659
                && (bfd_vma) e->X_add_number < ((bfd_vma) 1 << 17))
5660
               || (e->X_add_number < 0
5661
                   && (bfd_vma) -e->X_add_number <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << 17))))
5662
            {
5663
              /* sign-extend */
5664
              if (e->X_add_number >= 0
5665
                  && (e->X_add_number & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 16)) != 0)
5666
                {
5667
                  e->X_add_number |= ~(((bfd_vma) 1 << 17) - 1);
5668
                }
5669
              return OPERAND_MATCH;
5670
            }
5671
          else
5672
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5673
        }
5674
      break;
5675
 
5676
    case IA64_OPND_IMM14:
5677
    case IA64_OPND_IMM22:
5678
      relocatable = 1;
5679
    case IA64_OPND_IMM1:
5680
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8:
5681
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8U4:
5682
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1:
5683
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U4:
5684
    case IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8:
5685
    case IA64_OPND_IMM9a:
5686
    case IA64_OPND_IMM9b:
5687
      bits = operand_width (idesc->operands[res_index]);
5688
      if (relocatable && (e->X_op == O_symbol
5689
                          || e->X_op == O_subtract
5690
                          || e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup))
5691
        {
5692
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5693
 
5694
          if (idesc->operands[res_index] == IA64_OPND_IMM14)
5695
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14;
5696
          else
5697
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22;
5698
 
5699
          if (e->X_op != O_subtract)
5700
            {
5701
              fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5702
              if (e->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
5703
                e->X_op = O_symbol;
5704
            }
5705
 
5706
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5707
          fix->expr = *e;
5708
          fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5709
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5710
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
5711
        }
5712
      else if (e->X_op != O_constant
5713
               && ! (e->X_op == O_big && opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8))
5714
        return OPERAND_MISMATCH;
5715
 
5716
      if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U4)
5717
        {
5718
          /* Zero is not valid for unsigned compares that take an adjusted
5719
             constant immediate range.  */
5720
          if (e->X_add_number == 0)
5721
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5722
 
5723
          /* Sign-extend 32-bit unsigned numbers, so that the following range
5724
             checks will work.  */
5725
          val = e->X_add_number;
5726
          if (((val & (~(bfd_vma) 0 << 32)) == 0)
5727
              && ((val & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) != 0))
5728
            val = ((val << 32) >> 32);
5729
 
5730
          /* Check for 0x100000000.  This is valid because
5731
             0x100000000-1 is the same as ((uint32_t) -1).  */
5732
          if (val == ((bfd_signed_vma) 1 << 32))
5733
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5734
 
5735
          val = val - 1;
5736
        }
5737
      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8)
5738
        {
5739
          /* Zero is not valid for unsigned compares that take an adjusted
5740
             constant immediate range.  */
5741
          if (e->X_add_number == 0)
5742
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5743
 
5744
          /* Check for 0x10000000000000000.  */
5745
          if (e->X_op == O_big)
5746
            {
5747
              if (generic_bignum[0] == 0
5748
                  && generic_bignum[1] == 0
5749
                  && generic_bignum[2] == 0
5750
                  && generic_bignum[3] == 0
5751
                  && generic_bignum[4] == 1)
5752
                return OPERAND_MATCH;
5753
              else
5754
                return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5755
            }
5756
          else
5757
            val = e->X_add_number - 1;
5758
        }
5759
      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1)
5760
        val = e->X_add_number - 1;
5761
      else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_IMM8U4)
5762
        {
5763
          /* Sign-extend 32-bit unsigned numbers, so that the following range
5764
             checks will work.  */
5765
          val = e->X_add_number;
5766
          if (((val & (~(bfd_vma) 0 << 32)) == 0)
5767
              && ((val & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) != 0))
5768
            val = ((val << 32) >> 32);
5769
        }
5770
      else
5771
        val = e->X_add_number;
5772
 
5773
      if ((val >= 0 && (bfd_vma) val < ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
5774
          || (val < 0 && (bfd_vma) -val <= ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1))))
5775
        return OPERAND_MATCH;
5776
      else
5777
        return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5778
 
5779
    case IA64_OPND_INC3:
5780
      /* +/- 1, 4, 8, 16 */
5781
      val = e->X_add_number;
5782
      if (val < 0)
5783
        val = -val;
5784
      if (e->X_op == O_constant)
5785
        {
5786
          if ((val == 1 || val == 4 || val == 8 || val == 16))
5787
            return OPERAND_MATCH;
5788
          else
5789
            return OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE;
5790
        }
5791
      break;
5792
 
5793
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25:
5794
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25b:
5795
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25c:
5796
    case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
5797
      if (e->X_op == O_symbol)
5798
        {
5799
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5800
          if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25)
5801
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21F;
5802
          else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25b)
5803
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21M;
5804
          else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT25c)
5805
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21B;
5806
          else if (opnd == IA64_OPND_TGT64)
5807
            fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL60B;
5808
          else
5809
            abort ();
5810
 
5811
          fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5812
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5813
          fix->expr = *e;
5814
          fix->is_pcrel = 1;
5815
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5816
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
5817
        }
5818
    case IA64_OPND_TAG13:
5819
    case IA64_OPND_TAG13b:
5820
      switch (e->X_op)
5821
        {
5822
        case O_constant:
5823
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
5824
 
5825
        case O_symbol:
5826
          fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5827
          /* There are no external relocs for TAG13/TAG13b fields, so we
5828
             create a dummy reloc.  This will not live past md_apply_fix.  */
5829
          fix->code = BFD_RELOC_UNUSED;
5830
          fix->code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (e->X_op_symbol, fix->code);
5831
          fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5832
          fix->expr = *e;
5833
          fix->is_pcrel = 1;
5834
          ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5835
          return OPERAND_MATCH;
5836
 
5837
        default:
5838
          break;
5839
        }
5840
      break;
5841
 
5842
    case IA64_OPND_LDXMOV:
5843
      fix = CURR_SLOT.fixup + CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5844
      fix->code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LDXMOV;
5845
      fix->opnd = idesc->operands[res_index];
5846
      fix->expr = *e;
5847
      fix->is_pcrel = 0;
5848
      ++CURR_SLOT.num_fixups;
5849
      return OPERAND_MATCH;
5850
 
5851
    default:
5852
      break;
5853
    }
5854
  return OPERAND_MISMATCH;
5855
}
5856
 
5857
static int
5858
parse_operand (expressionS *e, int more)
5859
{
5860
  int sep = '\0';
5861
 
5862
  memset (e, 0, sizeof (*e));
5863
  e->X_op = O_absent;
5864
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5865
  expression (e);
5866
  sep = *input_line_pointer;
5867
  if (more && (sep == ',' || sep == more))
5868
    ++input_line_pointer;
5869
  return sep;
5870
}
5871
 
5872
static int
5873
parse_operand_and_eval (expressionS *e, int more)
5874
{
5875
  int sep = parse_operand (e, more);
5876
  resolve_expression (e);
5877
  return sep;
5878
}
5879
 
5880
static int
5881
parse_operand_maybe_eval (expressionS *e, int more, enum ia64_opnd op)
5882
{
5883
  int sep = parse_operand (e, more);
5884
  switch (op)
5885
    {
5886
    case IA64_OPND_IMM14:
5887
    case IA64_OPND_IMM22:
5888
    case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
5889
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25:
5890
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25b:
5891
    case IA64_OPND_TGT25c:
5892
    case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
5893
    case IA64_OPND_TAG13:
5894
    case IA64_OPND_TAG13b:
5895
    case IA64_OPND_LDXMOV:
5896
      break;
5897
    default:
5898
      resolve_expression (e);
5899
      break;
5900
    }
5901
  return sep;
5902
}
5903
 
5904
/* Returns the next entry in the opcode table that matches the one in
5905
   IDESC, and frees the entry in IDESC.  If no matching entry is
5906
   found, NULL is returned instead.  */
5907
 
5908
static struct ia64_opcode *
5909
get_next_opcode (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
5910
{
5911
  struct ia64_opcode *next = ia64_find_next_opcode (idesc);
5912
  ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
5913
  return next;
5914
}
5915
 
5916
/* Parse the operands for the opcode and find the opcode variant that
5917
   matches the specified operands, or NULL if no match is possible.  */
5918
 
5919
static struct ia64_opcode *
5920
parse_operands (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
5921
{
5922
  int i = 0, highest_unmatched_operand, num_operands = 0, num_outputs = 0;
5923
  int error_pos, out_of_range_pos, curr_out_of_range_pos, sep = 0;
5924
  int reg1, reg2;
5925
  char reg_class;
5926
  enum ia64_opnd expected_operand = IA64_OPND_NIL;
5927
  enum operand_match_result result;
5928
  char mnemonic[129];
5929
  char *first_arg = 0, *end, *saved_input_pointer;
5930
  unsigned int sof;
5931
 
5932
  gas_assert (strlen (idesc->name) <= 128);
5933
 
5934
  strcpy (mnemonic, idesc->name);
5935
  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_SOF
5936
      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_SOF)
5937
    {
5938
      /* To make the common idiom "alloc loc?=ar.pfs,0,1,0,0" work, we
5939
         can't parse the first operand until we have parsed the
5940
         remaining operands of the "alloc" instruction.  */
5941
      SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
5942
      first_arg = input_line_pointer;
5943
      end = strchr (input_line_pointer, '=');
5944
      if (!end)
5945
        {
5946
          as_bad (_("Expected separator `='"));
5947
          return 0;
5948
        }
5949
      input_line_pointer = end + 1;
5950
      ++i;
5951
      ++num_outputs;
5952
    }
5953
 
5954
  for (; ; ++i)
5955
    {
5956
      if (i < NELEMS (CURR_SLOT.opnd))
5957
        {
5958
          sep = parse_operand_maybe_eval (CURR_SLOT.opnd + i, '=',
5959
                                          idesc->operands[i]);
5960
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_op == O_absent)
5961
            break;
5962
        }
5963
      else
5964
        {
5965
          expressionS dummy;
5966
 
5967
          sep = parse_operand (&dummy, '=');
5968
          if (dummy.X_op == O_absent)
5969
            break;
5970
        }
5971
 
5972
      ++num_operands;
5973
 
5974
      if (sep != '=' && sep != ',')
5975
        break;
5976
 
5977
      if (sep == '=')
5978
        {
5979
          if (num_outputs > 0)
5980
            as_bad (_("Duplicate equal sign (=) in instruction"));
5981
          else
5982
            num_outputs = i + 1;
5983
        }
5984
    }
5985
  if (sep != '\0')
5986
    {
5987
      as_bad (_("Illegal operand separator `%c'"), sep);
5988
      return 0;
5989
    }
5990
 
5991
  if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_SOF
5992
      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_SOF)
5993
    {
5994
      /* Map alloc r1=ar.pfs,i,l,o,r to alloc r1=ar.pfs,(i+l+o),(i+l),r.
5995
         Note, however, that due to that mapping operand numbers in error
5996
         messages for any of the constant operands will not be correct.  */
5997
      know (strcmp (idesc->name, "alloc") == 0);
5998
      /* The first operand hasn't been parsed/initialized, yet (but
5999
         num_operands intentionally doesn't account for that).  */
6000
      i = num_operands > 4 ? 2 : 1;
6001
#define FORCE_CONST(n) (CURR_SLOT.opnd[n].X_op == O_constant \
6002
                        ? CURR_SLOT.opnd[n].X_add_number \
6003
                        : 0)
6004
      sof = set_regstack (FORCE_CONST(i),
6005
                          FORCE_CONST(i + 1),
6006
                          FORCE_CONST(i + 2),
6007
                          FORCE_CONST(i + 3));
6008
#undef FORCE_CONST
6009
 
6010
      /* now we can parse the first arg:  */
6011
      saved_input_pointer = input_line_pointer;
6012
      input_line_pointer = first_arg;
6013
      sep = parse_operand_maybe_eval (CURR_SLOT.opnd + 0, '=',
6014
                                      idesc->operands[0]);
6015
      if (sep != '=')
6016
        --num_outputs;  /* force error */
6017
      input_line_pointer = saved_input_pointer;
6018
 
6019
      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number = sof;
6020
      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_op == O_constant
6021
          && CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2].X_op == O_constant)
6022
        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_add_number
6023
          = sof - CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2].X_add_number;
6024
      else
6025
        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 1].X_op = O_illegal;
6026
      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 2] = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i + 3];
6027
    }
6028
 
6029
  highest_unmatched_operand = -4;
6030
  curr_out_of_range_pos = -1;
6031
  error_pos = 0;
6032
  for (; idesc; idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc))
6033
    {
6034
      if (num_outputs != idesc->num_outputs)
6035
        continue;               /* mismatch in # of outputs */
6036
      if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0)
6037
        highest_unmatched_operand |= 1;
6038
      if (num_operands > NELEMS (idesc->operands)
6039
          || (num_operands < NELEMS (idesc->operands)
6040
           && idesc->operands[num_operands])
6041
          || (num_operands > 0 && !idesc->operands[num_operands - 1]))
6042
        continue;               /* mismatch in number of arguments */
6043
      if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0)
6044
        highest_unmatched_operand |= 2;
6045
 
6046
      CURR_SLOT.num_fixups = 0;
6047
 
6048
      /* Try to match all operands.  If we see an out-of-range operand,
6049
         then continue trying to match the rest of the operands, since if
6050
         the rest match, then this idesc will give the best error message.  */
6051
 
6052
      out_of_range_pos = -1;
6053
      for (i = 0; i < num_operands && idesc->operands[i]; ++i)
6054
        {
6055
          result = operand_match (idesc, i, CURR_SLOT.opnd + i);
6056
          if (result != OPERAND_MATCH)
6057
            {
6058
              if (result != OPERAND_OUT_OF_RANGE)
6059
                break;
6060
              if (out_of_range_pos < 0)
6061
                /* remember position of the first out-of-range operand: */
6062
                out_of_range_pos = i;
6063
            }
6064
        }
6065
 
6066
      /* If we did not match all operands, or if at least one operand was
6067
         out-of-range, then this idesc does not match.  Keep track of which
6068
         idesc matched the most operands before failing.  If we have two
6069
         idescs that failed at the same position, and one had an out-of-range
6070
         operand, then prefer the out-of-range operand.  Thus if we have
6071
         "add r0=0x1000000,r1" we get an error saying the constant is out
6072
         of range instead of an error saying that the constant should have been
6073
         a register.  */
6074
 
6075
      if (i != num_operands || out_of_range_pos >= 0)
6076
        {
6077
          if (i > highest_unmatched_operand
6078
              || (i == highest_unmatched_operand
6079
                  && out_of_range_pos > curr_out_of_range_pos))
6080
            {
6081
              highest_unmatched_operand = i;
6082
              if (out_of_range_pos >= 0)
6083
                {
6084
                  expected_operand = idesc->operands[out_of_range_pos];
6085
                  error_pos = out_of_range_pos;
6086
                }
6087
              else
6088
                {
6089
                  expected_operand = idesc->operands[i];
6090
                  error_pos = i;
6091
                }
6092
              curr_out_of_range_pos = out_of_range_pos;
6093
            }
6094
          continue;
6095
        }
6096
 
6097
      break;
6098
    }
6099
  if (!idesc)
6100
    {
6101
      if (expected_operand)
6102
        as_bad (_("Operand %u of `%s' should be %s"),
6103
                error_pos + 1, mnemonic,
6104
                elf64_ia64_operands[expected_operand].desc);
6105
      else if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0 && !(highest_unmatched_operand & 1))
6106
        as_bad (_("Wrong number of output operands"));
6107
      else if (highest_unmatched_operand < 0 && !(highest_unmatched_operand & 2))
6108
        as_bad (_("Wrong number of input operands"));
6109
      else
6110
        as_bad (_("Operand mismatch"));
6111
      return 0;
6112
    }
6113
 
6114
  /* Check that the instruction doesn't use
6115
     - r0, f0, or f1 as output operands
6116
     - the same predicate twice as output operands
6117
     - r0 as address of a base update load or store
6118
     - the same GR as output and address of a base update load
6119
     - two even- or two odd-numbered FRs as output operands of a floating
6120
       point parallel load.
6121
     At most two (conflicting) output (or output-like) operands can exist,
6122
     (floating point parallel loads have three outputs, but the base register,
6123
     if updated, cannot conflict with the actual outputs).  */
6124
  reg2 = reg1 = -1;
6125
  for (i = 0; i < num_operands; ++i)
6126
    {
6127
      int regno = 0;
6128
 
6129
      reg_class = 0;
6130
      switch (idesc->operands[i])
6131
        {
6132
        case IA64_OPND_R1:
6133
        case IA64_OPND_R2:
6134
        case IA64_OPND_R3:
6135
          if (i < num_outputs)
6136
            {
6137
              if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number == REG_GR)
6138
                reg_class = 'r';
6139
              else if (reg1 < 0)
6140
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6141
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6142
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6143
            }
6144
          break;
6145
        case IA64_OPND_P1:
6146
        case IA64_OPND_P2:
6147
          if (i < num_outputs)
6148
            {
6149
              if (reg1 < 0)
6150
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6151
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6152
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6153
            }
6154
          break;
6155
        case IA64_OPND_F1:
6156
        case IA64_OPND_F2:
6157
        case IA64_OPND_F3:
6158
        case IA64_OPND_F4:
6159
          if (i < num_outputs)
6160
            {
6161
              if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number >= REG_FR
6162
                  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number <= REG_FR + 1)
6163
                {
6164
                  reg_class = 'f';
6165
                  regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
6166
                }
6167
              else if (reg1 < 0)
6168
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6169
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6170
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6171
            }
6172
          break;
6173
        case IA64_OPND_MR3:
6174
          if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_POSTINC)
6175
            {
6176
              if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number == REG_GR)
6177
                reg_class = 'm';
6178
              else if (reg1 < 0)
6179
                reg1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6180
              else if (reg2 < 0)
6181
                reg2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number;
6182
            }
6183
          break;
6184
        default:
6185
          break;
6186
        }
6187
      switch (reg_class)
6188
        {
6189
        case 0:
6190
          break;
6191
        default:
6192
          as_warn (_("Invalid use of `%c%d' as output operand"), reg_class, regno);
6193
          break;
6194
        case 'm':
6195
          as_warn (_("Invalid use of `r%d' as base update address operand"), regno);
6196
          break;
6197
        }
6198
    }
6199
  if (reg1 == reg2)
6200
    {
6201
      if (reg1 >= REG_GR && reg1 <= REG_GR + 127)
6202
        {
6203
          reg1 -= REG_GR;
6204
          reg_class = 'r';
6205
        }
6206
      else if (reg1 >= REG_P && reg1 <= REG_P + 63)
6207
        {
6208
          reg1 -= REG_P;
6209
          reg_class = 'p';
6210
        }
6211
      else if (reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127)
6212
        {
6213
          reg1 -= REG_FR;
6214
          reg_class = 'f';
6215
        }
6216
      else
6217
        reg_class = 0;
6218
      if (reg_class)
6219
        as_warn (_("Invalid duplicate use of `%c%d'"), reg_class, reg1);
6220
    }
6221
  else if (((reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 31
6222
             && reg2 >= REG_FR && reg2 <= REG_FR + 31)
6223
            || (reg1 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127
6224
             && reg2 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg2 <= REG_FR + 127))
6225
           && ! ((reg1 ^ reg2) & 1))
6226
    as_warn (_("Invalid simultaneous use of `f%d' and `f%d'"),
6227
             reg1 - REG_FR, reg2 - REG_FR);
6228
  else if ((reg1 >= REG_FR && reg1 <= REG_FR + 31
6229
            && reg2 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg2 <= REG_FR + 127)
6230
           || (reg1 >= REG_FR + 32 && reg1 <= REG_FR + 127
6231
            && reg2 >= REG_FR && reg2 <= REG_FR + 31))
6232
    as_warn (_("Dangerous simultaneous use of `f%d' and `f%d'"),
6233
             reg1 - REG_FR, reg2 - REG_FR);
6234
  return idesc;
6235
}
6236
 
6237
static void
6238
build_insn (struct slot *slot, bfd_vma *insnp)
6239
{
6240
  const struct ia64_operand *odesc, *o2desc;
6241
  struct ia64_opcode *idesc = slot->idesc;
6242
  bfd_vma insn;
6243
  bfd_signed_vma val;
6244
  const char *err;
6245
  int i;
6246
 
6247
  insn = idesc->opcode | slot->qp_regno;
6248
 
6249
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands) && idesc->operands[i]; ++i)
6250
    {
6251
      if (slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_register
6252
          || slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_constant
6253
          || slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_index)
6254
        val = slot->opnd[i].X_add_number;
6255
      else if (slot->opnd[i].X_op == O_big)
6256
        {
6257
          /* This must be the value 0x10000000000000000.  */
6258
          gas_assert (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_IMM8M1U8);
6259
          val = 0;
6260
        }
6261
      else
6262
        val = 0;
6263
 
6264
      switch (idesc->operands[i])
6265
        {
6266
        case IA64_OPND_IMMU64:
6267
          *insnp++ = (val >> 22) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
6268
          insn |= (((val & 0x7f) << 13) | (((val >> 7) & 0x1ff) << 27)
6269
                   | (((val >> 16) & 0x1f) << 22) | (((val >> 21) & 0x1) << 21)
6270
                   | (((val >> 63) & 0x1) << 36));
6271
          continue;
6272
 
6273
        case IA64_OPND_IMMU62:
6274
          val &= 0x3fffffffffffffffULL;
6275
          if (val != slot->opnd[i].X_add_number)
6276
            as_warn (_("Value truncated to 62 bits"));
6277
          *insnp++ = (val >> 21) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
6278
          insn |= (((val & 0xfffff) << 6) | (((val >> 20) & 0x1) << 36));
6279
          continue;
6280
 
6281
        case IA64_OPND_TGT64:
6282
          val >>= 4;
6283
          *insnp++ = ((val >> 20) & 0x7fffffffffLL) << 2;
6284
          insn |= ((((val >> 59) & 0x1) << 36)
6285
                   | (((val >> 0) & 0xfffff) << 13));
6286
          continue;
6287
 
6288
        case IA64_OPND_AR3:
6289
          val -= REG_AR;
6290
          break;
6291
 
6292
        case IA64_OPND_B1:
6293
        case IA64_OPND_B2:
6294
          val -= REG_BR;
6295
          break;
6296
 
6297
        case IA64_OPND_CR3:
6298
          val -= REG_CR;
6299
          break;
6300
 
6301
        case IA64_OPND_F1:
6302
        case IA64_OPND_F2:
6303
        case IA64_OPND_F3:
6304
        case IA64_OPND_F4:
6305
          val -= REG_FR;
6306
          break;
6307
 
6308
        case IA64_OPND_P1:
6309
        case IA64_OPND_P2:
6310
          val -= REG_P;
6311
          break;
6312
 
6313
        case IA64_OPND_R1:
6314
        case IA64_OPND_R2:
6315
        case IA64_OPND_R3:
6316
        case IA64_OPND_R3_2:
6317
        case IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3:
6318
        case IA64_OPND_DBR_R3:
6319
        case IA64_OPND_DTR_R3:
6320
        case IA64_OPND_ITR_R3:
6321
        case IA64_OPND_IBR_R3:
6322
        case IA64_OPND_MR3:
6323
        case IA64_OPND_MSR_R3:
6324
        case IA64_OPND_PKR_R3:
6325
        case IA64_OPND_PMC_R3:
6326
        case IA64_OPND_PMD_R3:
6327
        case IA64_OPND_RR_R3:
6328
          val -= REG_GR;
6329
          break;
6330
 
6331
        default:
6332
          break;
6333
        }
6334
 
6335
      odesc = elf64_ia64_operands + idesc->operands[i];
6336
      err = (*odesc->insert) (odesc, val, &insn);
6337
      if (err)
6338
        as_bad_where (slot->src_file, slot->src_line,
6339
                      _("Bad operand value: %s"), err);
6340
      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_PSEUDO)
6341
        {
6342
          if ((idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_F2_EQ_F3)
6343
              && odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_F3)
6344
            {
6345
              o2desc = elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_F2;
6346
              (*o2desc->insert) (o2desc, val, &insn);
6347
            }
6348
          if ((idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_LEN_EQ_64MCNT)
6349
              && (odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_CPOS6a
6350
                  || odesc == elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_POS6))
6351
            {
6352
              o2desc = elf64_ia64_operands + IA64_OPND_LEN6;
6353
              (*o2desc->insert) (o2desc, 64 - val, &insn);
6354
            }
6355
        }
6356
    }
6357
  *insnp = insn;
6358
}
6359
 
6360
static void
6361
emit_one_bundle (void)
6362
{
6363
  int manual_bundling_off = 0, manual_bundling = 0;
6364
  enum ia64_unit required_unit, insn_unit = 0;
6365
  enum ia64_insn_type type[3], insn_type;
6366
  unsigned int template_val, orig_template;
6367
  bfd_vma insn[3] = { -1, -1, -1 };
6368
  struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
6369
  int end_of_insn_group = 0, user_template = -1;
6370
  int n, i, j, first, curr, last_slot;
6371
  bfd_vma t0 = 0, t1 = 0;
6372
  struct label_fix *lfix;
6373
  bfd_boolean mark_label;
6374
  struct insn_fix *ifix;
6375
  char mnemonic[16];
6376
  fixS *fix;
6377
  char *f;
6378
  int addr_mod;
6379
 
6380
  first = (md.curr_slot + NUM_SLOTS - md.num_slots_in_use) % NUM_SLOTS;
6381
  know (first >= 0 && first < NUM_SLOTS);
6382
  n = MIN (3, md.num_slots_in_use);
6383
 
6384
  /* Determine template: user user_template if specified, best match
6385
     otherwise:  */
6386
 
6387
  if (md.slot[first].user_template >= 0)
6388
    user_template = template_val = md.slot[first].user_template;
6389
  else
6390
    {
6391
      /* Auto select appropriate template.  */
6392
      memset (type, 0, sizeof (type));
6393
      curr = first;
6394
      for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
6395
        {
6396
          if (md.slot[curr].label_fixups && i != 0)
6397
            break;
6398
          type[i] = md.slot[curr].idesc->type;
6399
          curr = (curr + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
6400
        }
6401
      template_val = best_template[type[0]][type[1]][type[2]];
6402
    }
6403
 
6404
  /* initialize instructions with appropriate nops:  */
6405
  for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
6406
    insn[i] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[i]];
6407
 
6408
  f = frag_more (16);
6409
 
6410
  /* Check to see if this bundle is at an offset that is a multiple of 16-bytes
6411
     from the start of the frag.  */
6412
  addr_mod = frag_now_fix () & 15;
6413
  if (frag_now->has_code && frag_now->insn_addr != addr_mod)
6414
    as_bad (_("instruction address is not a multiple of 16"));
6415
  frag_now->insn_addr = addr_mod;
6416
  frag_now->has_code = 1;
6417
 
6418
  /* now fill in slots with as many insns as possible:  */
6419
  curr = first;
6420
  idesc = md.slot[curr].idesc;
6421
  end_of_insn_group = 0;
6422
  last_slot = -1;
6423
  for (i = 0; i < 3 && md.num_slots_in_use > 0; ++i)
6424
    {
6425
      /* If we have unwind records, we may need to update some now.  */
6426
      unw_rec_list *ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record;
6427
      unw_rec_list *end_ptr = NULL;
6428
 
6429
      if (ptr)
6430
        {
6431
          /* Find the last prologue/body record in the list for the current
6432
             insn, and set the slot number for all records up to that point.
6433
             This needs to be done now, because prologue/body records refer to
6434
             the current point, not the point after the instruction has been
6435
             issued.  This matters because there may have been nops emitted
6436
             meanwhile.  Any non-prologue non-body record followed by a
6437
             prologue/body record must also refer to the current point.  */
6438
          unw_rec_list *last_ptr;
6439
 
6440
          for (j = 1; end_ptr == NULL && j < md.num_slots_in_use; ++j)
6441
            end_ptr = md.slot[(curr + j) % NUM_SLOTS].unwind_record;
6442
          for (last_ptr = NULL; ptr != end_ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
6443
            if (ptr->r.type == prologue || ptr->r.type == prologue_gr
6444
                || ptr->r.type == body)
6445
              last_ptr = ptr;
6446
          if (last_ptr)
6447
            {
6448
              /* Make last_ptr point one after the last prologue/body
6449
                 record.  */
6450
              last_ptr = last_ptr->next;
6451
              for (ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record; ptr != last_ptr;
6452
                   ptr = ptr->next)
6453
                {
6454
                  ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) f + i;
6455
                  ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
6456
                }
6457
              /* Remove the initialized records, so that we won't accidentally
6458
                 update them again if we insert a nop and continue.  */
6459
              md.slot[curr].unwind_record = last_ptr;
6460
            }
6461
        }
6462
 
6463
      manual_bundling_off = md.slot[curr].manual_bundling_off;
6464
      if (md.slot[curr].manual_bundling_on)
6465
        {
6466
          if (curr == first)
6467
            manual_bundling = 1;
6468
          else
6469
          break; /* Need to start a new bundle.  */
6470
        }
6471
 
6472
      /* If this instruction specifies a template, then it must be the first
6473
         instruction of a bundle.  */
6474
      if (curr != first && md.slot[curr].user_template >= 0)
6475
        break;
6476
 
6477
      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_SLOT2)
6478
        {
6479
          if (manual_bundling && !manual_bundling_off)
6480
            {
6481
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6482
                            _("`%s' must be last in bundle"), idesc->name);
6483
              if (i < 2)
6484
                manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6485
            }
6486
          i = 2;
6487
        }
6488
      if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_LAST)
6489
        {
6490
          int required_slot;
6491
          unsigned int required_template;
6492
 
6493
          /* If we need a stop bit after an M slot, our only choice is
6494
             template 5 (M;;MI).  If we need a stop bit after a B
6495
             slot, our only choice is to place it at the end of the
6496
             bundle, because the only available templates are MIB,
6497
             MBB, BBB, MMB, and MFB.  We don't handle anything other
6498
             than M and B slots because these are the only kind of
6499
             instructions that can have the IA64_OPCODE_LAST bit set.  */
6500
          required_template = template_val;
6501
          switch (idesc->type)
6502
            {
6503
            case IA64_TYPE_M:
6504
              required_slot = 0;
6505
              required_template = 5;
6506
              break;
6507
 
6508
            case IA64_TYPE_B:
6509
              required_slot = 2;
6510
              break;
6511
 
6512
            default:
6513
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6514
                            _("Internal error: don't know how to force %s to end of instruction group"),
6515
                            idesc->name);
6516
              required_slot = i;
6517
              break;
6518
            }
6519
          if (manual_bundling
6520
              && (i > required_slot
6521
                  || (required_slot == 2 && !manual_bundling_off)
6522
                  || (user_template >= 0
6523
                      /* Changing from MMI to M;MI is OK.  */
6524
                      && (template_val ^ required_template) > 1)))
6525
            {
6526
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6527
                            _("`%s' must be last in instruction group"),
6528
                            idesc->name);
6529
              if (i < 2 && required_slot == 2 && !manual_bundling_off)
6530
                manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6531
            }
6532
          if (required_slot < i)
6533
            /* Can't fit this instruction.  */
6534
            break;
6535
 
6536
          i = required_slot;
6537
          if (required_template != template_val)
6538
            {
6539
              /* If we switch the template, we need to reset the NOPs
6540
                 after slot i.  The slot-types of the instructions ahead
6541
                 of i never change, so we don't need to worry about
6542
                 changing NOPs in front of this slot.  */
6543
              for (j = i; j < 3; ++j)
6544
                insn[j] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[required_template].exec_unit[j]];
6545
 
6546
              /* We just picked a template that includes the stop bit in the
6547
                 middle, so we don't need another one emitted later.  */
6548
              md.slot[curr].end_of_insn_group = 0;
6549
            }
6550
          template_val = required_template;
6551
        }
6552
      if (curr != first && md.slot[curr].label_fixups)
6553
        {
6554
          if (manual_bundling)
6555
            {
6556
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6557
                            _("Label must be first in a bundle"));
6558
              manual_bundling = -1; /* Suppress meaningless post-loop errors.  */
6559
            }
6560
          /* This insn must go into the first slot of a bundle.  */
6561
          break;
6562
        }
6563
 
6564
      if (end_of_insn_group && md.num_slots_in_use >= 1)
6565
        {
6566
          /* We need an instruction group boundary in the middle of a
6567
             bundle.  See if we can switch to an other template with
6568
             an appropriate boundary.  */
6569
 
6570
          orig_template = template_val;
6571
          if (i == 1 && (user_template == 4
6572
                         || (user_template < 0
6573
                             && (ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[0]
6574
                                 == IA64_UNIT_M))))
6575
            {
6576
              template_val = 5;
6577
              end_of_insn_group = 0;
6578
            }
6579
          else if (i == 2 && (user_template == 0
6580
                              || (user_template < 0
6581
                                  && (ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[1]
6582
                                      == IA64_UNIT_I)))
6583
                   /* This test makes sure we don't switch the template if
6584
                      the next instruction is one that needs to be first in
6585
                      an instruction group.  Since all those instructions are
6586
                      in the M group, there is no way such an instruction can
6587
                      fit in this bundle even if we switch the template.  The
6588
                      reason we have to check for this is that otherwise we
6589
                      may end up generating "MI;;I M.." which has the deadly
6590
                      effect that the second M instruction is no longer the
6591
                      first in the group! --davidm 99/12/16  */
6592
                   && (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST) == 0)
6593
            {
6594
              template_val = 1;
6595
              end_of_insn_group = 0;
6596
            }
6597
          else if (i == 1
6598
                   && user_template == 0
6599
                   && !(idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST))
6600
            /* Use the next slot.  */
6601
            continue;
6602
          else if (curr != first)
6603
            /* can't fit this insn */
6604
            break;
6605
 
6606
          if (template_val != orig_template)
6607
            /* if we switch the template, we need to reset the NOPs
6608
               after slot i.  The slot-types of the instructions ahead
6609
               of i never change, so we don't need to worry about
6610
               changing NOPs in front of this slot.  */
6611
            for (j = i; j < 3; ++j)
6612
              insn[j] = nop[ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[j]];
6613
        }
6614
      required_unit = ia64_templ_desc[template_val].exec_unit[i];
6615
 
6616
      /* resolve dynamic opcodes such as "break", "hint", and "nop":  */
6617
      if (idesc->type == IA64_TYPE_DYN)
6618
        {
6619
          enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
6620
 
6621
          if ((strcmp (idesc->name, "nop") == 0)
6622
              || (strcmp (idesc->name, "break") == 0))
6623
            insn_unit = required_unit;
6624
          else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "hint") == 0)
6625
            {
6626
              insn_unit = required_unit;
6627
              if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_B)
6628
                {
6629
                  switch (md.hint_b)
6630
                    {
6631
                    case hint_b_ok:
6632
                      break;
6633
                    case hint_b_warning:
6634
                      as_warn (_("hint in B unit may be treated as nop"));
6635
                      break;
6636
                    case hint_b_error:
6637
                      /* When manual bundling is off and there is no
6638
                         user template, we choose a different unit so
6639
                         that hint won't go into the current slot. We
6640
                         will fill the current bundle with nops and
6641
                         try to put hint into the next bundle.  */
6642
                      if (!manual_bundling && user_template < 0)
6643
                        insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I;
6644
                      else
6645
                        as_bad (_("hint in B unit can't be used"));
6646
                      break;
6647
                    }
6648
                }
6649
            }
6650
          else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "chk.s") == 0
6651
              || strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0)
6652
            {
6653
              insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_M;
6654
              if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_I
6655
                  || (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_F && template_val == 6))
6656
                insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I;
6657
            }
6658
          else
6659
            as_fatal (_("emit_one_bundle: unexpected dynamic op"));
6660
 
6661
          snprintf (mnemonic, sizeof (mnemonic), "%s.%c",
6662
                    idesc->name, "?imbfxx"[insn_unit]);
6663
          opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
6664
          opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
6665
          ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
6666
          idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
6667
          /* moves to/from ARs have collisions */
6668
          if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3 || opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
6669
            {
6670
              while (idesc != NULL
6671
                     && (idesc->operands[0] != opnd1
6672
                         || idesc->operands[1] != opnd2))
6673
                idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc);
6674
            }
6675
          md.slot[curr].idesc = idesc;
6676
        }
6677
      else
6678
        {
6679
          insn_type = idesc->type;
6680
          insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_NIL;
6681
          switch (insn_type)
6682
            {
6683
            case IA64_TYPE_A:
6684
              if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_I || required_unit == IA64_UNIT_M)
6685
                insn_unit = required_unit;
6686
              break;
6687
            case IA64_TYPE_X: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_L; break;
6688
            case IA64_TYPE_I: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_I; break;
6689
            case IA64_TYPE_M: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_M; break;
6690
            case IA64_TYPE_B: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_B; break;
6691
            case IA64_TYPE_F: insn_unit = IA64_UNIT_F; break;
6692
            default:                                   break;
6693
            }
6694
        }
6695
 
6696
      if (insn_unit != required_unit)
6697
        continue;               /* Try next slot.  */
6698
 
6699
      /* Now is a good time to fix up the labels for this insn.  */
6700
      mark_label = FALSE;
6701
      for (lfix = md.slot[curr].label_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
6702
        {
6703
          S_SET_VALUE (lfix->sym, frag_now_fix () - 16);
6704
          symbol_set_frag (lfix->sym, frag_now);
6705
          mark_label |= lfix->dw2_mark_labels;
6706
        }
6707
      for (lfix = md.slot[curr].tag_fixups; lfix; lfix = lfix->next)
6708
        {
6709
          S_SET_VALUE (lfix->sym, frag_now_fix () - 16 + i);
6710
          symbol_set_frag (lfix->sym, frag_now);
6711
        }
6712
 
6713
      if (debug_type == DEBUG_DWARF2
6714
          || md.slot[curr].loc_directive_seen
6715
          || mark_label)
6716
        {
6717
          bfd_vma addr = frag_now->fr_address + frag_now_fix () - 16 + i;
6718
 
6719
          md.slot[curr].loc_directive_seen = 0;
6720
          if (mark_label)
6721
            md.slot[curr].debug_line.flags |= DWARF2_FLAG_BASIC_BLOCK;
6722
 
6723
          dwarf2_gen_line_info (addr, &md.slot[curr].debug_line);
6724
        }
6725
 
6726
      build_insn (md.slot + curr, insn + i);
6727
 
6728
      ptr = md.slot[curr].unwind_record;
6729
      if (ptr)
6730
        {
6731
          /* Set slot numbers for all remaining unwind records belonging to the
6732
             current insn.  There can not be any prologue/body unwind records
6733
             here.  */
6734
          for (; ptr != end_ptr; ptr = ptr->next)
6735
            {
6736
              ptr->slot_number = (unsigned long) f + i;
6737
              ptr->slot_frag = frag_now;
6738
            }
6739
          md.slot[curr].unwind_record = NULL;
6740
        }
6741
 
6742
      if (required_unit == IA64_UNIT_L)
6743
        {
6744
          know (i == 1);
6745
          /* skip one slot for long/X-unit instructions */
6746
          ++i;
6747
        }
6748
      --md.num_slots_in_use;
6749
      last_slot = i;
6750
 
6751
      for (j = 0; j < md.slot[curr].num_fixups; ++j)
6752
        {
6753
          ifix = md.slot[curr].fixup + j;
6754
          fix = fix_new_exp (frag_now, frag_now_fix () - 16 + i, 8,
6755
                             &ifix->expr, ifix->is_pcrel, ifix->code);
6756
          fix->tc_fix_data.opnd = ifix->opnd;
6757
          fix->fx_file = md.slot[curr].src_file;
6758
          fix->fx_line = md.slot[curr].src_line;
6759
        }
6760
 
6761
      end_of_insn_group = md.slot[curr].end_of_insn_group;
6762
 
6763
      /* clear slot:  */
6764
      ia64_free_opcode (md.slot[curr].idesc);
6765
      memset (md.slot + curr, 0, sizeof (md.slot[curr]));
6766
      md.slot[curr].user_template = -1;
6767
 
6768
      if (manual_bundling_off)
6769
        {
6770
          manual_bundling = 0;
6771
          break;
6772
        }
6773
      curr = (curr + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
6774
      idesc = md.slot[curr].idesc;
6775
    }
6776
 
6777
  /* A user template was specified, but the first following instruction did
6778
     not fit.  This can happen with or without manual bundling.  */
6779
  if (md.num_slots_in_use > 0 && last_slot < 0)
6780
    {
6781
      as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6782
                    _("`%s' does not fit into %s template"),
6783
                    idesc->name, ia64_templ_desc[template_val].name);
6784
      /* Drop first insn so we don't livelock.  */
6785
      --md.num_slots_in_use;
6786
      know (curr == first);
6787
      ia64_free_opcode (md.slot[curr].idesc);
6788
      memset (md.slot + curr, 0, sizeof (md.slot[curr]));
6789
      md.slot[curr].user_template = -1;
6790
    }
6791
  else if (manual_bundling > 0)
6792
    {
6793
      if (md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
6794
        {
6795
          if (last_slot >= 2)
6796
            as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6797
                          _("`%s' does not fit into bundle"), idesc->name);
6798
          else
6799
            {
6800
              const char *where;
6801
 
6802
              if (template_val == 2)
6803
                where = "X slot";
6804
              else if (last_slot == 0)
6805
                where = "slots 2 or 3";
6806
              else
6807
                where = "slot 3";
6808
              as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6809
                            _("`%s' can't go in %s of %s template"),
6810
                            idesc->name, where, ia64_templ_desc[template_val].name);
6811
            }
6812
        }
6813
      else
6814
        as_bad_where (md.slot[curr].src_file, md.slot[curr].src_line,
6815
                      _("Missing '}' at end of file"));
6816
    }
6817
 
6818
  know (md.num_slots_in_use < NUM_SLOTS);
6819
 
6820
  t0 = end_of_insn_group | (template_val << 1) | (insn[0] << 5) | (insn[1] << 46);
6821
  t1 = ((insn[1] >> 18) & 0x7fffff) | (insn[2] << 23);
6822
 
6823
  number_to_chars_littleendian (f + 0, t0, 8);
6824
  number_to_chars_littleendian (f + 8, t1, 8);
6825
}
6826
 
6827
int
6828
md_parse_option (int c, char *arg)
6829
{
6830
 
6831
  switch (c)
6832
    {
6833
    /* Switches from the Intel assembler.  */
6834
    case 'm':
6835
      if (strcmp (arg, "ilp64") == 0
6836
          || strcmp (arg, "lp64") == 0
6837
          || strcmp (arg, "p64") == 0)
6838
        {
6839
          md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ABI64;
6840
        }
6841
      else if (strcmp (arg, "ilp32") == 0)
6842
        {
6843
          md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_ABI64;
6844
        }
6845
      else if (strcmp (arg, "le") == 0)
6846
        {
6847
          md.flags &= ~EF_IA_64_BE;
6848
          default_big_endian = 0;
6849
        }
6850
      else if (strcmp (arg, "be") == 0)
6851
        {
6852
          md.flags |= EF_IA_64_BE;
6853
          default_big_endian = 1;
6854
        }
6855
      else if (strncmp (arg, "unwind-check=", 13) == 0)
6856
        {
6857
          arg += 13;
6858
          if (strcmp (arg, "warning") == 0)
6859
            md.unwind_check = unwind_check_warning;
6860
          else if (strcmp (arg, "error") == 0)
6861
            md.unwind_check = unwind_check_error;
6862
          else
6863
            return 0;
6864
        }
6865
      else if (strncmp (arg, "hint.b=", 7) == 0)
6866
        {
6867
          arg += 7;
6868
          if (strcmp (arg, "ok") == 0)
6869
            md.hint_b = hint_b_ok;
6870
          else if (strcmp (arg, "warning") == 0)
6871
            md.hint_b = hint_b_warning;
6872
          else if (strcmp (arg, "error") == 0)
6873
            md.hint_b = hint_b_error;
6874
          else
6875
            return 0;
6876
        }
6877
      else if (strncmp (arg, "tune=", 5) == 0)
6878
        {
6879
          arg += 5;
6880
          if (strcmp (arg, "itanium1") == 0)
6881
            md.tune = itanium1;
6882
          else if (strcmp (arg, "itanium2") == 0)
6883
            md.tune = itanium2;
6884
          else
6885
            return 0;
6886
        }
6887
      else
6888
        return 0;
6889
      break;
6890
 
6891
    case 'N':
6892
      if (strcmp (arg, "so") == 0)
6893
        {
6894
          /* Suppress signon message.  */
6895
        }
6896
      else if (strcmp (arg, "pi") == 0)
6897
        {
6898
          /* Reject privileged instructions.  FIXME */
6899
        }
6900
      else if (strcmp (arg, "us") == 0)
6901
        {
6902
          /* Allow union of signed and unsigned range.  FIXME */
6903
        }
6904
      else if (strcmp (arg, "close_fcalls") == 0)
6905
        {
6906
          /* Do not resolve global function calls.  */
6907
        }
6908
      else
6909
        return 0;
6910
      break;
6911
 
6912
    case 'C':
6913
      /* temp[="prefix"]  Insert temporary labels into the object file
6914
                          symbol table prefixed by "prefix".
6915
                          Default prefix is ":temp:".
6916
       */
6917
      break;
6918
 
6919
    case 'a':
6920
      /* indirect=<tgt> Assume unannotated indirect branches behavior
6921
                        according to <tgt> --
6922
                        exit:   branch out from the current context (default)
6923
                        labels: all labels in context may be branch targets
6924
       */
6925
      if (strncmp (arg, "indirect=", 9) != 0)
6926
        return 0;
6927
      break;
6928
 
6929
    case 'x':
6930
      /* -X conflicts with an ignored option, use -x instead */
6931
      md.detect_dv = 1;
6932
      if (!arg || strcmp (arg, "explicit") == 0)
6933
        {
6934
          /* set default mode to explicit */
6935
          md.default_explicit_mode = 1;
6936
          break;
6937
        }
6938
      else if (strcmp (arg, "auto") == 0)
6939
        {
6940
          md.default_explicit_mode = 0;
6941
        }
6942
      else if (strcmp (arg, "none") == 0)
6943
        {
6944
          md.detect_dv = 0;
6945
        }
6946
      else if (strcmp (arg, "debug") == 0)
6947
        {
6948
          md.debug_dv = 1;
6949
        }
6950
      else if (strcmp (arg, "debugx") == 0)
6951
        {
6952
          md.default_explicit_mode = 1;
6953
          md.debug_dv = 1;
6954
        }
6955
      else if (strcmp (arg, "debugn") == 0)
6956
        {
6957
          md.debug_dv = 1;
6958
          md.detect_dv = 0;
6959
        }
6960
      else
6961
        {
6962
          as_bad (_("Unrecognized option '-x%s'"), arg);
6963
        }
6964
      break;
6965
 
6966
    case 'S':
6967
      /* nops           Print nops statistics.  */
6968
      break;
6969
 
6970
    /* GNU specific switches for gcc.  */
6971
    case OPTION_MCONSTANT_GP:
6972
      md.flags |= EF_IA_64_CONS_GP;
6973
      break;
6974
 
6975
    case OPTION_MAUTO_PIC:
6976
      md.flags |= EF_IA_64_NOFUNCDESC_CONS_GP;
6977
      break;
6978
 
6979
    default:
6980
      return 0;
6981
    }
6982
 
6983
  return 1;
6984
}
6985
 
6986
void
6987
md_show_usage (FILE *stream)
6988
{
6989
  fputs (_("\
6990
IA-64 options:\n\
6991
  --mconstant-gp          mark output file as using the constant-GP model\n\
6992
                          (sets ELF header flag EF_IA_64_CONS_GP)\n\
6993
  --mauto-pic             mark output file as using the constant-GP model\n\
6994
                          without function descriptors (sets ELF header flag\n\
6995
                          EF_IA_64_NOFUNCDESC_CONS_GP)\n\
6996
  -milp32|-milp64|-mlp64|-mp64  select data model (default -mlp64)\n\
6997
  -mle | -mbe             select little- or big-endian byte order (default -mle)\n\
6998
  -mtune=[itanium1|itanium2]\n\
6999
                          tune for a specific CPU (default -mtune=itanium2)\n\
7000
  -munwind-check=[warning|error]\n\
7001
                          unwind directive check (default -munwind-check=warning)\n\
7002
  -mhint.b=[ok|warning|error]\n\
7003
                          hint.b check (default -mhint.b=error)\n\
7004
  -x | -xexplicit         turn on dependency violation checking\n"), stream);
7005
  /* Note for translators: "automagically" can be translated as "automatically" here.  */
7006
  fputs (_("\
7007
  -xauto                  automagically remove dependency violations (default)\n\
7008
  -xnone                  turn off dependency violation checking\n\
7009
  -xdebug                 debug dependency violation checker\n\
7010
  -xdebugn                debug dependency violation checker but turn off\n\
7011
                          dependency violation checking\n\
7012
  -xdebugx                debug dependency violation checker and turn on\n\
7013
                          dependency violation checking\n"),
7014
        stream);
7015
}
7016
 
7017
void
7018
ia64_after_parse_args (void)
7019
{
7020
  if (debug_type == DEBUG_STABS)
7021
    as_fatal (_("--gstabs is not supported for ia64"));
7022
}
7023
 
7024
/* Return true if TYPE fits in TEMPL at SLOT.  */
7025
 
7026
static int
7027
match (int templ, int type, int slot)
7028
{
7029
  enum ia64_unit unit;
7030
  int result;
7031
 
7032
  unit = ia64_templ_desc[templ].exec_unit[slot];
7033
  switch (type)
7034
    {
7035
    case IA64_TYPE_DYN: result = 1; break; /* for nop and break */
7036
    case IA64_TYPE_A:
7037
      result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_I || unit == IA64_UNIT_M);
7038
      break;
7039
    case IA64_TYPE_X:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_L); break;
7040
    case IA64_TYPE_I:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_I); break;
7041
    case IA64_TYPE_M:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_M); break;
7042
    case IA64_TYPE_B:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_B); break;
7043
    case IA64_TYPE_F:   result = (unit == IA64_UNIT_F); break;
7044
    default:            result = 0; break;
7045
    }
7046
  return result;
7047
}
7048
 
7049
/* For Itanium 1, add a bit of extra goodness if a nop of type F or B would fit
7050
   in TEMPL at SLOT.  For Itanium 2, add a bit of extra goodness if a nop of
7051
   type M or I would fit in TEMPL at SLOT.  */
7052
 
7053
static inline int
7054
extra_goodness (int templ, int slot)
7055
{
7056
  switch (md.tune)
7057
    {
7058
    case itanium1:
7059
      if (slot == 1 && match (templ, IA64_TYPE_F, slot))
7060
        return 2;
7061
      else if (slot == 2 && match (templ, IA64_TYPE_B, slot))
7062
        return 1;
7063
      else
7064
        return 0;
7065
      break;
7066
    case itanium2:
7067
      if (match (templ, IA64_TYPE_M, slot)
7068
          || match (templ, IA64_TYPE_I, slot))
7069
        /* Favor M- and I-unit NOPs.  We definitely want to avoid
7070
           F-unit and B-unit may cause split-issue or less-than-optimal
7071
           branch-prediction.  */
7072
        return 2;
7073
      else
7074
        return 0;
7075
      break;
7076
    default:
7077
      abort ();
7078
      return 0;
7079
    }
7080
}
7081
 
7082
/* This function is called once, at assembler startup time.  It sets
7083
   up all the tables, etc. that the MD part of the assembler will need
7084
   that can be determined before arguments are parsed.  */
7085
void
7086
md_begin (void)
7087
{
7088
  int i, j, k, t, goodness, best, ok;
7089
  const char *err;
7090
  char name[8];
7091
 
7092
  md.auto_align = 1;
7093
  md.explicit_mode = md.default_explicit_mode;
7094
 
7095
  bfd_set_section_alignment (stdoutput, text_section, 4);
7096
 
7097
  /* Make sure function pointers get initialized.  */
7098
  target_big_endian = -1;
7099
  dot_byteorder (default_big_endian);
7100
 
7101
  alias_hash = hash_new ();
7102
  alias_name_hash = hash_new ();
7103
  secalias_hash = hash_new ();
7104
  secalias_name_hash = hash_new ();
7105
 
7106
  pseudo_func[FUNC_DTP_MODULE].u.sym =
7107
    symbol_new (".<dtpmod>", undefined_section, FUNC_DTP_MODULE,
7108
                &zero_address_frag);
7109
 
7110
  pseudo_func[FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7111
    symbol_new (".<dtprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE,
7112
                &zero_address_frag);
7113
 
7114
  pseudo_func[FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7115
    symbol_new (".<fptr>", undefined_section, FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE,
7116
                &zero_address_frag);
7117
 
7118
  pseudo_func[FUNC_GP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7119
    symbol_new (".<gprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_GP_RELATIVE,
7120
                &zero_address_frag);
7121
 
7122
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7123
    symbol_new (".<ltoff>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_RELATIVE,
7124
                &zero_address_frag);
7125
 
7126
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X].u.sym =
7127
    symbol_new (".<ltoffx>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X,
7128
                &zero_address_frag);
7129
 
7130
  pseudo_func[FUNC_PC_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7131
    symbol_new (".<pcrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_PC_RELATIVE,
7132
                &zero_address_frag);
7133
 
7134
  pseudo_func[FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7135
    symbol_new (".<pltoff>", undefined_section, FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE,
7136
                &zero_address_frag);
7137
 
7138
  pseudo_func[FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7139
    symbol_new (".<secrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE,
7140
                &zero_address_frag);
7141
 
7142
  pseudo_func[FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7143
    symbol_new (".<segrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE,
7144
                &zero_address_frag);
7145
 
7146
  pseudo_func[FUNC_TP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7147
    symbol_new (".<tprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_TP_RELATIVE,
7148
                &zero_address_frag);
7149
 
7150
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7151
    symbol_new (".<ltv>", undefined_section, FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE,
7152
                &zero_address_frag);
7153
 
7154
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7155
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.fptr>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE,
7156
                &zero_address_frag);
7157
 
7158
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE].u.sym =
7159
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.dtpmod>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE,
7160
                &zero_address_frag);
7161
 
7162
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7163
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.dptrel>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE,
7164
                &zero_address_frag);
7165
 
7166
  pseudo_func[FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE].u.sym =
7167
    symbol_new (".<ltoff.tprel>", undefined_section, FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE,
7168
                &zero_address_frag);
7169
 
7170
  pseudo_func[FUNC_IPLT_RELOC].u.sym =
7171
    symbol_new (".<iplt>", undefined_section, FUNC_IPLT_RELOC,
7172
                &zero_address_frag);
7173
 
7174
#ifdef TE_VMS
7175
  pseudo_func[FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC].u.sym =
7176
    symbol_new (".<slotcount>", undefined_section, FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC,
7177
                &zero_address_frag);
7178
#endif
7179
 
7180
 if (md.tune != itanium1)
7181
   {
7182
     /* Convert MFI NOPs bundles into MMI NOPs bundles.  */
7183
     le_nop[0] = 0x8;
7184
     le_nop_stop[0] = 0x9;
7185
   }
7186
 
7187
  /* Compute the table of best templates.  We compute goodness as a
7188
     base 4 value, in which each match counts for 3.  Match-failures
7189
     result in NOPs and we use extra_goodness() to pick the execution
7190
     units that are best suited for issuing the NOP.  */
7191
  for (i = 0; i < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++i)
7192
    for (j = 0; j < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++j)
7193
      for (k = 0; k < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++k)
7194
        {
7195
          best = 0;
7196
          for (t = 0; t < NELEMS (ia64_templ_desc); ++t)
7197
            {
7198
              goodness = 0;
7199
              if (match (t, i, 0))
7200
                {
7201
                  if (match (t, j, 1))
7202
                    {
7203
                      if ((t == 2 && j == IA64_TYPE_X) || match (t, k, 2))
7204
                        goodness = 3 + 3 + 3;
7205
                      else
7206
                        goodness = 3 + 3 + extra_goodness (t, 2);
7207
                    }
7208
                  else if (match (t, j, 2))
7209
                    goodness = 3 + 3 + extra_goodness (t, 1);
7210
                  else
7211
                    {
7212
                      goodness = 3;
7213
                      goodness += extra_goodness (t, 1);
7214
                      goodness += extra_goodness (t, 2);
7215
                    }
7216
                }
7217
              else if (match (t, i, 1))
7218
                {
7219
                  if ((t == 2 && i == IA64_TYPE_X) || match (t, j, 2))
7220
                    goodness = 3 + 3;
7221
                  else
7222
                    goodness = 3 + extra_goodness (t, 2);
7223
                }
7224
              else if (match (t, i, 2))
7225
                goodness = 3 + extra_goodness (t, 1);
7226
 
7227
              if (goodness > best)
7228
                {
7229
                  best = goodness;
7230
                  best_template[i][j][k] = t;
7231
                }
7232
            }
7233
        }
7234
 
7235
#ifdef DEBUG_TEMPLATES
7236
  /* For debugging changes to the best_template calculations.  We don't care
7237
     about combinations with invalid instructions, so start the loops at 1.  */
7238
  for (i = 0; i < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++i)
7239
    for (j = 0; j < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++j)
7240
      for (k = 0; k < IA64_NUM_TYPES; ++k)
7241
        {
7242
          char type_letter[IA64_NUM_TYPES] = { 'n', 'a', 'i', 'm', 'b', 'f',
7243
                                               'x', 'd' };
7244
          fprintf (stderr, "%c%c%c %s\n", type_letter[i], type_letter[j],
7245
                   type_letter[k],
7246
                   ia64_templ_desc[best_template[i][j][k]].name);
7247
        }
7248
#endif
7249
 
7250
  for (i = 0; i < NUM_SLOTS; ++i)
7251
    md.slot[i].user_template = -1;
7252
 
7253
  md.pseudo_hash = hash_new ();
7254
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (pseudo_opcode); ++i)
7255
    {
7256
      err = hash_insert (md.pseudo_hash, pseudo_opcode[i].name,
7257
                         (void *) (pseudo_opcode + i));
7258
      if (err)
7259
        as_fatal (_("ia64.md_begin: can't hash `%s': %s"),
7260
                  pseudo_opcode[i].name, err);
7261
    }
7262
 
7263
  md.reg_hash = hash_new ();
7264
  md.dynreg_hash = hash_new ();
7265
  md.const_hash = hash_new ();
7266
  md.entry_hash = hash_new ();
7267
 
7268
  /* general registers:  */
7269
  declare_register_set ("r", 128, REG_GR);
7270
  declare_register ("gp", REG_GR +  1);
7271
  declare_register ("sp", REG_GR + 12);
7272
  declare_register ("tp", REG_GR + 13);
7273
  declare_register_set ("ret", 4, REG_GR + 8);
7274
 
7275
  /* floating point registers:  */
7276
  declare_register_set ("f", 128, REG_FR);
7277
  declare_register_set ("farg", 8, REG_FR + 8);
7278
  declare_register_set ("fret", 8, REG_FR + 8);
7279
 
7280
  /* branch registers:  */
7281
  declare_register_set ("b", 8, REG_BR);
7282
  declare_register ("rp", REG_BR + 0);
7283
 
7284
  /* predicate registers:  */
7285
  declare_register_set ("p", 64, REG_P);
7286
  declare_register ("pr", REG_PR);
7287
  declare_register ("pr.rot", REG_PR_ROT);
7288
 
7289
  /* application registers:  */
7290
  declare_register_set ("ar", 128, REG_AR);
7291
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (ar); ++i)
7292
    declare_register (ar[i].name, REG_AR + ar[i].regnum);
7293
 
7294
  /* control registers:  */
7295
  declare_register_set ("cr", 128, REG_CR);
7296
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (cr); ++i)
7297
    declare_register (cr[i].name, REG_CR + cr[i].regnum);
7298
 
7299
  declare_register ("ip", REG_IP);
7300
  declare_register ("cfm", REG_CFM);
7301
  declare_register ("psr", REG_PSR);
7302
  declare_register ("psr.l", REG_PSR_L);
7303
  declare_register ("psr.um", REG_PSR_UM);
7304
 
7305
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (indirect_reg); ++i)
7306
    {
7307
      unsigned int regnum = indirect_reg[i].regnum;
7308
 
7309
      md.indregsym[regnum - IND_CPUID] = declare_register (indirect_reg[i].name, regnum);
7310
    }
7311
 
7312
  /* pseudo-registers used to specify unwind info:  */
7313
  declare_register ("psp", REG_PSP);
7314
 
7315
  for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (const_bits); ++i)
7316
    {
7317
      err = hash_insert (md.const_hash, const_bits[i].name,
7318
                         (void *) (const_bits + i));
7319
      if (err)
7320
        as_fatal (_("Inserting \"%s\" into constant hash table failed: %s"),
7321
                  name, err);
7322
    }
7323
 
7324
  /* Set the architecture and machine depending on defaults and command line
7325
     options.  */
7326
  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7327
    ok = bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_ia64, bfd_mach_ia64_elf64);
7328
  else
7329
    ok = bfd_set_arch_mach (stdoutput, bfd_arch_ia64, bfd_mach_ia64_elf32);
7330
 
7331
  if (! ok)
7332
     as_warn (_("Could not set architecture and machine"));
7333
 
7334
  /* Set the pointer size and pointer shift size depending on md.flags */
7335
 
7336
  if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7337
    {
7338
      md.pointer_size = 8;         /* pointers are 8 bytes */
7339
      md.pointer_size_shift = 3;   /* alignment is 8 bytes = 2^2 */
7340
    }
7341
  else
7342
    {
7343
      md.pointer_size = 4;         /* pointers are 4 bytes */
7344
      md.pointer_size_shift = 2;   /* alignment is 4 bytes = 2^2 */
7345
    }
7346
 
7347
  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
7348
  md.path = 0;
7349
  md.maxpaths = 0;
7350
  md.entry_labels = NULL;
7351
}
7352
 
7353
/* Set the default options in md.  Cannot do this in md_begin because
7354
   that is called after md_parse_option which is where we set the
7355
   options in md based on command line options.  */
7356
 
7357
void
7358
ia64_init (int argc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **argv ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7359
{
7360
  md.flags = MD_FLAGS_DEFAULT;
7361
#ifndef TE_VMS
7362
  /* Don't turn on dependency checking for VMS, doesn't work.  */
7363
  md.detect_dv = 1;
7364
#endif
7365
  /* FIXME: We should change it to unwind_check_error someday.  */
7366
  md.unwind_check = unwind_check_warning;
7367
  md.hint_b = hint_b_error;
7368
  md.tune = itanium2;
7369
}
7370
 
7371
/* Return a string for the target object file format.  */
7372
 
7373
const char *
7374
ia64_target_format (void)
7375
{
7376
  if (OUTPUT_FLAVOR == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7377
    {
7378
      if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_BE)
7379
        {
7380
          if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7381
#if defined(TE_AIX50)
7382
            return "elf64-ia64-aix-big";
7383
#elif defined(TE_HPUX)
7384
            return "elf64-ia64-hpux-big";
7385
#else
7386
            return "elf64-ia64-big";
7387
#endif
7388
          else
7389
#if defined(TE_AIX50)
7390
            return "elf32-ia64-aix-big";
7391
#elif defined(TE_HPUX)
7392
            return "elf32-ia64-hpux-big";
7393
#else
7394
            return "elf32-ia64-big";
7395
#endif
7396
        }
7397
      else
7398
        {
7399
          if (md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64)
7400
#if defined (TE_AIX50)
7401
            return "elf64-ia64-aix-little";
7402
#elif defined (TE_VMS)
7403
          {
7404
            md.flags |= EF_IA_64_ARCHVER_1;
7405
            return "elf64-ia64-vms";
7406
          }
7407
#else
7408
            return "elf64-ia64-little";
7409
#endif
7410
          else
7411
#ifdef TE_AIX50
7412
            return "elf32-ia64-aix-little";
7413
#else
7414
            return "elf32-ia64-little";
7415
#endif
7416
        }
7417
    }
7418
  else
7419
    return "unknown-format";
7420
}
7421
 
7422
void
7423
ia64_end_of_source (void)
7424
{
7425
  /* terminate insn group upon reaching end of file:  */
7426
  insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7427
 
7428
  /* emits slots we haven't written yet:  */
7429
  ia64_flush_insns ();
7430
 
7431
  bfd_set_private_flags (stdoutput, md.flags);
7432
 
7433
  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
7434
}
7435
 
7436
void
7437
ia64_start_line (void)
7438
{
7439
  static int first;
7440
 
7441
  if (!first) {
7442
    /* Make sure we don't reference input_line_pointer[-1] when that's
7443
       not valid.  */
7444
    first = 1;
7445
    return;
7446
  }
7447
 
7448
  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
7449
    as_bad (_("qualifying predicate not followed by instruction"));
7450
  md.qp.X_op = O_absent;
7451
 
7452
  if (ignore_input ())
7453
    return;
7454
 
7455
  if (input_line_pointer[0] == ';' && input_line_pointer[-1] == ';')
7456
    {
7457
      if (md.detect_dv && !md.explicit_mode)
7458
        {
7459
          static int warned;
7460
 
7461
          if (!warned)
7462
            {
7463
              warned = 1;
7464
              as_warn (_("Explicit stops are ignored in auto mode"));
7465
            }
7466
        }
7467
      else
7468
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7469
    }
7470
  else if (input_line_pointer[-1] == '{')
7471
    {
7472
      if (md.manual_bundling)
7473
        as_warn (_("Found '{' when manual bundling is already turned on"));
7474
      else
7475
        CURR_SLOT.manual_bundling_on = 1;
7476
      md.manual_bundling = 1;
7477
 
7478
      /* Bundling is only acceptable in explicit mode
7479
         or when in default automatic mode.  */
7480
      if (md.detect_dv && !md.explicit_mode)
7481
        {
7482
          if (!md.mode_explicitly_set
7483
              && !md.default_explicit_mode)
7484
            dot_dv_mode ('E');
7485
          else
7486
            as_warn (_("Found '{' after explicit switch to automatic mode"));
7487
        }
7488
    }
7489
  else if (input_line_pointer[-1] == '}')
7490
    {
7491
      if (!md.manual_bundling)
7492
        as_warn (_("Found '}' when manual bundling is off"));
7493
      else
7494
        PREV_SLOT.manual_bundling_off = 1;
7495
      md.manual_bundling = 0;
7496
 
7497
      /* switch back to automatic mode, if applicable */
7498
      if (md.detect_dv
7499
          && md.explicit_mode
7500
          && !md.mode_explicitly_set
7501
          && !md.default_explicit_mode)
7502
        dot_dv_mode ('A');
7503
    }
7504
}
7505
 
7506
/* This is a hook for ia64_frob_label, so that it can distinguish tags from
7507
   labels.  */
7508
static int defining_tag = 0;
7509
 
7510
int
7511
ia64_unrecognized_line (int ch)
7512
{
7513
  switch (ch)
7514
    {
7515
    case '(':
7516
      expression_and_evaluate (&md.qp);
7517
      if (*input_line_pointer++ != ')')
7518
        {
7519
          as_bad (_("Expected ')'"));
7520
          return 0;
7521
        }
7522
      if (md.qp.X_op != O_register)
7523
        {
7524
          as_bad (_("Qualifying predicate expected"));
7525
          return 0;
7526
        }
7527
      if (md.qp.X_add_number < REG_P || md.qp.X_add_number >= REG_P + 64)
7528
        {
7529
          as_bad (_("Predicate register expected"));
7530
          return 0;
7531
        }
7532
      return 1;
7533
 
7534
    case '[':
7535
      {
7536
        char *s;
7537
        char c;
7538
        symbolS *tag;
7539
        int temp;
7540
 
7541
        if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
7542
          {
7543
            as_bad (_("Tag must come before qualifying predicate."));
7544
            return 0;
7545
          }
7546
 
7547
        /* This implements just enough of read_a_source_file in read.c to
7548
           recognize labels.  */
7549
        if (is_name_beginner (*input_line_pointer))
7550
          {
7551
            s = input_line_pointer;
7552
            c = get_symbol_end ();
7553
          }
7554
        else if (LOCAL_LABELS_FB
7555
                 && ISDIGIT (*input_line_pointer))
7556
          {
7557
            temp = 0;
7558
            while (ISDIGIT (*input_line_pointer))
7559
              temp = (temp * 10) + *input_line_pointer++ - '0';
7560
            fb_label_instance_inc (temp);
7561
            s = fb_label_name (temp, 0);
7562
            c = *input_line_pointer;
7563
          }
7564
        else
7565
          {
7566
            s = NULL;
7567
            c = '\0';
7568
          }
7569
        if (c != ':')
7570
          {
7571
            /* Put ':' back for error messages' sake.  */
7572
            *input_line_pointer++ = ':';
7573
            as_bad (_("Expected ':'"));
7574
            return 0;
7575
          }
7576
 
7577
        defining_tag = 1;
7578
        tag = colon (s);
7579
        defining_tag = 0;
7580
        /* Put ':' back for error messages' sake.  */
7581
        *input_line_pointer++ = ':';
7582
        if (*input_line_pointer++ != ']')
7583
          {
7584
            as_bad (_("Expected ']'"));
7585
            return 0;
7586
          }
7587
        if (! tag)
7588
          {
7589
            as_bad (_("Tag name expected"));
7590
            return 0;
7591
          }
7592
        return 1;
7593
      }
7594
 
7595
    default:
7596
      break;
7597
    }
7598
 
7599
  /* Not a valid line.  */
7600
  return 0;
7601
}
7602
 
7603
void
7604
ia64_frob_label (struct symbol *sym)
7605
{
7606
  struct label_fix *fix;
7607
 
7608
  /* Tags need special handling since they are not bundle breaks like
7609
     labels.  */
7610
  if (defining_tag)
7611
    {
7612
      fix = obstack_alloc (&notes, sizeof (*fix));
7613
      fix->sym = sym;
7614
      fix->next = CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups;
7615
      fix->dw2_mark_labels = FALSE;
7616
      CURR_SLOT.tag_fixups = fix;
7617
 
7618
      return;
7619
    }
7620
 
7621
  if (bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg) & SEC_CODE)
7622
    {
7623
      md.last_text_seg = now_seg;
7624
      fix = obstack_alloc (&notes, sizeof (*fix));
7625
      fix->sym = sym;
7626
      fix->next = CURR_SLOT.label_fixups;
7627
      fix->dw2_mark_labels = dwarf2_loc_mark_labels;
7628
      CURR_SLOT.label_fixups = fix;
7629
 
7630
      /* Keep track of how many code entry points we've seen.  */
7631
      if (md.path == md.maxpaths)
7632
        {
7633
          md.maxpaths += 20;
7634
          md.entry_labels = (const char **)
7635
            xrealloc ((void *) md.entry_labels,
7636
                      md.maxpaths * sizeof (char *));
7637
        }
7638
      md.entry_labels[md.path++] = S_GET_NAME (sym);
7639
    }
7640
}
7641
 
7642
#ifdef TE_HPUX
7643
/* The HP-UX linker will give unresolved symbol errors for symbols
7644
   that are declared but unused.  This routine removes declared,
7645
   unused symbols from an object.  */
7646
int
7647
ia64_frob_symbol (struct symbol *sym)
7648
{
7649
  if ((S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == &bfd_und_section && ! symbol_used_p (sym) &&
7650
       ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (S_GET_OTHER (sym)) == STV_DEFAULT)
7651
      || (S_GET_SEGMENT (sym) == &bfd_abs_section
7652
          && ! S_IS_EXTERNAL (sym)))
7653
    return 1;
7654
  return 0;
7655
}
7656
#endif
7657
 
7658
void
7659
ia64_flush_pending_output (void)
7660
{
7661
  if (!md.keep_pending_output
7662
      && bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, now_seg) & SEC_CODE)
7663
    {
7664
      /* ??? This causes many unnecessary stop bits to be emitted.
7665
         Unfortunately, it isn't clear if it is safe to remove this.  */
7666
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
7667
      ia64_flush_insns ();
7668
    }
7669
}
7670
 
7671
/* Do ia64-specific expression optimization.  All that's done here is
7672
   to transform index expressions that are either due to the indexing
7673
   of rotating registers or due to the indexing of indirect register
7674
   sets.  */
7675
int
7676
ia64_optimize_expr (expressionS *l, operatorT op, expressionS *r)
7677
{
7678
  if (op != O_index)
7679
    return 0;
7680
  resolve_expression (l);
7681
  if (l->X_op == O_register)
7682
    {
7683
      unsigned num_regs = l->X_add_number >> 16;
7684
 
7685
      resolve_expression (r);
7686
      if (num_regs)
7687
        {
7688
          /* Left side is a .rotX-allocated register.  */
7689
          if (r->X_op != O_constant)
7690
            {
7691
              as_bad (_("Rotating register index must be a non-negative constant"));
7692
              r->X_add_number = 0;
7693
            }
7694
          else if ((valueT) r->X_add_number >= num_regs)
7695
            {
7696
              as_bad (_("Index out of range 0..%u"), num_regs - 1);
7697
              r->X_add_number = 0;
7698
            }
7699
          l->X_add_number = (l->X_add_number & 0xffff) + r->X_add_number;
7700
          return 1;
7701
        }
7702
      else if (l->X_add_number >= IND_CPUID && l->X_add_number <= IND_RR)
7703
        {
7704
          if (r->X_op != O_register
7705
              || r->X_add_number < REG_GR
7706
              || r->X_add_number > REG_GR + 127)
7707
            {
7708
              as_bad (_("Indirect register index must be a general register"));
7709
              r->X_add_number = REG_GR;
7710
            }
7711
          l->X_op = O_index;
7712
          l->X_op_symbol = md.indregsym[l->X_add_number - IND_CPUID];
7713
          l->X_add_number = r->X_add_number;
7714
          return 1;
7715
        }
7716
    }
7717
  as_bad (_("Index can only be applied to rotating or indirect registers"));
7718
  /* Fall back to some register use of which has as little as possible
7719
     side effects, to minimize subsequent error messages.  */
7720
  l->X_op = O_register;
7721
  l->X_add_number = REG_GR + 3;
7722
  return 1;
7723
}
7724
 
7725
int
7726
ia64_parse_name (char *name, expressionS *e, char *nextcharP)
7727
{
7728
  struct const_desc *cdesc;
7729
  struct dynreg *dr = 0;
7730
  unsigned int idx;
7731
  struct symbol *sym;
7732
  char *end;
7733
 
7734
  if (*name == '@')
7735
    {
7736
      enum pseudo_type pseudo_type = PSEUDO_FUNC_NONE;
7737
 
7738
      /* Find what relocation pseudo-function we're dealing with.  */
7739
      for (idx = 0; idx < NELEMS (pseudo_func); ++idx)
7740
        if (pseudo_func[idx].name
7741
            && pseudo_func[idx].name[0] == name[1]
7742
            && strcmp (pseudo_func[idx].name + 1, name + 2) == 0)
7743
          {
7744
            pseudo_type = pseudo_func[idx].type;
7745
            break;
7746
          }
7747
      switch (pseudo_type)
7748
        {
7749
        case PSEUDO_FUNC_RELOC:
7750
          end = input_line_pointer;
7751
          if (*nextcharP != '(')
7752
            {
7753
              as_bad (_("Expected '('"));
7754
              break;
7755
            }
7756
          /* Skip '('.  */
7757
          ++input_line_pointer;
7758
          expression (e);
7759
          if (*input_line_pointer != ')')
7760
            {
7761
              as_bad (_("Missing ')'"));
7762
              goto done;
7763
            }
7764
          /* Skip ')'.  */
7765
          ++input_line_pointer;
7766
#ifdef TE_VMS
7767
          if (idx == FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC)
7768
            {
7769
              /* @slotcount can accept any expression.  Canonicalize.  */
7770
              e->X_add_symbol = make_expr_symbol (e);
7771
              e->X_op = O_symbol;
7772
              e->X_add_number = 0;
7773
            }
7774
#endif
7775
          if (e->X_op != O_symbol)
7776
            {
7777
              if (e->X_op != O_pseudo_fixup)
7778
                {
7779
                  as_bad (_("Not a symbolic expression"));
7780
                  goto done;
7781
                }
7782
              if (idx != FUNC_LT_RELATIVE)
7783
                {
7784
                  as_bad (_("Illegal combination of relocation functions"));
7785
                  goto done;
7786
                }
7787
              switch (S_GET_VALUE (e->X_op_symbol))
7788
                {
7789
                case FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE:
7790
                  idx = FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE; break;
7791
                case FUNC_DTP_MODULE:
7792
                  idx = FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE; break;
7793
                case FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE:
7794
                  idx = FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE; break;
7795
                case FUNC_TP_RELATIVE:
7796
                  idx = FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE; break;
7797
                default:
7798
                  as_bad (_("Illegal combination of relocation functions"));
7799
                  goto done;
7800
                }
7801
            }
7802
          /* Make sure gas doesn't get rid of local symbols that are used
7803
             in relocs.  */
7804
          e->X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
7805
          e->X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[idx].u.sym;
7806
        done:
7807
          *nextcharP = *input_line_pointer;
7808
          break;
7809
 
7810
        case PSEUDO_FUNC_CONST:
7811
          e->X_op = O_constant;
7812
          e->X_add_number = pseudo_func[idx].u.ival;
7813
          break;
7814
 
7815
        case PSEUDO_FUNC_REG:
7816
          e->X_op = O_register;
7817
          e->X_add_number = pseudo_func[idx].u.ival;
7818
          break;
7819
 
7820
        default:
7821
          return 0;
7822
        }
7823
      return 1;
7824
    }
7825
 
7826
  /* first see if NAME is a known register name:  */
7827
  sym = hash_find (md.reg_hash, name);
7828
  if (sym)
7829
    {
7830
      e->X_op = O_register;
7831
      e->X_add_number = S_GET_VALUE (sym);
7832
      return 1;
7833
    }
7834
 
7835
  cdesc = hash_find (md.const_hash, name);
7836
  if (cdesc)
7837
    {
7838
      e->X_op = O_constant;
7839
      e->X_add_number = cdesc->value;
7840
      return 1;
7841
    }
7842
 
7843
  /* check for inN, locN, or outN:  */
7844
  idx = 0;
7845
  switch (name[0])
7846
    {
7847
    case 'i':
7848
      if (name[1] == 'n' && ISDIGIT (name[2]))
7849
        {
7850
          dr = &md.in;
7851
          idx = 2;
7852
        }
7853
      break;
7854
 
7855
    case 'l':
7856
      if (name[1] == 'o' && name[2] == 'c' && ISDIGIT (name[3]))
7857
        {
7858
          dr = &md.loc;
7859
          idx = 3;
7860
        }
7861
      break;
7862
 
7863
    case 'o':
7864
      if (name[1] == 'u' && name[2] == 't' && ISDIGIT (name[3]))
7865
        {
7866
          dr = &md.out;
7867
          idx = 3;
7868
        }
7869
      break;
7870
 
7871
    default:
7872
      break;
7873
    }
7874
 
7875
  /* Ignore register numbers with leading zeroes, except zero itself.  */
7876
  if (dr && (name[idx] != '0' || name[idx + 1] == '\0'))
7877
    {
7878
      unsigned long regnum;
7879
 
7880
      /* The name is inN, locN, or outN; parse the register number.  */
7881
      regnum = strtoul (name + idx, &end, 10);
7882
      if (end > name + idx && *end == '\0' && regnum < 96)
7883
        {
7884
          if (regnum >= dr->num_regs)
7885
            {
7886
              if (!dr->num_regs)
7887
                as_bad (_("No current frame"));
7888
              else
7889
                as_bad (_("Register number out of range 0..%u"),
7890
                        dr->num_regs - 1);
7891
              regnum = 0;
7892
            }
7893
          e->X_op = O_register;
7894
          e->X_add_number = dr->base + regnum;
7895
          return 1;
7896
        }
7897
    }
7898
 
7899
  end = alloca (strlen (name) + 1);
7900
  strcpy (end, name);
7901
  name = ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (end);
7902
  if ((dr = hash_find (md.dynreg_hash, name)))
7903
    {
7904
      /* We've got ourselves the name of a rotating register set.
7905
         Store the base register number in the low 16 bits of
7906
         X_add_number and the size of the register set in the top 16
7907
         bits.  */
7908
      e->X_op = O_register;
7909
      e->X_add_number = dr->base | (dr->num_regs << 16);
7910
      return 1;
7911
    }
7912
  return 0;
7913
}
7914
 
7915
/* Remove the '#' suffix that indicates a symbol as opposed to a register.  */
7916
 
7917
char *
7918
ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (char *name)
7919
{
7920
  size_t len = strlen (name), full = len;
7921
 
7922
  while (len > 0 && name[len - 1] == '#')
7923
    --len;
7924
  if (len <= 0)
7925
    {
7926
      if (full > 0)
7927
        as_bad (_("Standalone `#' is illegal"));
7928
    }
7929
  else if (len < full - 1)
7930
    as_warn (_("Redundant `#' suffix operators"));
7931
  name[len] = '\0';
7932
  return name;
7933
}
7934
 
7935
/* Return true if idesc is a conditional branch instruction.  This excludes
7936
   the modulo scheduled branches, and br.ia.  Mod-sched branches are excluded
7937
   because they always read/write resources regardless of the value of the
7938
   qualifying predicate.  br.ia must always use p0, and hence is always
7939
   taken.  Thus this function returns true for branches which can fall
7940
   through, and which use no resources if they do fall through.  */
7941
 
7942
static int
7943
is_conditional_branch (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
7944
{
7945
  /* br is a conditional branch.  Everything that starts with br. except
7946
     br.ia, br.c{loop,top,exit}, and br.w{top,exit} is a conditional branch.
7947
     Everything that starts with brl is a conditional branch.  */
7948
  return (idesc->name[0] == 'b' && idesc->name[1] == 'r'
7949
          && (idesc->name[2] == '\0'
7950
              || (idesc->name[2] == '.' && idesc->name[3] != 'i'
7951
                  && idesc->name[3] != 'c' && idesc->name[3] != 'w')
7952
              || idesc->name[2] == 'l'
7953
              /* br.cond, br.call, br.clr  */
7954
              || (idesc->name[2] == '.' && idesc->name[3] == 'c'
7955
                  && (idesc->name[4] == 'a' || idesc->name[4] == 'o'
7956
                      || (idesc->name[4] == 'l' && idesc->name[5] == 'r')))));
7957
}
7958
 
7959
/* Return whether the given opcode is a taken branch.  If there's any doubt,
7960
   returns zero.  */
7961
 
7962
static int
7963
is_taken_branch (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
7964
{
7965
  return ((is_conditional_branch (idesc) && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0)
7966
          || strncmp (idesc->name, "br.ia", 5) == 0);
7967
}
7968
 
7969
/* Return whether the given opcode is an interruption or rfi.  If there's any
7970
   doubt, returns zero.  */
7971
 
7972
static int
7973
is_interruption_or_rfi (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
7974
{
7975
  if (strcmp (idesc->name, "rfi") == 0)
7976
    return 1;
7977
  return 0;
7978
}
7979
 
7980
/* Returns the index of the given dependency in the opcode's list of chks, or
7981
   -1 if there is no dependency.  */
7982
 
7983
static int
7984
depends_on (int depind, struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
7985
{
7986
  int i;
7987
  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *dep = idesc->dependencies;
7988
  for (i = 0; i < dep->nchks; i++)
7989
    {
7990
      if (depind == DEP (dep->chks[i]))
7991
        return i;
7992
    }
7993
  return -1;
7994
}
7995
 
7996
/* Determine a set of specific resources used for a particular resource
7997
   class.  Returns the number of specific resources identified  For those
7998
   cases which are not determinable statically, the resource returned is
7999
   marked nonspecific.
8000
 
8001
   Meanings of value in 'NOTE':
8002
   1) only read/write when the register number is explicitly encoded in the
8003
   insn.
8004
   2) only read CFM when accessing a rotating GR, FR, or PR.  mov pr only
8005
   accesses CFM when qualifying predicate is in the rotating region.
8006
   3) general register value is used to specify an indirect register; not
8007
   determinable statically.
8008
   4) only read the given resource when bits 7:0 of the indirect index
8009
   register value does not match the register number of the resource; not
8010
   determinable statically.
8011
   5) all rules are implementation specific.
8012
   6) only when both the index specified by the reader and the index specified
8013
   by the writer have the same value in bits 63:61; not determinable
8014
   statically.
8015
   7) only access the specified resource when the corresponding mask bit is
8016
   set
8017
   8) PSR.dfh is only read when these insns reference FR32-127.  PSR.dfl is
8018
   only read when these insns reference FR2-31
8019
   9) PSR.mfl is only written when these insns write FR2-31.  PSR.mfh is only
8020
   written when these insns write FR32-127
8021
   10) The PSR.bn bit is only accessed when one of GR16-31 is specified in the
8022
   instruction
8023
   11) The target predicates are written independently of PR[qp], but source
8024
   registers are only read if PR[qp] is true.  Since the state of PR[qp]
8025
   cannot statically be determined, all source registers are marked used.
8026
   12) This insn only reads the specified predicate register when that
8027
   register is the PR[qp].
8028
   13) This reference to ld-c only applies to the GR whose value is loaded
8029
   with data returned from memory, not the post-incremented address register.
8030
   14) The RSE resource includes the implementation-specific RSE internal
8031
   state resources.  At least one (and possibly more) of these resources are
8032
   read by each instruction listed in IC:rse-readers.  At least one (and
8033
   possibly more) of these resources are written by each insn listed in
8034
   IC:rse-writers.
8035
   15+16) Represents reserved instructions, which the assembler does not
8036
   generate.
8037
   17) CR[TPR] has a RAW dependency only between mov-to-CR-TPR and
8038
   mov-to-PSR-l or ssm instructions that set PSR.i, PSR.pp or PSR.up.
8039
 
8040
   Memory resources (i.e. locations in memory) are *not* marked or tracked by
8041
   this code; there are no dependency violations based on memory access.
8042
*/
8043
 
8044
#define MAX_SPECS 256
8045
#define DV_CHK 1
8046
#define DV_REG 0
8047
 
8048
static int
8049
specify_resource (const struct ia64_dependency *dep,
8050
                  struct ia64_opcode *idesc,
8051
                  /* is this a DV chk or a DV reg? */
8052
                  int type,
8053
                  /* returned specific resources */
8054
                  struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS],
8055
                  /* resource note for this insn's usage */
8056
                  int note,
8057
                  /* which execution path to examine */
8058
                  int path)
8059
{
8060
  int count = 0;
8061
  int i;
8062
  int rsrc_write = 0;
8063
  struct rsrc tmpl;
8064
 
8065
  if (dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAW
8066
      || (dep->mode == IA64_DV_RAW && type == DV_REG)
8067
      || (dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAR && type == DV_CHK))
8068
    rsrc_write = 1;
8069
 
8070
  /* template for any resources we identify */
8071
  tmpl.dependency = dep;
8072
  tmpl.note = note;
8073
  tmpl.insn_srlz = tmpl.data_srlz = 0;
8074
  tmpl.qp_regno = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8075
  tmpl.link_to_qp_branch = 1;
8076
  tmpl.mem_offset.hint = 0;
8077
  tmpl.mem_offset.offset = 0;
8078
  tmpl.mem_offset.base = 0;
8079
  tmpl.specific = 1;
8080
  tmpl.index = -1;
8081
  tmpl.cmp_type = CMP_NONE;
8082
  tmpl.depind = 0;
8083
  tmpl.file = NULL;
8084
  tmpl.line = 0;
8085
  tmpl.path = 0;
8086
 
8087
#define UNHANDLED \
8088
as_warn (_("Unhandled dependency %s for %s (%s), note %d"), \
8089
dep->name, idesc->name, (rsrc_write?"write":"read"), note)
8090
#define KNOWN(REG) (gr_values[REG].known && gr_values[REG].path >= path)
8091
 
8092
  /* we don't need to track these */
8093
  if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_NONE)
8094
    return 0;
8095
 
8096
  switch (dep->specifier)
8097
    {
8098
    case IA64_RS_AR_K:
8099
      if (note == 1)
8100
        {
8101
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8102
            {
8103
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8104
              if (regno >= 0 && regno <= 7)
8105
                {
8106
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8107
                  specs[count++].index = regno;
8108
                }
8109
            }
8110
        }
8111
      else if (note == 0)
8112
        {
8113
          for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8114
            {
8115
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8116
              specs[count++].index = i;
8117
            }
8118
        }
8119
      else
8120
        {
8121
          UNHANDLED;
8122
        }
8123
      break;
8124
 
8125
    case IA64_RS_AR_UNAT:
8126
      /* This is a mov =AR or mov AR= instruction.  */
8127
      if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8128
        {
8129
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8130
          if (regno == AR_UNAT)
8131
            {
8132
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
8133
            }
8134
        }
8135
      else
8136
        {
8137
          /* This is a spill/fill, or other instruction that modifies the
8138
             unat register.  */
8139
 
8140
          /* Unless we can determine the specific bits used, mark the whole
8141
             thing; bits 8:3 of the memory address indicate the bit used in
8142
             UNAT.  The .mem.offset hint may be used to eliminate a small
8143
             subset of conflicts.  */
8144
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8145
          if (md.mem_offset.hint)
8146
            {
8147
              if (md.debug_dv)
8148
                fprintf (stderr, "  Using hint for spill/fill\n");
8149
              /* The index isn't actually used, just set it to something
8150
                 approximating the bit index.  */
8151
              specs[count].index = (md.mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F;
8152
              specs[count].mem_offset.hint = 1;
8153
              specs[count].mem_offset.offset = md.mem_offset.offset;
8154
              specs[count++].mem_offset.base = md.mem_offset.base;
8155
            }
8156
          else
8157
            {
8158
              specs[count++].specific = 0;
8159
            }
8160
        }
8161
      break;
8162
 
8163
    case IA64_RS_AR:
8164
      if (note == 1)
8165
        {
8166
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8167
            {
8168
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8169
              if ((regno >= 8 && regno <= 15)
8170
                  || (regno >= 20 && regno <= 23)
8171
                  || (regno >= 31 && regno <= 39)
8172
                  || (regno >= 41 && regno <= 47)
8173
                  || (regno >= 67 && regno <= 111))
8174
                {
8175
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8176
                  specs[count++].index = regno;
8177
                }
8178
            }
8179
        }
8180
      else
8181
        {
8182
          UNHANDLED;
8183
        }
8184
      break;
8185
 
8186
    case IA64_RS_ARb:
8187
      if (note == 1)
8188
        {
8189
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8190
            {
8191
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8192
              if ((regno >= 48 && regno <= 63)
8193
                  || (regno >= 112 && regno <= 127))
8194
                {
8195
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8196
                  specs[count++].index = regno;
8197
                }
8198
            }
8199
        }
8200
      else if (note == 0)
8201
        {
8202
          for (i = 48; i < 64; i++)
8203
            {
8204
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8205
              specs[count++].index = i;
8206
            }
8207
          for (i = 112; i < 128; i++)
8208
            {
8209
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8210
              specs[count++].index = i;
8211
            }
8212
        }
8213
      else
8214
        {
8215
          UNHANDLED;
8216
        }
8217
      break;
8218
 
8219
    case IA64_RS_BR:
8220
      if (note != 1)
8221
        {
8222
          UNHANDLED;
8223
        }
8224
      else
8225
        {
8226
          if (rsrc_write)
8227
            {
8228
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8229
                if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B1
8230
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B2)
8231
                  {
8232
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8233
                    specs[count++].index =
8234
                      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_BR;
8235
                  }
8236
            }
8237
          else
8238
            {
8239
              for (i = idesc->num_outputs; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8240
                if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B1
8241
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_B2)
8242
                  {
8243
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8244
                    specs[count++].index =
8245
                      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_BR;
8246
                  }
8247
            }
8248
        }
8249
      break;
8250
 
8251
    case IA64_RS_CPUID: /* four or more registers */
8252
      if (note == 3)
8253
        {
8254
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3)
8255
            {
8256
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8257
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8258
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8259
                {
8260
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8261
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8262
                }
8263
              else
8264
                {
8265
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8266
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8267
                }
8268
            }
8269
        }
8270
      else
8271
        {
8272
          UNHANDLED;
8273
        }
8274
      break;
8275
 
8276
    case IA64_RS_DBR: /* four or more registers */
8277
      if (note == 3)
8278
        {
8279
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_DBR_R3)
8280
            {
8281
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8282
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8283
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8284
                {
8285
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8286
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8287
                }
8288
              else
8289
                {
8290
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8291
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8292
                }
8293
            }
8294
        }
8295
      else if (note == 0 && !rsrc_write)
8296
        {
8297
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8298
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8299
        }
8300
      else
8301
        {
8302
          UNHANDLED;
8303
        }
8304
      break;
8305
 
8306
    case IA64_RS_IBR: /* four or more registers */
8307
      if (note == 3)
8308
        {
8309
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_IBR_R3)
8310
            {
8311
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8312
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8313
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8314
                {
8315
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8316
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8317
                }
8318
              else
8319
                {
8320
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8321
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8322
                }
8323
            }
8324
        }
8325
      else
8326
        {
8327
          UNHANDLED;
8328
        }
8329
      break;
8330
 
8331
    case IA64_RS_MSR:
8332
      if (note == 5)
8333
        {
8334
          /* These are implementation specific.  Force all references to
8335
             conflict with all other references.  */
8336
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8337
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8338
        }
8339
      else
8340
        {
8341
          UNHANDLED;
8342
        }
8343
      break;
8344
 
8345
    case IA64_RS_PKR: /* 16 or more registers */
8346
      if (note == 3 || note == 4)
8347
        {
8348
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PKR_R3)
8349
            {
8350
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8351
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8352
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8353
                {
8354
                  if (note == 3)
8355
                    {
8356
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8357
                      specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8358
                    }
8359
                  else
8360
                    for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (gr_values); i++)
8361
                      {
8362
                        /* Uses all registers *except* the one in R3.  */
8363
                        if ((unsigned)i != (gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF))
8364
                          {
8365
                            specs[count] = tmpl;
8366
                            specs[count++].index = i;
8367
                          }
8368
                      }
8369
                }
8370
              else
8371
                {
8372
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8373
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8374
                }
8375
            }
8376
        }
8377
      else if (note == 0)
8378
        {
8379
          /* probe et al.  */
8380
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8381
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8382
        }
8383
      break;
8384
 
8385
    case IA64_RS_PMC: /* four or more registers */
8386
      if (note == 3)
8387
        {
8388
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PMC_R3
8389
              || (!rsrc_write && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3))
8390
 
8391
            {
8392
              int reg_index = ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_R3 && !rsrc_write)
8393
                               ? 1 : !rsrc_write);
8394
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[reg_index].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8395
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8396
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8397
                {
8398
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8399
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8400
                }
8401
              else
8402
                {
8403
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8404
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8405
                }
8406
            }
8407
        }
8408
      else
8409
        {
8410
          UNHANDLED;
8411
        }
8412
      break;
8413
 
8414
    case IA64_RS_PMD: /* four or more registers */
8415
      if (note == 3)
8416
        {
8417
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3)
8418
            {
8419
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8420
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8421
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8422
                {
8423
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8424
                  specs[count++].index = gr_values[regno].value & 0xFF;
8425
                }
8426
              else
8427
                {
8428
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8429
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8430
                }
8431
            }
8432
        }
8433
      else
8434
        {
8435
          UNHANDLED;
8436
        }
8437
      break;
8438
 
8439
    case IA64_RS_RR: /* eight registers */
8440
      if (note == 6)
8441
        {
8442
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_RR_R3)
8443
            {
8444
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8445
              if (regno >= 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values)
8446
                  && KNOWN (regno))
8447
                {
8448
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8449
                  specs[count++].index = (gr_values[regno].value >> 61) & 0x7;
8450
                }
8451
              else
8452
                {
8453
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8454
                  specs[count++].specific = 0;
8455
                }
8456
            }
8457
        }
8458
      else if (note == 0 && !rsrc_write)
8459
        {
8460
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8461
          specs[count++].specific = 0;
8462
        }
8463
      else
8464
        {
8465
          UNHANDLED;
8466
        }
8467
      break;
8468
 
8469
    case IA64_RS_CR_IRR:
8470
      if (note == 0)
8471
        {
8472
          /* handle mov-from-CR-IVR; it's a read that writes CR[IRR] */
8473
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8474
          if (rsrc_write
8475
              && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8476
              && regno == CR_IVR)
8477
            {
8478
              for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
8479
                {
8480
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8481
                  specs[count++].index = CR_IRR0 + i;
8482
                }
8483
            }
8484
        }
8485
      else if (note == 1)
8486
        {
8487
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8488
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8489
              && regno >= CR_IRR0
8490
              && regno <= CR_IRR3)
8491
            {
8492
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8493
              specs[count++].index = regno;
8494
            }
8495
        }
8496
      else
8497
        {
8498
          UNHANDLED;
8499
        }
8500
      break;
8501
 
8502
    case IA64_RS_CR_IIB:
8503
      if (note != 0)
8504
        {
8505
          UNHANDLED;
8506
        }
8507
      else
8508
        {
8509
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8510
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8511
              && (regno == CR_IIB0 || regno == CR_IIB1))
8512
            {
8513
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8514
              specs[count++].index = regno;
8515
            }
8516
        }
8517
      break;
8518
 
8519
    case IA64_RS_CR_LRR:
8520
      if (note != 1)
8521
        {
8522
          UNHANDLED;
8523
        }
8524
      else
8525
        {
8526
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8527
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8528
              && (regno == CR_LRR0 || regno == CR_LRR1))
8529
            {
8530
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8531
              specs[count++].index = regno;
8532
            }
8533
        }
8534
      break;
8535
 
8536
    case IA64_RS_CR:
8537
      if (note == 1)
8538
        {
8539
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
8540
            {
8541
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8542
              specs[count++].index =
8543
                CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8544
            }
8545
        }
8546
      else
8547
        {
8548
          UNHANDLED;
8549
        }
8550
      break;
8551
 
8552
    case IA64_RS_FR:
8553
    case IA64_RS_FRb:
8554
      if (note != 1)
8555
        {
8556
          UNHANDLED;
8557
        }
8558
      else if (rsrc_write)
8559
        {
8560
          if (dep->specifier == IA64_RS_FRb
8561
              && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_F1)
8562
            {
8563
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8564
              specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_FR;
8565
            }
8566
        }
8567
      else
8568
        {
8569
          for (i = idesc->num_outputs; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8570
            {
8571
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
8572
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
8573
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
8574
                {
8575
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8576
                  specs[count++].index =
8577
                    CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
8578
                }
8579
            }
8580
        }
8581
      break;
8582
 
8583
    case IA64_RS_GR:
8584
      if (note == 13)
8585
        {
8586
          /* This reference applies only to the GR whose value is loaded with
8587
             data returned from memory.  */
8588
          specs[count] = tmpl;
8589
          specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8590
        }
8591
      else if (note == 1)
8592
        {
8593
          if (rsrc_write)
8594
            {
8595
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8596
                if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
8597
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
8598
                    || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
8599
                  {
8600
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8601
                    specs[count++].index =
8602
                      CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8603
                  }
8604
              if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_POSTINC)
8605
                for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8606
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MR3)
8607
                    {
8608
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8609
                      specs[count++].index =
8610
                        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8611
                    }
8612
            }
8613
          else
8614
            {
8615
              /* Look for anything that reads a GR.  */
8616
              for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
8617
                {
8618
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MR3
8619
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_CPUID_R3
8620
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_DBR_R3
8621
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_IBR_R3
8622
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_MSR_R3
8623
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PKR_R3
8624
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PMC_R3
8625
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PMD_R3
8626
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_RR_R3
8627
                      || ((i >= idesc->num_outputs)
8628
                          && (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
8629
                              || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
8630
                              || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3
8631
                              /* addl source register.  */
8632
                              || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3_2)))
8633
                    {
8634
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8635
                      specs[count++].index =
8636
                        CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
8637
                    }
8638
                }
8639
            }
8640
        }
8641
      else
8642
        {
8643
          UNHANDLED;
8644
        }
8645
      break;
8646
 
8647
      /* This is the same as IA64_RS_PRr, except that the register range is
8648
         from 1 - 15, and there are no rotating register reads/writes here.  */
8649
    case IA64_RS_PR:
8650
      if (note == 0)
8651
        {
8652
          for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8653
            {
8654
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8655
              specs[count++].index = i;
8656
            }
8657
        }
8658
      else if (note == 7)
8659
        {
8660
          valueT mask = 0;
8661
          /* Mark only those registers indicated by the mask.  */
8662
          if (rsrc_write)
8663
            {
8664
              mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
8665
              for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8666
                if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << i))
8667
                  {
8668
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8669
                    specs[count++].index = i;
8670
                  }
8671
            }
8672
          else
8673
            {
8674
              UNHANDLED;
8675
            }
8676
        }
8677
      else if (note == 11) /* note 11 implies note 1 as well */
8678
        {
8679
          if (rsrc_write)
8680
            {
8681
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8682
                {
8683
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
8684
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8685
                    {
8686
                      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
8687
                      if (regno >= 1 && regno < 16)
8688
                        {
8689
                          specs[count] = tmpl;
8690
                          specs[count++].index = regno;
8691
                        }
8692
                    }
8693
                }
8694
            }
8695
          else
8696
            {
8697
              UNHANDLED;
8698
            }
8699
        }
8700
      else if (note == 12)
8701
        {
8702
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 16)
8703
            {
8704
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8705
              specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8706
            }
8707
        }
8708
      else if (note == 1)
8709
        {
8710
          if (rsrc_write)
8711
            {
8712
              int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
8713
              int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
8714
              int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
8715
              int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
8716
 
8717
              if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
8718
                   || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8719
                  && p1 >= 1 && p1 < 16)
8720
                {
8721
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8722
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
8723
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
8724
                  specs[count++].index = p1;
8725
                }
8726
              if ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
8727
                   || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8728
                  && p2 >= 1 && p2 < 16)
8729
                {
8730
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8731
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
8732
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
8733
                  specs[count++].index = p2;
8734
                }
8735
            }
8736
          else
8737
            {
8738
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 16)
8739
                {
8740
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8741
                  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8742
                }
8743
              if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PR)
8744
                {
8745
                  for (i = 1; i < 16; i++)
8746
                    {
8747
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8748
                      specs[count++].index = i;
8749
                    }
8750
                }
8751
            }
8752
        }
8753
      else
8754
        {
8755
          UNHANDLED;
8756
        }
8757
      break;
8758
 
8759
      /* This is the general case for PRs.  IA64_RS_PR and IA64_RS_PR63 are
8760
         simplified cases of this.  */
8761
    case IA64_RS_PRr:
8762
      if (note == 0)
8763
        {
8764
          for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8765
            {
8766
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8767
              specs[count++].index = i;
8768
            }
8769
        }
8770
      else if (note == 7)
8771
        {
8772
          valueT mask = 0;
8773
          /* Mark only those registers indicated by the mask.  */
8774
          if (rsrc_write
8775
              && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_PR)
8776
            {
8777
              mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
8778
              if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << 16))
8779
                for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8780
                  {
8781
                    specs[count] = tmpl;
8782
                    specs[count++].index = i;
8783
                  }
8784
            }
8785
          else if (rsrc_write
8786
                   && idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_PR_ROT)
8787
            {
8788
              for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8789
                {
8790
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8791
                  specs[count++].index = i;
8792
                }
8793
            }
8794
          else
8795
            {
8796
              UNHANDLED;
8797
            }
8798
        }
8799
      else if (note == 11) /* note 11 implies note 1 as well */
8800
        {
8801
          if (rsrc_write)
8802
            {
8803
              for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
8804
                {
8805
                  if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
8806
                      || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8807
                    {
8808
                      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
8809
                      if (regno >= 16 && regno < 63)
8810
                        {
8811
                          specs[count] = tmpl;
8812
                          specs[count++].index = regno;
8813
                        }
8814
                    }
8815
                }
8816
            }
8817
          else
8818
            {
8819
              UNHANDLED;
8820
            }
8821
        }
8822
      else if (note == 12)
8823
        {
8824
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 16 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 63)
8825
            {
8826
              specs[count] = tmpl;
8827
              specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8828
            }
8829
        }
8830
      else if (note == 1)
8831
        {
8832
          if (rsrc_write)
8833
            {
8834
              int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
8835
              int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
8836
              int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
8837
              int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
8838
 
8839
              if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
8840
                   || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8841
                  && p1 >= 16 && p1 < 63)
8842
                {
8843
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8844
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
8845
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
8846
                  specs[count++].index = p1;
8847
                }
8848
              if ((idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
8849
                   || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2)
8850
                  && p2 >= 16 && p2 < 63)
8851
                {
8852
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8853
                  specs[count].cmp_type =
8854
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
8855
                  specs[count++].index = p2;
8856
                }
8857
            }
8858
          else
8859
            {
8860
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno >= 16 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno < 63)
8861
                {
8862
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
8863
                  specs[count++].index = CURR_SLOT.qp_regno;
8864
                }
8865
              if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_PR)
8866
                {
8867
                  for (i = 16; i < 63; i++)
8868
                    {
8869
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
8870
                      specs[count++].index = i;
8871
                    }
8872
                }
8873
            }
8874
        }
8875
      else
8876
        {
8877
          UNHANDLED;
8878
        }
8879
      break;
8880
 
8881
    case IA64_RS_PSR:
8882
      /* Verify that the instruction is using the PSR bit indicated in
8883
         dep->regindex.  */
8884
      if (note == 0)
8885
        {
8886
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR_UM)
8887
            {
8888
              if (dep->regindex < 6)
8889
                {
8890
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
8891
                }
8892
            }
8893
          else if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR)
8894
            {
8895
              if (dep->regindex < 32
8896
                  || dep->regindex == 35
8897
                  || dep->regindex == 36
8898
                  || (!rsrc_write && dep->regindex == PSR_CPL))
8899
                {
8900
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
8901
                }
8902
            }
8903
          else if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_PSR_L)
8904
            {
8905
              if (dep->regindex < 32
8906
                  || dep->regindex == 35
8907
                  || dep->regindex == 36
8908
                  || (rsrc_write && dep->regindex == PSR_CPL))
8909
                {
8910
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
8911
                }
8912
            }
8913
          else
8914
            {
8915
              /* Several PSR bits have very specific dependencies.  */
8916
              switch (dep->regindex)
8917
                {
8918
                default:
8919
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
8920
                  break;
8921
                case PSR_IC:
8922
                  if (rsrc_write)
8923
                    {
8924
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
8925
                    }
8926
                  else
8927
                    {
8928
                      /* Only certain CR accesses use PSR.ic */
8929
                      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3
8930
                          || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
8931
                        {
8932
                          int reg_index =
8933
                            ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
8934
                             ? 0 : 1);
8935
                          int regno =
8936
                            CURR_SLOT.opnd[reg_index].X_add_number - REG_CR;
8937
 
8938
                          switch (regno)
8939
                            {
8940
                            default:
8941
                              break;
8942
                            case CR_ITIR:
8943
                            case CR_IFS:
8944
                            case CR_IIM:
8945
                            case CR_IIP:
8946
                            case CR_IPSR:
8947
                            case CR_ISR:
8948
                            case CR_IFA:
8949
                            case CR_IHA:
8950
                            case CR_IIB0:
8951
                            case CR_IIB1:
8952
                            case CR_IIPA:
8953
                              specs[count++] = tmpl;
8954
                              break;
8955
                            }
8956
                        }
8957
                    }
8958
                  break;
8959
                case PSR_CPL:
8960
                  if (rsrc_write)
8961
                    {
8962
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
8963
                    }
8964
                  else
8965
                    {
8966
                      /* Only some AR accesses use cpl */
8967
                      if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3
8968
                          || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8969
                        {
8970
                          int reg_index =
8971
                            ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
8972
                             ? 0 : 1);
8973
                          int regno =
8974
                            CURR_SLOT.opnd[reg_index].X_add_number - REG_AR;
8975
 
8976
                          if (regno == AR_ITC
8977
                              || regno == AR_RUC
8978
                              || (reg_index == 0
8979
                                  && (regno == AR_RSC
8980
                                      || (regno >= AR_K0
8981
                                          && regno <= AR_K7))))
8982
                            {
8983
                              specs[count++] = tmpl;
8984
                            }
8985
                        }
8986
                      else
8987
                        {
8988
                          specs[count++] = tmpl;
8989
                        }
8990
                      break;
8991
                    }
8992
                }
8993
            }
8994
        }
8995
      else if (note == 7)
8996
        {
8997
          valueT mask = 0;
8998
          if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_IMMU24)
8999
            {
9000
              mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number;
9001
            }
9002
          else
9003
            {
9004
              UNHANDLED;
9005
            }
9006
          if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << dep->regindex))
9007
            {
9008
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9009
            }
9010
        }
9011
      else if (note == 8)
9012
        {
9013
          int min = dep->regindex == PSR_DFL ? 2 : 32;
9014
          int max = dep->regindex == PSR_DFL ? 31 : 127;
9015
          /* dfh is read on FR32-127; dfl is read on FR2-31 */
9016
          for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9017
            {
9018
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1
9019
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
9020
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
9021
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
9022
                {
9023
                  int reg = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9024
                  if (reg >= min && reg <= max)
9025
                    {
9026
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9027
                    }
9028
                }
9029
            }
9030
        }
9031
      else if (note == 9)
9032
        {
9033
          int min = dep->regindex == PSR_MFL ? 2 : 32;
9034
          int max = dep->regindex == PSR_MFL ? 31 : 127;
9035
          /* mfh is read on writes to FR32-127; mfl is read on writes to
9036
             FR2-31 */
9037
          for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9038
            {
9039
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1)
9040
                {
9041
                  int reg = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9042
                  if (reg >= min && reg <= max)
9043
                    {
9044
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9045
                    }
9046
                }
9047
            }
9048
        }
9049
      else if (note == 10)
9050
        {
9051
          for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9052
            {
9053
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9054
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9055
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9056
                {
9057
                  int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9058
                  if (regno >= 16 && regno <= 31)
9059
                    {
9060
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9061
                    }
9062
                }
9063
            }
9064
        }
9065
      else
9066
        {
9067
          UNHANDLED;
9068
        }
9069
      break;
9070
 
9071
    case IA64_RS_AR_FPSR:
9072
      if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9073
        {
9074
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9075
          if (regno == AR_FPSR)
9076
            {
9077
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9078
            }
9079
        }
9080
      else
9081
        {
9082
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9083
        }
9084
      break;
9085
 
9086
    case IA64_RS_ARX:
9087
      /* Handle all AR[REG] resources */
9088
      if (note == 0 || note == 1)
9089
        {
9090
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9091
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9092
              && regno == dep->regindex)
9093
            {
9094
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9095
            }
9096
          /* other AR[REG] resources may be affected by AR accesses */
9097
          else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9098
            {
9099
              /* AR[] writes */
9100
              regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9101
              switch (dep->regindex)
9102
                {
9103
                default:
9104
                  break;
9105
                case AR_BSP:
9106
                case AR_RNAT:
9107
                  if (regno == AR_BSPSTORE)
9108
                    {
9109
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9110
                    }
9111
                case AR_RSC:
9112
                  if (!rsrc_write &&
9113
                      (regno == AR_BSPSTORE
9114
                       || regno == AR_RNAT))
9115
                    {
9116
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9117
                    }
9118
                  break;
9119
                }
9120
            }
9121
          else if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9122
            {
9123
              /* AR[] reads */
9124
              regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR;
9125
              switch (dep->regindex)
9126
                {
9127
                default:
9128
                  break;
9129
                case AR_RSC:
9130
                  if (regno == AR_BSPSTORE || regno == AR_RNAT)
9131
                    {
9132
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9133
                    }
9134
                  break;
9135
                }
9136
            }
9137
          else
9138
            {
9139
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9140
            }
9141
        }
9142
      else
9143
        {
9144
          UNHANDLED;
9145
        }
9146
      break;
9147
 
9148
    case IA64_RS_CRX:
9149
      /* Handle all CR[REG] resources.
9150
         ??? FIXME: The rule 17 isn't really handled correctly.   */
9151
      if (note == 0 || note == 1 || note == 17)
9152
        {
9153
          if (idesc->operands[!rsrc_write] == IA64_OPND_CR3)
9154
            {
9155
              int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[!rsrc_write].X_add_number - REG_CR;
9156
              if (regno == dep->regindex)
9157
                {
9158
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9159
                }
9160
              else if (!rsrc_write)
9161
                {
9162
                  /* Reads from CR[IVR] affect other resources.  */
9163
                  if (regno == CR_IVR)
9164
                    {
9165
                      if ((dep->regindex >= CR_IRR0
9166
                           && dep->regindex <= CR_IRR3)
9167
                          || dep->regindex == CR_TPR)
9168
                        {
9169
                          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9170
                        }
9171
                    }
9172
                }
9173
            }
9174
          else
9175
            {
9176
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9177
            }
9178
        }
9179
      else
9180
        {
9181
          UNHANDLED;
9182
        }
9183
      break;
9184
 
9185
    case IA64_RS_INSERVICE:
9186
      /* look for write of EOI (67) or read of IVR (65) */
9187
      if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9188
           && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_CR == CR_EOI)
9189
          || (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_CR3
9190
              && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_CR == CR_IVR))
9191
        {
9192
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9193
        }
9194
      break;
9195
 
9196
    case IA64_RS_GR0:
9197
      if (note == 1)
9198
        {
9199
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9200
        }
9201
      else
9202
        {
9203
          UNHANDLED;
9204
        }
9205
      break;
9206
 
9207
    case IA64_RS_CFM:
9208
      if (note != 2)
9209
        {
9210
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9211
        }
9212
      else
9213
        {
9214
          /* Check if any of the registers accessed are in the rotating region.
9215
             mov to/from pr accesses CFM only when qp_regno is in the rotating
9216
             region */
9217
          for (i = 0; i < NELEMS (idesc->operands); i++)
9218
            {
9219
              if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9220
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9221
                  || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9222
                {
9223
                  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9224
                  /* Assumes that md.rot.num_regs is always valid */
9225
                  if (md.rot.num_regs > 0
9226
                      && num > 31
9227
                      && num < 31 + md.rot.num_regs)
9228
                    {
9229
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9230
                      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9231
                    }
9232
                }
9233
              else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F1
9234
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F2
9235
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F3
9236
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_F4)
9237
                {
9238
                  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_FR;
9239
                  if (num > 31)
9240
                    {
9241
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9242
                      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9243
                    }
9244
                }
9245
              else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9246
                       || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9247
                {
9248
                  int num = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9249
                  if (num > 15)
9250
                    {
9251
                      specs[count] = tmpl;
9252
                      specs[count++].specific = 0;
9253
                    }
9254
                }
9255
            }
9256
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno > 15)
9257
            {
9258
              specs[count] = tmpl;
9259
              specs[count++].specific = 0;
9260
            }
9261
        }
9262
      break;
9263
 
9264
      /* This is the same as IA64_RS_PRr, except simplified to account for
9265
         the fact that there is only one register.  */
9266
    case IA64_RS_PR63:
9267
      if (note == 0)
9268
        {
9269
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9270
        }
9271
      else if (note == 7)
9272
        {
9273
          valueT mask = 0;
9274
          if (idesc->operands[2] == IA64_OPND_IMM17)
9275
            mask = CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
9276
          if (mask & ((valueT) 1 << 63))
9277
            specs[count++] = tmpl;
9278
        }
9279
      else if (note == 11)
9280
        {
9281
          if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9282
               && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P == 63)
9283
              || (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2
9284
                  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P == 63))
9285
            {
9286
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9287
            }
9288
        }
9289
      else if (note == 12)
9290
        {
9291
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 63)
9292
            {
9293
              specs[count++] = tmpl;
9294
            }
9295
        }
9296
      else if (note == 1)
9297
        {
9298
          if (rsrc_write)
9299
            {
9300
              int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9301
              int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9302
              int or_andcm = strstr (idesc->name, "or.andcm") != NULL;
9303
              int and_orcm = strstr (idesc->name, "and.orcm") != NULL;
9304
 
9305
              if (p1 == 63
9306
                  && (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9307
                      || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9308
                {
9309
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9310
                  specs[count++].cmp_type =
9311
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_OR : (and_orcm ? CMP_AND : CMP_NONE));
9312
                }
9313
              if (p2 == 63
9314
                  && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9315
                      || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9316
                {
9317
                  specs[count] = tmpl;
9318
                  specs[count++].cmp_type =
9319
                    (or_andcm ? CMP_AND : (and_orcm ? CMP_OR : CMP_NONE));
9320
                }
9321
            }
9322
          else
9323
            {
9324
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 63)
9325
                {
9326
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9327
                }
9328
            }
9329
        }
9330
      else
9331
        {
9332
          UNHANDLED;
9333
        }
9334
      break;
9335
 
9336
    case IA64_RS_RSE:
9337
      /* FIXME we can identify some individual RSE written resources, but RSE
9338
         read resources have not yet been completely identified, so for now
9339
         treat RSE as a single resource */
9340
      if (strncmp (idesc->name, "mov", 3) == 0)
9341
        {
9342
          if (rsrc_write)
9343
            {
9344
              if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3
9345
                  && CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE)
9346
                {
9347
                  specs[count++] = tmpl;
9348
                }
9349
            }
9350
          else
9351
            {
9352
              if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9353
                {
9354
                  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE
9355
                      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_RNAT)
9356
                    {
9357
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9358
                    }
9359
                }
9360
              else if (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_AR3)
9361
                {
9362
                  if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSP
9363
                      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_BSPSTORE
9364
                      || CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_AR == AR_RNAT)
9365
                    {
9366
                      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9367
                    }
9368
                }
9369
            }
9370
        }
9371
      else
9372
        {
9373
          specs[count++] = tmpl;
9374
        }
9375
      break;
9376
 
9377
    case IA64_RS_ANY:
9378
      /* FIXME -- do any of these need to be non-specific? */
9379
      specs[count++] = tmpl;
9380
      break;
9381
 
9382
    default:
9383
      as_bad (_("Unrecognized dependency specifier %d\n"), dep->specifier);
9384
      break;
9385
    }
9386
 
9387
  return count;
9388
}
9389
 
9390
/* Clear branch flags on marked resources.  This breaks the link between the
9391
   QP of the marking instruction and a subsequent branch on the same QP.  */
9392
 
9393
static void
9394
clear_qp_branch_flag (valueT mask)
9395
{
9396
  int i;
9397
  for (i = 0; i < regdepslen; i++)
9398
    {
9399
      valueT bit = ((valueT) 1 << regdeps[i].qp_regno);
9400
      if ((bit & mask) != 0)
9401
        {
9402
          regdeps[i].link_to_qp_branch = 0;
9403
        }
9404
    }
9405
}
9406
 
9407
/* MASK contains 2 and only 2 PRs which are mutually exclusive.  Remove
9408
   any mutexes which contain one of the PRs and create new ones when
9409
   needed.  */
9410
 
9411
static int
9412
update_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9413
{
9414
  int i;
9415
  int add = 0;
9416
 
9417
  i = 0;
9418
  while (i < qp_mutexeslen)
9419
    {
9420
      if ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) != 0)
9421
        {
9422
          /* If it destroys and creates the same mutex, do nothing.  */
9423
          if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask == mask
9424
              && qp_mutexes[i].path == md.path)
9425
            {
9426
              i++;
9427
              add = -1;
9428
            }
9429
          else
9430
            {
9431
              int keep = 0;
9432
 
9433
              if (md.debug_dv)
9434
                {
9435
                  fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing mutex relation");
9436
                  print_prmask (qp_mutexes[i].prmask);
9437
                  fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9438
                }
9439
 
9440
              /* Deal with the old mutex with more than 3+ PRs only if
9441
                 the new mutex on the same execution path with it.
9442
 
9443
                 FIXME: The 3+ mutex support is incomplete.
9444
                 dot_pred_rel () may be a better place to fix it.  */
9445
              if (qp_mutexes[i].path == md.path)
9446
                {
9447
                  /* If it is a proper subset of the mutex, create a
9448
                     new mutex.  */
9449
                  if (add == 0
9450
                      && (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) == mask)
9451
                    add = 1;
9452
 
9453
                  qp_mutexes[i].prmask &= ~mask;
9454
                  if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & (qp_mutexes[i].prmask - 1))
9455
                    {
9456
                      /* Modify the mutex if there are more than one
9457
                         PR left.  */
9458
                      keep = 1;
9459
                      i++;
9460
                    }
9461
                }
9462
 
9463
              if (keep == 0)
9464
                /* Remove the mutex.  */
9465
                qp_mutexes[i] = qp_mutexes[--qp_mutexeslen];
9466
            }
9467
        }
9468
      else
9469
        ++i;
9470
    }
9471
 
9472
  if (add == 1)
9473
    add_qp_mutex (mask);
9474
 
9475
  return add;
9476
}
9477
 
9478
/* Remove any mutexes which contain any of the PRs indicated in the mask.
9479
 
9480
   Any changes to a PR clears the mutex relations which include that PR.  */
9481
 
9482
static void
9483
clear_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9484
{
9485
  int i;
9486
 
9487
  i = 0;
9488
  while (i < qp_mutexeslen)
9489
    {
9490
      if ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) != 0)
9491
        {
9492
          if (md.debug_dv)
9493
            {
9494
              fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing mutex relation");
9495
              print_prmask (qp_mutexes[i].prmask);
9496
              fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9497
            }
9498
          qp_mutexes[i] = qp_mutexes[--qp_mutexeslen];
9499
        }
9500
      else
9501
        ++i;
9502
    }
9503
}
9504
 
9505
/* Clear implies relations which contain PRs in the given masks.
9506
   P1_MASK indicates the source of the implies relation, while P2_MASK
9507
   indicates the implied PR.  */
9508
 
9509
static void
9510
clear_qp_implies (valueT p1_mask, valueT p2_mask)
9511
{
9512
  int i;
9513
 
9514
  i = 0;
9515
  while (i < qp_implieslen)
9516
    {
9517
      if ((((valueT) 1 << qp_implies[i].p1) & p1_mask) != 0
9518
          || (((valueT) 1 << qp_implies[i].p2) & p2_mask) != 0)
9519
        {
9520
          if (md.debug_dv)
9521
            fprintf (stderr, "Clearing implied relation PR%d->PR%d\n",
9522
                     qp_implies[i].p1, qp_implies[i].p2);
9523
          qp_implies[i] = qp_implies[--qp_implieslen];
9524
        }
9525
      else
9526
        ++i;
9527
    }
9528
}
9529
 
9530
/* Add the PRs specified to the list of implied relations.  */
9531
 
9532
static void
9533
add_qp_imply (int p1, int p2)
9534
{
9535
  valueT mask;
9536
  valueT bit;
9537
  int i;
9538
 
9539
  /* p0 is not meaningful here.  */
9540
  if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
9541
    abort ();
9542
 
9543
  if (p1 == p2)
9544
    return;
9545
 
9546
  /* If it exists already, ignore it.  */
9547
  for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
9548
    {
9549
      if (qp_implies[i].p1 == p1
9550
          && qp_implies[i].p2 == p2
9551
          && qp_implies[i].path == md.path
9552
          && !qp_implies[i].p2_branched)
9553
        return;
9554
    }
9555
 
9556
  if (qp_implieslen == qp_impliestotlen)
9557
    {
9558
      qp_impliestotlen += 20;
9559
      qp_implies = (struct qp_imply *)
9560
        xrealloc ((void *) qp_implies,
9561
                  qp_impliestotlen * sizeof (struct qp_imply));
9562
    }
9563
  if (md.debug_dv)
9564
    fprintf (stderr, "  Registering PR%d implies PR%d\n", p1, p2);
9565
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].p1 = p1;
9566
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].p2 = p2;
9567
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen].path = md.path;
9568
  qp_implies[qp_implieslen++].p2_branched = 0;
9569
 
9570
  /* Add in the implied transitive relations; for everything that p2 implies,
9571
     make p1 imply that, too; for everything that implies p1, make it imply p2
9572
     as well.  */
9573
  for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
9574
    {
9575
      if (qp_implies[i].p1 == p2)
9576
        add_qp_imply (p1, qp_implies[i].p2);
9577
      if (qp_implies[i].p2 == p1)
9578
        add_qp_imply (qp_implies[i].p1, p2);
9579
    }
9580
  /* Add in mutex relations implied by this implies relation; for each mutex
9581
     relation containing p2, duplicate it and replace p2 with p1.  */
9582
  bit = (valueT) 1 << p1;
9583
  mask = (valueT) 1 << p2;
9584
  for (i = 0; i < qp_mutexeslen; i++)
9585
    {
9586
      if (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask)
9587
        add_qp_mutex ((qp_mutexes[i].prmask & ~mask) | bit);
9588
    }
9589
}
9590
 
9591
/* Add the PRs specified in the mask to the mutex list; this means that only
9592
   one of the PRs can be true at any time.  PR0 should never be included in
9593
   the mask.  */
9594
 
9595
static void
9596
add_qp_mutex (valueT mask)
9597
{
9598
  if (mask & 0x1)
9599
    abort ();
9600
 
9601
  if (qp_mutexeslen == qp_mutexestotlen)
9602
    {
9603
      qp_mutexestotlen += 20;
9604
      qp_mutexes = (struct qpmutex *)
9605
        xrealloc ((void *) qp_mutexes,
9606
                  qp_mutexestotlen * sizeof (struct qpmutex));
9607
    }
9608
  if (md.debug_dv)
9609
    {
9610
      fprintf (stderr, "  Registering mutex on");
9611
      print_prmask (mask);
9612
      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9613
    }
9614
  qp_mutexes[qp_mutexeslen].path = md.path;
9615
  qp_mutexes[qp_mutexeslen++].prmask = mask;
9616
}
9617
 
9618
static int
9619
has_suffix_p (const char *name, const char *suffix)
9620
{
9621
  size_t namelen = strlen (name);
9622
  size_t sufflen = strlen (suffix);
9623
 
9624
  if (namelen <= sufflen)
9625
    return 0;
9626
  return strcmp (name + namelen - sufflen, suffix) == 0;
9627
}
9628
 
9629
static void
9630
clear_register_values (void)
9631
{
9632
  int i;
9633
  if (md.debug_dv)
9634
    fprintf (stderr, "  Clearing register values\n");
9635
  for (i = 1; i < NELEMS (gr_values); i++)
9636
    gr_values[i].known = 0;
9637
}
9638
 
9639
/* Keep track of register values/changes which affect DV tracking.
9640
 
9641
   optimization note: should add a flag to classes of insns where otherwise we
9642
   have to examine a group of strings to identify them.  */
9643
 
9644
static void
9645
note_register_values (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
9646
{
9647
  valueT qp_changemask = 0;
9648
  int i;
9649
 
9650
  /* Invalidate values for registers being written to.  */
9651
  for (i = 0; i < idesc->num_outputs; i++)
9652
    {
9653
      if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R1
9654
          || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R2
9655
          || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3)
9656
        {
9657
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9658
          if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9659
            gr_values[regno].known = 0;
9660
        }
9661
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_R3_2)
9662
        {
9663
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9664
          if (regno > 0 && regno < 4)
9665
            gr_values[regno].known = 0;
9666
        }
9667
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P1
9668
               || idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9669
        {
9670
          int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[i].X_add_number - REG_P;
9671
          qp_changemask |= (valueT) 1 << regno;
9672
        }
9673
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PR)
9674
        {
9675
          if (idesc->operands[2] & (valueT) 0x10000)
9676
            qp_changemask = ~(valueT) 0x1FFFF | idesc->operands[2];
9677
          else
9678
            qp_changemask = idesc->operands[2];
9679
          break;
9680
        }
9681
      else if (idesc->operands[i] == IA64_OPND_PR_ROT)
9682
        {
9683
          if (idesc->operands[1] & ((valueT) 1 << 43))
9684
            qp_changemask = -((valueT) 1 << 44) | idesc->operands[1];
9685
          else
9686
            qp_changemask = idesc->operands[1];
9687
          qp_changemask &= ~(valueT) 0xFFFF;
9688
          break;
9689
        }
9690
    }
9691
 
9692
  /* Always clear qp branch flags on any PR change.  */
9693
  /* FIXME there may be exceptions for certain compares.  */
9694
  clear_qp_branch_flag (qp_changemask);
9695
 
9696
  /* Invalidate rotating registers on insns which affect RRBs in CFM.  */
9697
  if (idesc->flags & IA64_OPCODE_MOD_RRBS)
9698
    {
9699
      qp_changemask |= ~(valueT) 0xFFFF;
9700
      if (strcmp (idesc->name, "clrrrb.pr") != 0)
9701
        {
9702
          for (i = 32; i < 32 + md.rot.num_regs; i++)
9703
            gr_values[i].known = 0;
9704
        }
9705
      clear_qp_mutex (qp_changemask);
9706
      clear_qp_implies (qp_changemask, qp_changemask);
9707
    }
9708
  /* After a call, all register values are undefined, except those marked
9709
     as "safe".  */
9710
  else if (strncmp (idesc->name, "br.call", 6) == 0
9711
           || strncmp (idesc->name, "brl.call", 7) == 0)
9712
    {
9713
      /* FIXME keep GR values which are marked as "safe_across_calls"  */
9714
      clear_register_values ();
9715
      clear_qp_mutex (~qp_safe_across_calls);
9716
      clear_qp_implies (~qp_safe_across_calls, ~qp_safe_across_calls);
9717
      clear_qp_branch_flag (~qp_safe_across_calls);
9718
    }
9719
  else if (is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
9720
           || is_taken_branch (idesc))
9721
    {
9722
      clear_register_values ();
9723
      clear_qp_mutex (~(valueT) 0);
9724
      clear_qp_implies (~(valueT) 0, ~(valueT) 0);
9725
    }
9726
  /* Look for mutex and implies relations.  */
9727
  else if ((idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P1
9728
            || idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_P2)
9729
           && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P1
9730
               || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_P2))
9731
    {
9732
      int p1 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_P;
9733
      int p2 = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number - REG_P;
9734
      valueT p1mask = (p1 != 0) ? (valueT) 1 << p1 : 0;
9735
      valueT p2mask = (p2 != 0) ? (valueT) 1 << p2 : 0;
9736
 
9737
      /* If both PRs are PR0, we can't really do anything.  */
9738
      if (p1 == 0 && p2 == 0)
9739
        {
9740
          if (md.debug_dv)
9741
            fprintf (stderr, "  Ignoring PRs due to inclusion of p0\n");
9742
        }
9743
      /* In general, clear mutexes and implies which include P1 or P2,
9744
         with the following exceptions.  */
9745
      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".or.andcm")
9746
               || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".and.orcm"))
9747
        {
9748
          clear_qp_implies (p2mask, p1mask);
9749
        }
9750
      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".andcm")
9751
               || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".and"))
9752
        {
9753
          clear_qp_implies (0, p1mask | p2mask);
9754
        }
9755
      else if (has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".orcm")
9756
               || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".or"))
9757
        {
9758
          clear_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9759
          clear_qp_implies (p1mask | p2mask, 0);
9760
        }
9761
      else
9762
        {
9763
          int added = 0;
9764
 
9765
          clear_qp_implies (p1mask | p2mask, p1mask | p2mask);
9766
 
9767
          /* If one of the PRs is PR0, we call clear_qp_mutex.  */
9768
          if (p1 == 0 || p2 == 0)
9769
            clear_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9770
          else
9771
            added = update_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9772
 
9773
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0
9774
              || has_suffix_p (idesc->name, ".unc"))
9775
            {
9776
              if (added == 0 && p1 && p2)
9777
                add_qp_mutex (p1mask | p2mask);
9778
              if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
9779
                {
9780
                  if (p1)
9781
                    add_qp_imply (p1, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno);
9782
                  if (p2)
9783
                    add_qp_imply (p2, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno);
9784
                }
9785
            }
9786
        }
9787
    }
9788
  /* Look for mov imm insns into GRs.  */
9789
  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_R1
9790
           && (idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMM22
9791
               || idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMMU64)
9792
           && CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_op == O_constant
9793
           && (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0
9794
               || strcmp (idesc->name, "movl") == 0))
9795
    {
9796
      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9797
      if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9798
        {
9799
          gr_values[regno].known = 1;
9800
          gr_values[regno].value = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number;
9801
          gr_values[regno].path = md.path;
9802
          if (md.debug_dv)
9803
            {
9804
              fprintf (stderr, "  Know gr%d = ", regno);
9805
              fprintf_vma (stderr, gr_values[regno].value);
9806
              fputs ("\n", stderr);
9807
            }
9808
        }
9809
    }
9810
  /* Look for dep.z imm insns.  */
9811
  else if (idesc->operands[0] == IA64_OPND_R1
9812
           && idesc->operands[1] == IA64_OPND_IMM8
9813
           && strcmp (idesc->name, "dep.z") == 0)
9814
    {
9815
      int regno = CURR_SLOT.opnd[0].X_add_number - REG_GR;
9816
      if (regno > 0 && regno < NELEMS (gr_values))
9817
        {
9818
          valueT value = CURR_SLOT.opnd[1].X_add_number;
9819
 
9820
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[3].X_add_number < 64)
9821
            value &= ((valueT)1 << CURR_SLOT.opnd[3].X_add_number) - 1;
9822
          value <<= CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number;
9823
          gr_values[regno].known = 1;
9824
          gr_values[regno].value = value;
9825
          gr_values[regno].path = md.path;
9826
          if (md.debug_dv)
9827
            {
9828
              fprintf (stderr, "  Know gr%d = ", regno);
9829
              fprintf_vma (stderr, gr_values[regno].value);
9830
              fputs ("\n", stderr);
9831
            }
9832
        }
9833
    }
9834
  else
9835
    {
9836
      clear_qp_mutex (qp_changemask);
9837
      clear_qp_implies (qp_changemask, qp_changemask);
9838
    }
9839
}
9840
 
9841
/* Return whether the given predicate registers are currently mutex.  */
9842
 
9843
static int
9844
qp_mutex (int p1, int p2, int path)
9845
{
9846
  int i;
9847
  valueT mask;
9848
 
9849
  if (p1 != p2)
9850
    {
9851
      mask = ((valueT) 1 << p1) | (valueT) 1 << p2;
9852
      for (i = 0; i < qp_mutexeslen; i++)
9853
        {
9854
          if (qp_mutexes[i].path >= path
9855
              && (qp_mutexes[i].prmask & mask) == mask)
9856
            return 1;
9857
        }
9858
    }
9859
  return 0;
9860
}
9861
 
9862
/* Return whether the given resource is in the given insn's list of chks
9863
   Return 1 if the conflict is absolutely determined, 2 if it's a potential
9864
   conflict.  */
9865
 
9866
static int
9867
resources_match (struct rsrc *rs,
9868
                 struct ia64_opcode *idesc,
9869
                 int note,
9870
                 int qp_regno,
9871
                 int path)
9872
{
9873
  struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];
9874
  int count;
9875
 
9876
  /* If the marked resource's qp_regno and the given qp_regno are mutex,
9877
     we don't need to check.  One exception is note 11, which indicates that
9878
     target predicates are written regardless of PR[qp].  */
9879
  if (qp_mutex (rs->qp_regno, qp_regno, path)
9880
      && note != 11)
9881
    return 0;
9882
 
9883
  count = specify_resource (rs->dependency, idesc, DV_CHK, specs, note, path);
9884
  while (count-- > 0)
9885
    {
9886
      /* UNAT checking is a bit more specific than other resources */
9887
      if (rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_AR_UNAT
9888
          && specs[count].mem_offset.hint
9889
          && rs->mem_offset.hint)
9890
        {
9891
          if (rs->mem_offset.base == specs[count].mem_offset.base)
9892
            {
9893
              if (((rs->mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F) ==
9894
                  ((specs[count].mem_offset.offset >> 3) & 0x3F))
9895
                return 1;
9896
              else
9897
                continue;
9898
            }
9899
        }
9900
 
9901
      /* Skip apparent PR write conflicts where both writes are an AND or both
9902
         writes are an OR.  */
9903
      if (rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PR
9904
          || rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PRr
9905
          || rs->dependency->specifier == IA64_RS_PR63)
9906
        {
9907
          if (specs[count].cmp_type != CMP_NONE
9908
              && specs[count].cmp_type == rs->cmp_type)
9909
            {
9910
              if (md.debug_dv)
9911
                fprintf (stderr, "  %s on parallel compare allowed (PR%d)\n",
9912
                         dv_mode[rs->dependency->mode],
9913
                         rs->dependency->specifier != IA64_RS_PR63 ?
9914
                         specs[count].index : 63);
9915
              continue;
9916
            }
9917
          if (md.debug_dv)
9918
            fprintf (stderr,
9919
                     "  %s on parallel compare conflict %s vs %s on PR%d\n",
9920
                     dv_mode[rs->dependency->mode],
9921
                     dv_cmp_type[rs->cmp_type],
9922
                     dv_cmp_type[specs[count].cmp_type],
9923
                     rs->dependency->specifier != IA64_RS_PR63 ?
9924
                     specs[count].index : 63);
9925
 
9926
        }
9927
 
9928
      /* If either resource is not specific, conservatively assume a conflict
9929
       */
9930
      if (!specs[count].specific || !rs->specific)
9931
        return 2;
9932
      else if (specs[count].index == rs->index)
9933
        return 1;
9934
    }
9935
 
9936
  return 0;
9937
}
9938
 
9939
/* Indicate an instruction group break; if INSERT_STOP is non-zero, then
9940
   insert a stop to create the break.  Update all resource dependencies
9941
   appropriately.  If QP_REGNO is non-zero, only apply the break to resources
9942
   which use the same QP_REGNO and have the link_to_qp_branch flag set.
9943
   If SAVE_CURRENT is non-zero, don't affect resources marked by the current
9944
   instruction.  */
9945
 
9946
static void
9947
insn_group_break (int insert_stop, int qp_regno, int save_current)
9948
{
9949
  int i;
9950
 
9951
  if (insert_stop && md.num_slots_in_use > 0)
9952
    PREV_SLOT.end_of_insn_group = 1;
9953
 
9954
  if (md.debug_dv)
9955
    {
9956
      fprintf (stderr, "  Insn group break%s",
9957
               (insert_stop ? " (w/stop)" : ""));
9958
      if (qp_regno != 0)
9959
        fprintf (stderr, " effective for QP=%d", qp_regno);
9960
      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9961
    }
9962
 
9963
  i = 0;
9964
  while (i < regdepslen)
9965
    {
9966
      const struct ia64_dependency *dep = regdeps[i].dependency;
9967
 
9968
      if (qp_regno != 0
9969
          && regdeps[i].qp_regno != qp_regno)
9970
        {
9971
          ++i;
9972
          continue;
9973
        }
9974
 
9975
      if (save_current
9976
          && CURR_SLOT.src_file == regdeps[i].file
9977
          && CURR_SLOT.src_line == regdeps[i].line)
9978
        {
9979
          ++i;
9980
          continue;
9981
        }
9982
 
9983
      /* clear dependencies which are automatically cleared by a stop, or
9984
         those that have reached the appropriate state of insn serialization */
9985
      if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_IMPLIED
9986
          || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_IMPLIEDF
9987
          || regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_SRLZ)
9988
        {
9989
          print_dependency ("Removing", i);
9990
          regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
9991
        }
9992
      else
9993
        {
9994
          if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_DATA
9995
              || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_INSTR
9996
              || dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_SPECIFIC)
9997
            {
9998
              if (regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_NONE)
9999
                regdeps[i].insn_srlz = STATE_STOP;
10000
              if (regdeps[i].data_srlz == STATE_NONE)
10001
                regdeps[i].data_srlz = STATE_STOP;
10002
            }
10003
          ++i;
10004
        }
10005
    }
10006
}
10007
 
10008
/* Add the given resource usage spec to the list of active dependencies.  */
10009
 
10010
static void
10011
mark_resource (struct ia64_opcode *idesc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10012
               const struct ia64_dependency *dep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10013
               struct rsrc *spec,
10014
               int depind,
10015
               int path)
10016
{
10017
  if (regdepslen == regdepstotlen)
10018
    {
10019
      regdepstotlen += 20;
10020
      regdeps = (struct rsrc *)
10021
        xrealloc ((void *) regdeps,
10022
                  regdepstotlen * sizeof (struct rsrc));
10023
    }
10024
 
10025
  regdeps[regdepslen] = *spec;
10026
  regdeps[regdepslen].depind = depind;
10027
  regdeps[regdepslen].path = path;
10028
  regdeps[regdepslen].file = CURR_SLOT.src_file;
10029
  regdeps[regdepslen].line = CURR_SLOT.src_line;
10030
 
10031
  print_dependency ("Adding", regdepslen);
10032
 
10033
  ++regdepslen;
10034
}
10035
 
10036
static void
10037
print_dependency (const char *action, int depind)
10038
{
10039
  if (md.debug_dv)
10040
    {
10041
      fprintf (stderr, "  %s %s '%s'",
10042
               action, dv_mode[(regdeps[depind].dependency)->mode],
10043
               (regdeps[depind].dependency)->name);
10044
      if (regdeps[depind].specific && regdeps[depind].index >= 0)
10045
        fprintf (stderr, " (%d)", regdeps[depind].index);
10046
      if (regdeps[depind].mem_offset.hint)
10047
        {
10048
          fputs (" ", stderr);
10049
          fprintf_vma (stderr, regdeps[depind].mem_offset.base);
10050
          fputs ("+", stderr);
10051
          fprintf_vma (stderr, regdeps[depind].mem_offset.offset);
10052
        }
10053
      fprintf (stderr, "\n");
10054
    }
10055
}
10056
 
10057
static void
10058
instruction_serialization (void)
10059
{
10060
  int i;
10061
  if (md.debug_dv)
10062
    fprintf (stderr, "  Instruction serialization\n");
10063
  for (i = 0; i < regdepslen; i++)
10064
    if (regdeps[i].insn_srlz == STATE_STOP)
10065
      regdeps[i].insn_srlz = STATE_SRLZ;
10066
}
10067
 
10068
static void
10069
data_serialization (void)
10070
{
10071
  int i = 0;
10072
  if (md.debug_dv)
10073
    fprintf (stderr, "  Data serialization\n");
10074
  while (i < regdepslen)
10075
    {
10076
      if (regdeps[i].data_srlz == STATE_STOP
10077
          /* Note: as of 991210, all "other" dependencies are cleared by a
10078
             data serialization.  This might change with new tables */
10079
          || (regdeps[i].dependency)->semantics == IA64_DVS_OTHER)
10080
        {
10081
          print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10082
          regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10083
        }
10084
      else
10085
        ++i;
10086
    }
10087
}
10088
 
10089
/* Insert stops and serializations as needed to avoid DVs.  */
10090
 
10091
static void
10092
remove_marked_resource (struct rsrc *rs)
10093
{
10094
  switch (rs->dependency->semantics)
10095
    {
10096
    case IA64_DVS_SPECIFIC:
10097
      if (md.debug_dv)
10098
        fprintf (stderr, "Implementation-specific, assume worst case...\n");
10099
      /* ...fall through...  */
10100
    case IA64_DVS_INSTR:
10101
      if (md.debug_dv)
10102
        fprintf (stderr, "Inserting instr serialization\n");
10103
      if (rs->insn_srlz < STATE_STOP)
10104
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10105
      if (rs->insn_srlz < STATE_SRLZ)
10106
        {
10107
          struct slot oldslot = CURR_SLOT;
10108
          /* Manually jam a srlz.i insn into the stream */
10109
          memset (&CURR_SLOT, 0, sizeof (CURR_SLOT));
10110
          CURR_SLOT.user_template = -1;
10111
          CURR_SLOT.idesc = ia64_find_opcode ("srlz.i");
10112
          instruction_serialization ();
10113
          md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10114
          if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10115
            emit_one_bundle ();
10116
          CURR_SLOT = oldslot;
10117
        }
10118
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10119
      break;
10120
    case IA64_DVS_OTHER: /* as of rev2 (991220) of the DV tables, all
10121
                            "other" types of DV are eliminated
10122
                            by a data serialization */
10123
    case IA64_DVS_DATA:
10124
      if (md.debug_dv)
10125
        fprintf (stderr, "Inserting data serialization\n");
10126
      if (rs->data_srlz < STATE_STOP)
10127
        insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10128
      {
10129
        struct slot oldslot = CURR_SLOT;
10130
        /* Manually jam a srlz.d insn into the stream */
10131
        memset (&CURR_SLOT, 0, sizeof (CURR_SLOT));
10132
        CURR_SLOT.user_template = -1;
10133
        CURR_SLOT.idesc = ia64_find_opcode ("srlz.d");
10134
        data_serialization ();
10135
        md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10136
        if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10137
          emit_one_bundle ();
10138
        CURR_SLOT = oldslot;
10139
      }
10140
      break;
10141
    case IA64_DVS_IMPLIED:
10142
    case IA64_DVS_IMPLIEDF:
10143
      if (md.debug_dv)
10144
        fprintf (stderr, "Inserting stop\n");
10145
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10146
      break;
10147
    default:
10148
      break;
10149
    }
10150
}
10151
 
10152
/* Check the resources used by the given opcode against the current dependency
10153
   list.
10154
 
10155
   The check is run once for each execution path encountered.  In this case,
10156
   a unique execution path is the sequence of instructions following a code
10157
   entry point, e.g. the following has three execution paths, one starting
10158
   at L0, one at L1, and one at L2.
10159
 
10160
   L0:     nop
10161
   L1:     add
10162
   L2:     add
10163
   br.ret
10164
*/
10165
 
10166
static void
10167
check_dependencies (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10168
{
10169
  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *opdeps = idesc->dependencies;
10170
  int path;
10171
  int i;
10172
 
10173
  /* Note that the number of marked resources may change within the
10174
     loop if in auto mode.  */
10175
  i = 0;
10176
  while (i < regdepslen)
10177
    {
10178
      struct rsrc *rs = &regdeps[i];
10179
      const struct ia64_dependency *dep = rs->dependency;
10180
      int chkind;
10181
      int note;
10182
      int start_over = 0;
10183
 
10184
      if (dep->semantics == IA64_DVS_NONE
10185
          || (chkind = depends_on (rs->depind, idesc)) == -1)
10186
        {
10187
          ++i;
10188
          continue;
10189
        }
10190
 
10191
      note = NOTE (opdeps->chks[chkind]);
10192
 
10193
      /* Check this resource against each execution path seen thus far.  */
10194
      for (path = 0; path <= md.path; path++)
10195
        {
10196
          int matchtype;
10197
 
10198
          /* If the dependency wasn't on the path being checked, ignore it.  */
10199
          if (rs->path < path)
10200
            continue;
10201
 
10202
          /* If the QP for this insn implies a QP which has branched, don't
10203
             bother checking.  Ed. NOTE: I don't think this check is terribly
10204
             useful; what's the point of generating code which will only be
10205
             reached if its QP is zero?
10206
             This code was specifically inserted to handle the following code,
10207
             based on notes from Intel's DV checking code, where p1 implies p2.
10208
 
10209
                  mov r4 = 2
10210
             (p2) br.cond L
10211
             (p1) mov r4 = 7
10212
          */
10213
          if (CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10214
            {
10215
              int skip = 0;
10216
              int implies;
10217
              for (implies = 0; implies < qp_implieslen; implies++)
10218
                {
10219
                  if (qp_implies[implies].path >= path
10220
                      && qp_implies[implies].p1 == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno
10221
                      && qp_implies[implies].p2_branched)
10222
                    {
10223
                      skip = 1;
10224
                      break;
10225
                    }
10226
                }
10227
              if (skip)
10228
                continue;
10229
            }
10230
 
10231
          if ((matchtype = resources_match (rs, idesc, note,
10232
                                            CURR_SLOT.qp_regno, path)) != 0)
10233
            {
10234
              char msg[1024];
10235
              char pathmsg[256] = "";
10236
              char indexmsg[256] = "";
10237
              int certain = (matchtype == 1 && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno == 0);
10238
 
10239
              if (path != 0)
10240
                snprintf (pathmsg, sizeof (pathmsg),
10241
                          " when entry is at label '%s'",
10242
                         md.entry_labels[path - 1]);
10243
              if (matchtype == 1 && rs->index >= 0)
10244
                snprintf (indexmsg, sizeof (indexmsg),
10245
                          ", specific resource number is %d",
10246
                         rs->index);
10247
              snprintf (msg, sizeof (msg),
10248
                        "Use of '%s' %s %s dependency '%s' (%s)%s%s",
10249
                       idesc->name,
10250
                       (certain ? "violates" : "may violate"),
10251
                       dv_mode[dep->mode], dep->name,
10252
                       dv_sem[dep->semantics],
10253
                       pathmsg, indexmsg);
10254
 
10255
              if (md.explicit_mode)
10256
                {
10257
                  as_warn ("%s", msg);
10258
                  if (path < md.path)
10259
                    as_warn (_("Only the first path encountering the conflict is reported"));
10260
                  as_warn_where (rs->file, rs->line,
10261
                                 _("This is the location of the conflicting usage"));
10262
                  /* Don't bother checking other paths, to avoid duplicating
10263
                     the same warning */
10264
                  break;
10265
                }
10266
              else
10267
                {
10268
                  if (md.debug_dv)
10269
                    fprintf (stderr, "%s @ %s:%d\n", msg, rs->file, rs->line);
10270
 
10271
                  remove_marked_resource (rs);
10272
 
10273
                  /* since the set of dependencies has changed, start over */
10274
                  /* FIXME -- since we're removing dvs as we go, we
10275
                     probably don't really need to start over...  */
10276
                  start_over = 1;
10277
                  break;
10278
                }
10279
            }
10280
        }
10281
      if (start_over)
10282
        i = 0;
10283
      else
10284
        ++i;
10285
    }
10286
}
10287
 
10288
/* Register new dependencies based on the given opcode.  */
10289
 
10290
static void
10291
mark_resources (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10292
{
10293
  int i;
10294
  const struct ia64_opcode_dependency *opdeps = idesc->dependencies;
10295
  int add_only_qp_reads = 0;
10296
 
10297
  /* A conditional branch only uses its resources if it is taken; if it is
10298
     taken, we stop following that path.  The other branch types effectively
10299
     *always* write their resources.  If it's not taken, register only QP
10300
     reads.  */
10301
  if (is_conditional_branch (idesc) || is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc))
10302
    {
10303
      add_only_qp_reads = 1;
10304
    }
10305
 
10306
  if (md.debug_dv)
10307
    fprintf (stderr, "Registering '%s' resource usage\n", idesc->name);
10308
 
10309
  for (i = 0; i < opdeps->nregs; i++)
10310
    {
10311
      const struct ia64_dependency *dep;
10312
      struct rsrc specs[MAX_SPECS];
10313
      int note;
10314
      int path;
10315
      int count;
10316
 
10317
      dep = ia64_find_dependency (opdeps->regs[i]);
10318
      note = NOTE (opdeps->regs[i]);
10319
 
10320
      if (add_only_qp_reads
10321
          && !(dep->mode == IA64_DV_WAR
10322
               && (dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PR
10323
                   || dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PRr
10324
                   || dep->specifier == IA64_RS_PR63)))
10325
        continue;
10326
 
10327
      count = specify_resource (dep, idesc, DV_REG, specs, note, md.path);
10328
 
10329
      while (count-- > 0)
10330
        {
10331
          mark_resource (idesc, dep, &specs[count],
10332
                         DEP (opdeps->regs[i]), md.path);
10333
        }
10334
 
10335
      /* The execution path may affect register values, which may in turn
10336
         affect which indirect-access resources are accessed.  */
10337
      switch (dep->specifier)
10338
        {
10339
        default:
10340
          break;
10341
        case IA64_RS_CPUID:
10342
        case IA64_RS_DBR:
10343
        case IA64_RS_IBR:
10344
        case IA64_RS_MSR:
10345
        case IA64_RS_PKR:
10346
        case IA64_RS_PMC:
10347
        case IA64_RS_PMD:
10348
        case IA64_RS_RR:
10349
          for (path = 0; path < md.path; path++)
10350
            {
10351
              count = specify_resource (dep, idesc, DV_REG, specs, note, path);
10352
              while (count-- > 0)
10353
                mark_resource (idesc, dep, &specs[count],
10354
                               DEP (opdeps->regs[i]), path);
10355
            }
10356
          break;
10357
        }
10358
    }
10359
}
10360
 
10361
/* Remove dependencies when they no longer apply.  */
10362
 
10363
static void
10364
update_dependencies (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10365
{
10366
  int i;
10367
 
10368
  if (strcmp (idesc->name, "srlz.i") == 0)
10369
    {
10370
      instruction_serialization ();
10371
    }
10372
  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "srlz.d") == 0)
10373
    {
10374
      data_serialization ();
10375
    }
10376
  else if (is_interruption_or_rfi (idesc)
10377
           || is_taken_branch (idesc))
10378
    {
10379
      /* Although technically the taken branch doesn't clear dependencies
10380
         which require a srlz.[id], we don't follow the branch; the next
10381
         instruction is assumed to start with a clean slate.  */
10382
      regdepslen = 0;
10383
      md.path = 0;
10384
    }
10385
  else if (is_conditional_branch (idesc)
10386
           && CURR_SLOT.qp_regno != 0)
10387
    {
10388
      int is_call = strstr (idesc->name, ".call") != NULL;
10389
 
10390
      for (i = 0; i < qp_implieslen; i++)
10391
        {
10392
          /* If the conditional branch's predicate is implied by the predicate
10393
             in an existing dependency, remove that dependency.  */
10394
          if (qp_implies[i].p2 == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno)
10395
            {
10396
              int depind = 0;
10397
              /* Note that this implied predicate takes a branch so that if
10398
                 a later insn generates a DV but its predicate implies this
10399
                 one, we can avoid the false DV warning.  */
10400
              qp_implies[i].p2_branched = 1;
10401
              while (depind < regdepslen)
10402
                {
10403
                  if (regdeps[depind].qp_regno == qp_implies[i].p1)
10404
                    {
10405
                      print_dependency ("Removing", depind);
10406
                      regdeps[depind] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10407
                    }
10408
                  else
10409
                    ++depind;
10410
                }
10411
            }
10412
        }
10413
      /* Any marked resources which have this same predicate should be
10414
         cleared, provided that the QP hasn't been modified between the
10415
         marking instruction and the branch.  */
10416
      if (is_call)
10417
        {
10418
          insn_group_break (0, CURR_SLOT.qp_regno, 1);
10419
        }
10420
      else
10421
        {
10422
          i = 0;
10423
          while (i < regdepslen)
10424
            {
10425
              if (regdeps[i].qp_regno == CURR_SLOT.qp_regno
10426
                  && regdeps[i].link_to_qp_branch
10427
                  && (regdeps[i].file != CURR_SLOT.src_file
10428
                      || regdeps[i].line != CURR_SLOT.src_line))
10429
                {
10430
                  /* Treat like a taken branch */
10431
                  print_dependency ("Removing", i);
10432
                  regdeps[i] = regdeps[--regdepslen];
10433
                }
10434
              else
10435
                ++i;
10436
            }
10437
        }
10438
    }
10439
}
10440
 
10441
/* Examine the current instruction for dependency violations.  */
10442
 
10443
static int
10444
check_dv (struct ia64_opcode *idesc)
10445
{
10446
  if (md.debug_dv)
10447
    {
10448
      fprintf (stderr, "Checking %s for violations (line %d, %d/%d)\n",
10449
               idesc->name, CURR_SLOT.src_line,
10450
               idesc->dependencies->nchks,
10451
               idesc->dependencies->nregs);
10452
    }
10453
 
10454
  /* Look through the list of currently marked resources; if the current
10455
     instruction has the dependency in its chks list which uses that resource,
10456
     check against the specific resources used.  */
10457
  check_dependencies (idesc);
10458
 
10459
  /* Look up the instruction's regdeps (RAW writes, WAW writes, and WAR reads),
10460
     then add them to the list of marked resources.  */
10461
  mark_resources (idesc);
10462
 
10463
  /* There are several types of dependency semantics, and each has its own
10464
     requirements for being cleared
10465
 
10466
     Instruction serialization (insns separated by interruption, rfi, or
10467
     writer + srlz.i + reader, all in separate groups) clears DVS_INSTR.
10468
 
10469
     Data serialization (instruction serialization, or writer + srlz.d +
10470
     reader, where writer and srlz.d are in separate groups) clears
10471
     DVS_DATA. (This also clears DVS_OTHER, but that is not guaranteed to
10472
     always be the case).
10473
 
10474
     Instruction group break (groups separated by stop, taken branch,
10475
     interruption or rfi) clears DVS_IMPLIED and DVS_IMPLIEDF.
10476
   */
10477
  update_dependencies (idesc);
10478
 
10479
  /* Sometimes, knowing a register value allows us to avoid giving a false DV
10480
     warning.  Keep track of as many as possible that are useful.  */
10481
  note_register_values (idesc);
10482
 
10483
  /* We don't need or want this anymore.  */
10484
  md.mem_offset.hint = 0;
10485
 
10486
  return 0;
10487
}
10488
 
10489
/* Translate one line of assembly.  Pseudo ops and labels do not show
10490
   here.  */
10491
void
10492
md_assemble (char *str)
10493
{
10494
  char *saved_input_line_pointer, *mnemonic;
10495
  const struct pseudo_opcode *pdesc;
10496
  struct ia64_opcode *idesc;
10497
  unsigned char qp_regno;
10498
  unsigned int flags;
10499
  int ch;
10500
 
10501
  saved_input_line_pointer = input_line_pointer;
10502
  input_line_pointer = str;
10503
 
10504
  /* extract the opcode (mnemonic):  */
10505
 
10506
  mnemonic = input_line_pointer;
10507
  ch = get_symbol_end ();
10508
  pdesc = (struct pseudo_opcode *) hash_find (md.pseudo_hash, mnemonic);
10509
  if (pdesc)
10510
    {
10511
      *input_line_pointer = ch;
10512
      (*pdesc->handler) (pdesc->arg);
10513
      goto done;
10514
    }
10515
 
10516
  /* Find the instruction descriptor matching the arguments.  */
10517
 
10518
  idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10519
  *input_line_pointer = ch;
10520
  if (!idesc)
10521
    {
10522
      as_bad (_("Unknown opcode `%s'"), mnemonic);
10523
      goto done;
10524
    }
10525
 
10526
  idesc = parse_operands (idesc);
10527
  if (!idesc)
10528
    goto done;
10529
 
10530
  /* Handle the dynamic ops we can handle now:  */
10531
  if (idesc->type == IA64_TYPE_DYN)
10532
    {
10533
      if (strcmp (idesc->name, "add") == 0)
10534
        {
10535
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_op == O_register
10536
              && CURR_SLOT.opnd[2].X_add_number < 4)
10537
            mnemonic = "addl";
10538
          else
10539
            mnemonic = "adds";
10540
          ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
10541
          idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10542
        }
10543
      else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov") == 0)
10544
        {
10545
          enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
10546
          int rop;
10547
 
10548
          opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
10549
          opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
10550
          if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10551
            rop = 0;
10552
          else if (opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10553
            rop = 1;
10554
          else
10555
            abort ();
10556
          if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_op == O_register)
10557
            {
10558
              if (ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10559
                mnemonic = "mov.i";
10560
              else if (ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10561
                mnemonic = "mov.m";
10562
              else
10563
                rop = -1;
10564
            }
10565
          else
10566
            abort ();
10567
          if (rop >= 0)
10568
            {
10569
              ia64_free_opcode (idesc);
10570
              idesc = ia64_find_opcode (mnemonic);
10571
              while (idesc != NULL
10572
                     && (idesc->operands[0] != opnd1
10573
                         || idesc->operands[1] != opnd2))
10574
                idesc = get_next_opcode (idesc);
10575
            }
10576
        }
10577
    }
10578
  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "mov.i") == 0
10579
           || strcmp (idesc->name, "mov.m") == 0)
10580
    {
10581
      enum ia64_opnd opnd1, opnd2;
10582
      int rop;
10583
 
10584
      opnd1 = idesc->operands[0];
10585
      opnd2 = idesc->operands[1];
10586
      if (opnd1 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10587
        rop = 0;
10588
      else if (opnd2 == IA64_OPND_AR3)
10589
        rop = 1;
10590
      else
10591
        abort ();
10592
      if (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_op == O_register)
10593
        {
10594
          char unit = 'a';
10595
          if (ar_is_only_in_integer_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10596
            unit = 'i';
10597
          else if (ar_is_only_in_memory_unit (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number))
10598
            unit = 'm';
10599
          if (unit != 'a' && unit != idesc->name [4])
10600
            as_bad (_("AR %d can only be accessed by %c-unit"),
10601
                    (int) (CURR_SLOT.opnd[rop].X_add_number - REG_AR),
10602
                    TOUPPER (unit));
10603
        }
10604
    }
10605
  else if (strcmp (idesc->name, "hint.b") == 0)
10606
    {
10607
      switch (md.hint_b)
10608
        {
10609
        case hint_b_ok:
10610
          break;
10611
        case hint_b_warning:
10612
          as_warn (_("hint.b may be treated as nop"));
10613
          break;
10614
        case hint_b_error:
10615
          as_bad (_("hint.b shouldn't be used"));
10616
          break;
10617
        }
10618
    }
10619
 
10620
  qp_regno = 0;
10621
  if (md.qp.X_op == O_register)
10622
    {
10623
      qp_regno = md.qp.X_add_number - REG_P;
10624
      md.qp.X_op = O_absent;
10625
    }
10626
 
10627
  flags = idesc->flags;
10628
 
10629
  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_FIRST) != 0)
10630
    {
10631
      /* The alignment frag has to end with a stop bit only if the
10632
         next instruction after the alignment directive has to be
10633
         the first instruction in an instruction group.  */
10634
      if (align_frag)
10635
        {
10636
          while (align_frag->fr_type != rs_align_code)
10637
            {
10638
              align_frag = align_frag->fr_next;
10639
              if (!align_frag)
10640
                break;
10641
            }
10642
          /* align_frag can be NULL if there are directives in
10643
             between.  */
10644
          if (align_frag && align_frag->fr_next == frag_now)
10645
            align_frag->tc_frag_data = 1;
10646
        }
10647
 
10648
      insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10649
    }
10650
  align_frag = NULL;
10651
 
10652
  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_NO_PRED) != 0 && qp_regno != 0)
10653
    {
10654
      as_bad (_("`%s' cannot be predicated"), idesc->name);
10655
      goto done;
10656
    }
10657
 
10658
  /* Build the instruction.  */
10659
  CURR_SLOT.qp_regno = qp_regno;
10660
  CURR_SLOT.idesc = idesc;
10661
  as_where (&CURR_SLOT.src_file, &CURR_SLOT.src_line);
10662
  dwarf2_where (&CURR_SLOT.debug_line);
10663
  dwarf2_consume_line_info ();
10664
 
10665
  /* Add unwind entries, if there are any.  */
10666
  if (unwind.current_entry)
10667
    {
10668
      CURR_SLOT.unwind_record = unwind.current_entry;
10669
      unwind.current_entry = NULL;
10670
    }
10671
  if (unwind.pending_saves)
10672
    {
10673
      if (unwind.pending_saves->next)
10674
        {
10675
          /* Attach the next pending save to the next slot so that its
10676
             slot number will get set correctly.  */
10677
          add_unwind_entry (unwind.pending_saves->next, NOT_A_CHAR);
10678
          unwind.pending_saves = &unwind.pending_saves->next->r.record.p;
10679
        }
10680
      else
10681
        unwind.pending_saves = NULL;
10682
    }
10683
  if (unwind.proc_pending.sym && S_IS_DEFINED (unwind.proc_pending.sym))
10684
    unwind.insn = 1;
10685
 
10686
  /* Check for dependency violations.  */
10687
  if (md.detect_dv)
10688
    check_dv (idesc);
10689
 
10690
  md.curr_slot = (md.curr_slot + 1) % NUM_SLOTS;
10691
  if (++md.num_slots_in_use >= NUM_SLOTS)
10692
    emit_one_bundle ();
10693
 
10694
  if ((flags & IA64_OPCODE_LAST) != 0)
10695
    insn_group_break (1, 0, 0);
10696
 
10697
  md.last_text_seg = now_seg;
10698
 
10699
 done:
10700
  input_line_pointer = saved_input_line_pointer;
10701
}
10702
 
10703
/* Called when symbol NAME cannot be found in the symbol table.
10704
   Should be used for dynamic valued symbols only.  */
10705
 
10706
symbolS *
10707
md_undefined_symbol (char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10708
{
10709
  return 0;
10710
}
10711
 
10712
/* Called for any expression that can not be recognized.  When the
10713
   function is called, `input_line_pointer' will point to the start of
10714
   the expression.  */
10715
 
10716
void
10717
md_operand (expressionS *e)
10718
{
10719
  switch (*input_line_pointer)
10720
    {
10721
    case '[':
10722
      ++input_line_pointer;
10723
      expression_and_evaluate (e);
10724
      if (*input_line_pointer != ']')
10725
        {
10726
          as_bad (_("Closing bracket missing"));
10727
          goto err;
10728
        }
10729
      else
10730
        {
10731
          if (e->X_op != O_register
10732
              || e->X_add_number < REG_GR
10733
              || e->X_add_number > REG_GR + 127)
10734
            {
10735
              as_bad (_("Index must be a general register"));
10736
              e->X_add_number = REG_GR;
10737
            }
10738
 
10739
          ++input_line_pointer;
10740
          e->X_op = O_index;
10741
        }
10742
      break;
10743
 
10744
    default:
10745
      break;
10746
    }
10747
  return;
10748
 
10749
 err:
10750
  ignore_rest_of_line ();
10751
}
10752
 
10753
/* Return 1 if it's OK to adjust a reloc by replacing the symbol with
10754
   a section symbol plus some offset.  For relocs involving @fptr(),
10755
   directives we don't want such adjustments since we need to have the
10756
   original symbol's name in the reloc.  */
10757
int
10758
ia64_fix_adjustable (fixS *fix)
10759
{
10760
  /* Prevent all adjustments to global symbols */
10761
  if (S_IS_EXTERNAL (fix->fx_addsy) || S_IS_WEAK (fix->fx_addsy))
10762
    return 0;
10763
 
10764
  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
10765
    {
10766
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
10767
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
10768
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB:
10769
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB:
10770
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
10771
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
10772
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
10773
      return 0;
10774
    default:
10775
      break;
10776
    }
10777
 
10778
  return 1;
10779
}
10780
 
10781
int
10782
ia64_force_relocation (fixS *fix)
10783
{
10784
  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
10785
    {
10786
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
10787
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
10788
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB:
10789
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB:
10790
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
10791
 
10792
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22:
10793
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF64I:
10794
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
10795
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
10796
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF22:
10797
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64I:
10798
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64MSB:
10799
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64LSB:
10800
 
10801
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22X:
10802
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LDXMOV:
10803
      return 1;
10804
 
10805
    default:
10806
      break;
10807
    }
10808
 
10809
  return generic_force_reloc (fix);
10810
}
10811
 
10812
/* Decide from what point a pc-relative relocation is relative to,
10813
   relative to the pc-relative fixup.  Er, relatively speaking.  */
10814
long
10815
ia64_pcrel_from_section (fixS *fix, segT sec)
10816
{
10817
  unsigned long off = fix->fx_frag->fr_address + fix->fx_where;
10818
 
10819
  if (bfd_get_section_flags (stdoutput, sec) & SEC_CODE)
10820
    off &= ~0xfUL;
10821
 
10822
  return off;
10823
}
10824
 
10825
 
10826
/* Used to emit section-relative relocs for the dwarf2 debug data.  */
10827
void
10828
ia64_dwarf2_emit_offset (symbolS *symbol, unsigned int size)
10829
{
10830
  expressionS exp;
10831
 
10832
  exp.X_op = O_pseudo_fixup;
10833
  exp.X_op_symbol = pseudo_func[FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE].u.sym;
10834
  exp.X_add_number = 0;
10835
  exp.X_add_symbol = symbol;
10836
  emit_expr (&exp, size);
10837
}
10838
 
10839
/* This is called whenever some data item (not an instruction) needs a
10840
   fixup.  We pick the right reloc code depending on the byteorder
10841
   currently in effect.  */
10842
void
10843
ia64_cons_fix_new (fragS *f, int where, int nbytes, expressionS *exp)
10844
{
10845
  bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
10846
  fixS *fix;
10847
 
10848
  switch (nbytes)
10849
    {
10850
      /* There are no reloc for 8 and 16 bit quantities, but we allow
10851
         them here since they will work fine as long as the expression
10852
         is fully defined at the end of the pass over the source file.  */
10853
    case 1: code = BFD_RELOC_8; break;
10854
    case 2: code = BFD_RELOC_16; break;
10855
    case 4:
10856
      if (target_big_endian)
10857
        code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB;
10858
      else
10859
        code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB;
10860
      break;
10861
 
10862
    case 8:
10863
      /* In 32-bit mode, data8 could mean function descriptors too.  */
10864
      if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
10865
          && exp->X_op_symbol
10866
          && S_GET_VALUE (exp->X_op_symbol) == FUNC_IPLT_RELOC
10867
          && !(md.flags & EF_IA_64_ABI64))
10868
        {
10869
          if (target_big_endian)
10870
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB;
10871
          else
10872
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB;
10873
          exp->X_op = O_symbol;
10874
          break;
10875
        }
10876
      else
10877
        {
10878
          if (target_big_endian)
10879
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB;
10880
          else
10881
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB;
10882
          break;
10883
        }
10884
 
10885
    case 16:
10886
      if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup
10887
          && exp->X_op_symbol
10888
          && S_GET_VALUE (exp->X_op_symbol) == FUNC_IPLT_RELOC)
10889
        {
10890
          if (target_big_endian)
10891
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB;
10892
          else
10893
            code = BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB;
10894
          exp->X_op = O_symbol;
10895
          break;
10896
        }
10897
      /* FALLTHRU */
10898
 
10899
    default:
10900
      as_bad (_("Unsupported fixup size %d"), nbytes);
10901
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
10902
      return;
10903
    }
10904
 
10905
  if (exp->X_op == O_pseudo_fixup)
10906
    {
10907
      exp->X_op = O_symbol;
10908
      code = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (exp->X_op_symbol, code);
10909
      /* ??? If code unchanged, unsupported.  */
10910
    }
10911
 
10912
  fix = fix_new_exp (f, where, nbytes, exp, 0, code);
10913
  /* We need to store the byte order in effect in case we're going
10914
     to fix an 8 or 16 bit relocation (for which there no real
10915
     relocs available).  See md_apply_fix().  */
10916
  fix->tc_fix_data.bigendian = target_big_endian;
10917
}
10918
 
10919
/* Return the actual relocation we wish to associate with the pseudo
10920
   reloc described by SYM and R_TYPE.  SYM should be one of the
10921
   symbols in the pseudo_func array, or NULL.  */
10922
 
10923
static bfd_reloc_code_real_type
10924
ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (struct symbol *sym, bfd_reloc_code_real_type r_type)
10925
{
10926
  bfd_reloc_code_real_type newr = 0;
10927
  const char *type = NULL, *suffix = "";
10928
 
10929
  if (sym == NULL)
10930
    {
10931
      return r_type;
10932
    }
10933
 
10934
  switch (S_GET_VALUE (sym))
10935
    {
10936
    case FUNC_FPTR_RELATIVE:
10937
      switch (r_type)
10938
        {
10939
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I; break;
10940
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB; break;
10941
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32LSB; break;
10942
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64MSB; break;
10943
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB; break;
10944
        default:                        type = "FPTR"; break;
10945
        }
10946
      break;
10947
 
10948
    case FUNC_GP_RELATIVE:
10949
      switch (r_type)
10950
        {
10951
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL22; break;
10952
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64I; break;
10953
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL32MSB; break;
10954
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL32LSB; break;
10955
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64MSB; break;
10956
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_GPREL64LSB; break;
10957
        default:                        type = "GPREL"; break;
10958
        }
10959
      break;
10960
 
10961
    case FUNC_LT_RELATIVE:
10962
      switch (r_type)
10963
        {
10964
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22; break;
10965
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF64I; break;
10966
        default:                        type = "LTOFF"; break;
10967
        }
10968
      break;
10969
 
10970
    case FUNC_LT_RELATIVE_X:
10971
      switch (r_type)
10972
        {
10973
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF22X; break;
10974
        default:                        type = "LTOFF"; suffix = "X"; break;
10975
        }
10976
      break;
10977
 
10978
    case FUNC_PC_RELATIVE:
10979
      switch (r_type)
10980
        {
10981
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL22; break;
10982
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64I; break;
10983
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32MSB; break;
10984
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32LSB; break;
10985
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64MSB; break;
10986
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64LSB; break;
10987
        default:                        type = "PCREL"; break;
10988
        }
10989
      break;
10990
 
10991
    case FUNC_PLT_RELATIVE:
10992
      switch (r_type)
10993
        {
10994
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF22; break;
10995
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64I; break;
10996
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64MSB;break;
10997
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_PLTOFF64LSB;break;
10998
        default:                        type = "PLTOFF"; break;
10999
        }
11000
      break;
11001
 
11002
    case FUNC_SEC_RELATIVE:
11003
      switch (r_type)
11004
        {
11005
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL32MSB;break;
11006
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL32LSB;break;
11007
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL64MSB;break;
11008
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SECREL64LSB;break;
11009
        default:                        type = "SECREL"; break;
11010
        }
11011
      break;
11012
 
11013
    case FUNC_SEG_RELATIVE:
11014
      switch (r_type)
11015
        {
11016
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL32MSB;break;
11017
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL32LSB;break;
11018
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL64MSB;break;
11019
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_SEGREL64LSB;break;
11020
        default:                        type = "SEGREL"; break;
11021
        }
11022
      break;
11023
 
11024
    case FUNC_LTV_RELATIVE:
11025
      switch (r_type)
11026
        {
11027
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV32MSB; break;
11028
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV32LSB; break;
11029
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV64MSB; break;
11030
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTV64LSB; break;
11031
        default:                        type = "LTV"; break;
11032
        }
11033
      break;
11034
 
11035
    case FUNC_LT_FPTR_RELATIVE:
11036
      switch (r_type)
11037
        {
11038
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11039
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22; break;
11040
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:
11041
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I; break;
11042
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:
11043
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32MSB; break;
11044
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:
11045
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR32LSB; break;
11046
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11047
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64MSB; break;
11048
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11049
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64LSB; break;
11050
        default:
11051
          type = "LTOFF_FPTR"; break;
11052
        }
11053
      break;
11054
 
11055
    case FUNC_TP_RELATIVE:
11056
      switch (r_type)
11057
        {
11058
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL14; break;
11059
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL22; break;
11060
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:      newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64I; break;
11061
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64MSB; break;
11062
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:   newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64LSB; break;
11063
        default:                        type = "TPREL"; break;
11064
        }
11065
      break;
11066
 
11067
    case FUNC_LT_TP_RELATIVE:
11068
      switch (r_type)
11069
        {
11070
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11071
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_TPREL22; break;
11072
        default:
11073
          type = "LTOFF_TPREL"; break;
11074
        }
11075
      break;
11076
 
11077
    case FUNC_DTP_MODULE:
11078
      switch (r_type)
11079
        {
11080
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11081
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPMOD64MSB; break;
11082
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11083
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPMOD64LSB; break;
11084
        default:
11085
          type = "DTPMOD"; break;
11086
        }
11087
      break;
11088
 
11089
    case FUNC_LT_DTP_MODULE:
11090
      switch (r_type)
11091
        {
11092
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11093
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPMOD22; break;
11094
        default:
11095
          type = "LTOFF_DTPMOD"; break;
11096
        }
11097
      break;
11098
 
11099
    case FUNC_DTP_RELATIVE:
11100
      switch (r_type)
11101
        {
11102
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB:
11103
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL32MSB; break;
11104
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB:
11105
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL32LSB; break;
11106
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB:
11107
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64MSB; break;
11108
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB:
11109
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64LSB; break;
11110
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:
11111
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL14; break;
11112
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11113
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL22; break;
11114
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:
11115
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64I; break;
11116
        default:
11117
          type = "DTPREL"; break;
11118
        }
11119
      break;
11120
 
11121
    case FUNC_LT_DTP_RELATIVE:
11122
      switch (r_type)
11123
        {
11124
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:
11125
          newr = BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPREL22; break;
11126
        default:
11127
          type = "LTOFF_DTPREL"; break;
11128
        }
11129
      break;
11130
 
11131
    case FUNC_IPLT_RELOC:
11132
      switch (r_type)
11133
        {
11134
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTMSB:    return r_type;
11135
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IPLTLSB:    return r_type;
11136
        default:                        type = "IPLT"; break;
11137
        }
11138
      break;
11139
 
11140
#ifdef TE_VMS
11141
    case FUNC_SLOTCOUNT_RELOC:
11142
      return DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT;
11143
#endif
11144
 
11145
    default:
11146
      abort ();
11147
    }
11148
 
11149
  if (newr)
11150
    return newr;
11151
  else
11152
    {
11153
      int width;
11154
 
11155
      if (!type)
11156
        abort ();
11157
      switch (r_type)
11158
        {
11159
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32MSB: width = 32; suffix = "MSB"; break;
11160
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR32LSB: width = 32; suffix = "LSB"; break;
11161
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64MSB: width = 64; suffix = "MSB"; break;
11162
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DIR64LSB: width = 64; suffix = "LSB"; break;
11163
        case BFD_RELOC_UNUSED:        width = 13; break;
11164
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM14:    width = 14; break;
11165
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM22:    width = 22; break;
11166
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_IMM64:    width = 64; suffix = "I"; break;
11167
        default:                      abort ();
11168
        }
11169
 
11170
      /* This should be an error, but since previously there wasn't any
11171
         diagnostic here, don't make it fail because of this for now.  */
11172
      as_warn (_("Cannot express %s%d%s relocation"), type, width, suffix);
11173
      return r_type;
11174
    }
11175
}
11176
 
11177
/* Here is where generate the appropriate reloc for pseudo relocation
11178
   functions.  */
11179
void
11180
ia64_validate_fix (fixS *fix)
11181
{
11182
  switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11183
    {
11184
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64I:
11185
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR32MSB:
11186
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_FPTR64LSB:
11187
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR22:
11188
    case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_FPTR64I:
11189
      if (fix->fx_offset != 0)
11190
        as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11191
                      _("No addend allowed in @fptr() relocation"));
11192
      break;
11193
    default:
11194
      break;
11195
    }
11196
}
11197
 
11198
static void
11199
fix_insn (fixS *fix, const struct ia64_operand *odesc, valueT value)
11200
{
11201
  bfd_vma insn[3], t0, t1, control_bits;
11202
  const char *err;
11203
  char *fixpos;
11204
  long slot;
11205
 
11206
  slot = fix->fx_where & 0x3;
11207
  fixpos = fix->fx_frag->fr_literal + (fix->fx_where - slot);
11208
 
11209
  /* Bundles are always in little-endian byte order */
11210
  t0 = bfd_getl64 (fixpos);
11211
  t1 = bfd_getl64 (fixpos + 8);
11212
  control_bits = t0 & 0x1f;
11213
  insn[0] = (t0 >>  5) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11214
  insn[1] = ((t0 >> 46) & 0x3ffff) | ((t1 & 0x7fffff) << 18);
11215
  insn[2] = (t1 >> 23) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11216
 
11217
  err = NULL;
11218
  if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_IMMU64)
11219
    {
11220
      insn[1] = (value >> 22) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11221
      insn[2] |= (((value & 0x7f) << 13)
11222
                  | (((value >> 7) & 0x1ff) << 27)
11223
                  | (((value >> 16) & 0x1f) << 22)
11224
                  | (((value >> 21) & 0x1) << 21)
11225
                  | (((value >> 63) & 0x1) << 36));
11226
    }
11227
  else if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_IMMU62)
11228
    {
11229
      if (value & ~0x3fffffffffffffffULL)
11230
        err = _("integer operand out of range");
11231
      insn[1] = (value >> 21) & 0x1ffffffffffLL;
11232
      insn[2] |= (((value & 0xfffff) << 6) | (((value >> 20) & 0x1) << 36));
11233
    }
11234
  else if (odesc - elf64_ia64_operands == IA64_OPND_TGT64)
11235
    {
11236
      value >>= 4;
11237
      insn[1] = ((value >> 20) & 0x7fffffffffLL) << 2;
11238
      insn[2] |= ((((value >> 59) & 0x1) << 36)
11239
                  | (((value >> 0) & 0xfffff) << 13));
11240
    }
11241
  else
11242
    err = (*odesc->insert) (odesc, value, insn + slot);
11243
 
11244
  if (err)
11245
    as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line, "%s", err);
11246
 
11247
  t0 = control_bits | (insn[0] << 5) | (insn[1] << 46);
11248
  t1 = ((insn[1] >> 18) & 0x7fffff) | (insn[2] << 23);
11249
  number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos + 0, t0, 8);
11250
  number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos + 8, t1, 8);
11251
}
11252
 
11253
/* Attempt to simplify or even eliminate a fixup.  The return value is
11254
   ignored; perhaps it was once meaningful, but now it is historical.
11255
   To indicate that a fixup has been eliminated, set FIXP->FX_DONE.
11256
 
11257
   If fixp->fx_addsy is non-NULL, we'll have to generate a reloc entry
11258
   (if possible).  */
11259
 
11260
void
11261
md_apply_fix (fixS *fix, valueT *valP, segT seg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11262
{
11263
  char *fixpos;
11264
  valueT value = *valP;
11265
 
11266
  fixpos = fix->fx_frag->fr_literal + fix->fx_where;
11267
 
11268
  if (fix->fx_pcrel)
11269
    {
11270
    switch (fix->fx_r_type)
11271
      {
11272
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21B: break;
11273
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21BI: break;
11274
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21F: break;
11275
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL21M: break;
11276
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL60B: break;
11277
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL22: break;
11278
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64I: break;
11279
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32MSB: break;
11280
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL32LSB: break;
11281
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64MSB: break;
11282
      case BFD_RELOC_IA64_PCREL64LSB: break;
11283
      default:
11284
        fix->fx_r_type = ia64_gen_real_reloc_type (pseudo_func[FUNC_PC_RELATIVE].u.sym,
11285
                                               fix->fx_r_type);
11286
        break;
11287
      }
11288
    }
11289
  if (fix->fx_addsy)
11290
    {
11291
      switch ((unsigned) fix->fx_r_type)
11292
        {
11293
        case BFD_RELOC_UNUSED:
11294
          /* This must be a TAG13 or TAG13b operand.  There are no external
11295
             relocs defined for them, so we must give an error.  */
11296
          as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11297
                        _("%s must have a constant value"),
11298
                        elf64_ia64_operands[fix->tc_fix_data.opnd].desc);
11299
          fix->fx_done = 1;
11300
          return;
11301
 
11302
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL14:
11303
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL22:
11304
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_TPREL64I:
11305
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_TPREL22:
11306
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPMOD22:
11307
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL14:
11308
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL22:
11309
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_DTPREL64I:
11310
        case BFD_RELOC_IA64_LTOFF_DTPREL22:
11311
          S_SET_THREAD_LOCAL (fix->fx_addsy);
11312
          break;
11313
 
11314
#ifdef TE_VMS
11315
        case DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT:
11316
          as_bad_where (fix->fx_file, fix->fx_line,
11317
                        _("cannot resolve @slotcount parameter"));
11318
          fix->fx_done = 1;
11319
          return;
11320
#endif
11321
 
11322
        default:
11323
          break;
11324
        }
11325
    }
11326
  else if (fix->tc_fix_data.opnd == IA64_OPND_NIL)
11327
    {
11328
#ifdef TE_VMS
11329
      if (fix->fx_r_type == DUMMY_RELOC_IA64_SLOTCOUNT)
11330
        {
11331
          /* For @slotcount, convert an addresses difference to a slots
11332
             difference.  */
11333
          valueT v;
11334
 
11335
          v = (value >> 4) * 3;
11336
          switch (value & 0x0f)
11337
            {
11338
            case 0:
11339
            case 1:
11340
            case 2:
11341
              v += value & 0x0f;
11342
              break;
11343
            case 0x0f:
11344
              v += 2;
11345
              break;
11346
            case 0x0e:
11347
              v += 1;
11348
              break;
11349
            default:
11350
              as_bad (_("invalid @slotcount value"));
11351
            }
11352
          value = v;
11353
        }
11354
#endif
11355
 
11356
      if (fix->tc_fix_data.bigendian)
11357
        number_to_chars_bigendian (fixpos, value, fix->fx_size);
11358
      else
11359
        number_to_chars_littleendian (fixpos, value, fix->fx_size);
11360
      fix->fx_done = 1;
11361
    }
11362
  else
11363
    {
11364
      fix_insn (fix, elf64_ia64_operands + fix->tc_fix_data.opnd, value);
11365
      fix->fx_done = 1;
11366
    }
11367
}
11368
 
11369
/* Generate the BFD reloc to be stuck in the object file from the
11370
   fixup used internally in the assembler.  */
11371
 
11372
arelent *
11373
tc_gen_reloc (asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, fixS *fixp)
11374
{
11375
  arelent *reloc;
11376
 
11377
  reloc = xmalloc (sizeof (*reloc));
11378
  reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = (asymbol **) xmalloc (sizeof (asymbol *));
11379
  *reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = symbol_get_bfdsym (fixp->fx_addsy);
11380
  reloc->address = fixp->fx_frag->fr_address + fixp->fx_where;
11381
  reloc->addend = fixp->fx_offset;
11382
  reloc->howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (stdoutput, fixp->fx_r_type);
11383
 
11384
  if (!reloc->howto)
11385
    {
11386
      as_bad_where (fixp->fx_file, fixp->fx_line,
11387
                    _("Cannot represent %s relocation in object file"),
11388
                    bfd_get_reloc_code_name (fixp->fx_r_type));
11389
      free (reloc);
11390
      return NULL;
11391
    }
11392
  return reloc;
11393
}
11394
 
11395
/* Turn a string in input_line_pointer into a floating point constant
11396
   of type TYPE, and store the appropriate bytes in *LIT.  The number
11397
   of LITTLENUMS emitted is stored in *SIZE.  An error message is
11398
   returned, or NULL on OK.  */
11399
 
11400
#define MAX_LITTLENUMS 5
11401
 
11402
char *
11403
md_atof (int type, char *lit, int *size)
11404
{
11405
  LITTLENUM_TYPE words[MAX_LITTLENUMS];
11406
  char *t;
11407
  int prec;
11408
 
11409
  switch (type)
11410
    {
11411
      /* IEEE floats */
11412
    case 'f':
11413
    case 'F':
11414
    case 's':
11415
    case 'S':
11416
      prec = 2;
11417
      break;
11418
 
11419
    case 'd':
11420
    case 'D':
11421
    case 'r':
11422
    case 'R':
11423
      prec = 4;
11424
      break;
11425
 
11426
    case 'x':
11427
    case 'X':
11428
    case 'p':
11429
    case 'P':
11430
      prec = 5;
11431
      break;
11432
 
11433
    default:
11434
      *size = 0;
11435
      return _("Unrecognized or unsupported floating point constant");
11436
    }
11437
  t = atof_ieee (input_line_pointer, type, words);
11438
  if (t)
11439
    input_line_pointer = t;
11440
 
11441
  (*ia64_float_to_chars) (lit, words, prec);
11442
 
11443
  if (type == 'X')
11444
    {
11445
      /* It is 10 byte floating point with 6 byte padding.  */
11446
      memset (&lit [10], 0, 6);
11447
      *size = 8 * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11448
    }
11449
  else
11450
    *size = prec * sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11451
 
11452
  return NULL;
11453
}
11454
 
11455
/* Handle ia64 specific semantics of the align directive.  */
11456
 
11457
void
11458
ia64_md_do_align (int n ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11459
                  const char *fill ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11460
                  int len ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11461
                  int max ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11462
{
11463
  if (subseg_text_p (now_seg))
11464
    ia64_flush_insns ();
11465
}
11466
 
11467
/* This is called from HANDLE_ALIGN in write.c.  Fill in the contents
11468
   of an rs_align_code fragment.  */
11469
 
11470
void
11471
ia64_handle_align (fragS *fragp)
11472
{
11473
  int bytes;
11474
  char *p;
11475
  const unsigned char *nop_type;
11476
 
11477
  if (fragp->fr_type != rs_align_code)
11478
    return;
11479
 
11480
  /* Check if this frag has to end with a stop bit.  */
11481
  nop_type = fragp->tc_frag_data ? le_nop_stop : le_nop;
11482
 
11483
  bytes = fragp->fr_next->fr_address - fragp->fr_address - fragp->fr_fix;
11484
  p = fragp->fr_literal + fragp->fr_fix;
11485
 
11486
  /* If no paddings are needed, we check if we need a stop bit.  */
11487
  if (!bytes && fragp->tc_frag_data)
11488
    {
11489
      if (fragp->fr_fix < 16)
11490
#if 1
11491
        /* FIXME: It won't work with
11492
           .align 16
11493
           alloc r32=ar.pfs,1,2,4,0
11494
         */
11495
        ;
11496
#else
11497
        as_bad_where (fragp->fr_file, fragp->fr_line,
11498
                      _("Can't add stop bit to mark end of instruction group"));
11499
#endif
11500
      else
11501
        /* Bundles are always in little-endian byte order. Make sure
11502
           the previous bundle has the stop bit.  */
11503
        *(p - 16) |= 1;
11504
    }
11505
 
11506
  /* Make sure we are on a 16-byte boundary, in case someone has been
11507
     putting data into a text section.  */
11508
  if (bytes & 15)
11509
    {
11510
      int fix = bytes & 15;
11511
      memset (p, 0, fix);
11512
      p += fix;
11513
      bytes -= fix;
11514
      fragp->fr_fix += fix;
11515
    }
11516
 
11517
  /* Instruction bundles are always little-endian.  */
11518
  memcpy (p, nop_type, 16);
11519
  fragp->fr_var = 16;
11520
}
11521
 
11522
static void
11523
ia64_float_to_chars_bigendian (char *lit, LITTLENUM_TYPE *words,
11524
                               int prec)
11525
{
11526
  while (prec--)
11527
    {
11528
      number_to_chars_bigendian (lit, (long) (*words++),
11529
                                 sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
11530
      lit += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11531
    }
11532
}
11533
 
11534
static void
11535
ia64_float_to_chars_littleendian (char *lit, LITTLENUM_TYPE *words,
11536
                                  int prec)
11537
{
11538
  while (prec--)
11539
    {
11540
      number_to_chars_littleendian (lit, (long) (words[prec]),
11541
                                    sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE));
11542
      lit += sizeof (LITTLENUM_TYPE);
11543
    }
11544
}
11545
 
11546
void
11547
ia64_elf_section_change_hook (void)
11548
{
11549
  if (elf_section_type (now_seg) == SHT_IA_64_UNWIND
11550
      && elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) == NULL)
11551
    elf_linked_to_section (now_seg) = text_section;
11552
  dot_byteorder (-1);
11553
}
11554
 
11555
/* Check if a label should be made global.  */
11556
void
11557
ia64_check_label (symbolS *label)
11558
{
11559
  if (*input_line_pointer == ':')
11560
    {
11561
      S_SET_EXTERNAL (label);
11562
      input_line_pointer++;
11563
    }
11564
}
11565
 
11566
/* Used to remember where .alias and .secalias directives are seen. We
11567
   will rename symbol and section names when we are about to output
11568
   the relocatable file.  */
11569
struct alias
11570
{
11571
  char *file;           /* The file where the directive is seen.  */
11572
  unsigned int line;    /* The line number the directive is at.  */
11573
  const char *name;     /* The original name of the symbol.  */
11574
};
11575
 
11576
/* Called for .alias and .secalias directives. If SECTION is 1, it is
11577
   .secalias. Otherwise, it is .alias.  */
11578
static void
11579
dot_alias (int section)
11580
{
11581
  char *name, *alias;
11582
  char delim;
11583
  char *end_name;
11584
  int len;
11585
  const char *error_string;
11586
  struct alias *h;
11587
  const char *a;
11588
  struct hash_control *ahash, *nhash;
11589
  const char *kind;
11590
 
11591
  name = input_line_pointer;
11592
  delim = get_symbol_end ();
11593
  end_name = input_line_pointer;
11594
  *end_name = delim;
11595
 
11596
  if (name == end_name)
11597
    {
11598
      as_bad (_("expected symbol name"));
11599
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11600
      return;
11601
    }
11602
 
11603
  SKIP_WHITESPACE ();
11604
 
11605
  if (*input_line_pointer != ',')
11606
    {
11607
      *end_name = 0;
11608
      as_bad (_("expected comma after \"%s\""), name);
11609
      *end_name = delim;
11610
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11611
      return;
11612
    }
11613
 
11614
  input_line_pointer++;
11615
  *end_name = 0;
11616
  ia64_canonicalize_symbol_name (name);
11617
 
11618
  /* We call demand_copy_C_string to check if alias string is valid.
11619
     There should be a closing `"' and no `\0' in the string.  */
11620
  alias = demand_copy_C_string (&len);
11621
  if (alias == NULL)
11622
    {
11623
      ignore_rest_of_line ();
11624
      return;
11625
    }
11626
 
11627
  /* Make a copy of name string.  */
11628
  len = strlen (name) + 1;
11629
  obstack_grow (&notes, name, len);
11630
  name = obstack_finish (&notes);
11631
 
11632
  if (section)
11633
    {
11634
      kind = "section";
11635
      ahash = secalias_hash;
11636
      nhash = secalias_name_hash;
11637
    }
11638
  else
11639
    {
11640
      kind = "symbol";
11641
      ahash = alias_hash;
11642
      nhash = alias_name_hash;
11643
    }
11644
 
11645
  /* Check if alias has been used before.  */
11646
  h = (struct alias *) hash_find (ahash, alias);
11647
  if (h)
11648
    {
11649
      if (strcmp (h->name, name))
11650
        as_bad (_("`%s' is already the alias of %s `%s'"),
11651
                alias, kind, h->name);
11652
      goto out;
11653
    }
11654
 
11655
  /* Check if name already has an alias.  */
11656
  a = (const char *) hash_find (nhash, name);
11657
  if (a)
11658
    {
11659
      if (strcmp (a, alias))
11660
        as_bad (_("%s `%s' already has an alias `%s'"), kind, name, a);
11661
      goto out;
11662
    }
11663
 
11664
  h = (struct alias *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct alias));
11665
  as_where (&h->file, &h->line);
11666
  h->name = name;
11667
 
11668
  error_string = hash_jam (ahash, alias, (void *) h);
11669
  if (error_string)
11670
    {
11671
      as_fatal (_("inserting \"%s\" into %s alias hash table failed: %s"),
11672
                alias, kind, error_string);
11673
      goto out;
11674
    }
11675
 
11676
  error_string = hash_jam (nhash, name, (void *) alias);
11677
  if (error_string)
11678
    {
11679
      as_fatal (_("inserting \"%s\" into %s name hash table failed: %s"),
11680
                alias, kind, error_string);
11681
out:
11682
      obstack_free (&notes, name);
11683
      obstack_free (&notes, alias);
11684
    }
11685
 
11686
  demand_empty_rest_of_line ();
11687
}
11688
 
11689
/* It renames the original symbol name to its alias.  */
11690
static void
11691
do_alias (const char *alias, void *value)
11692
{
11693
  struct alias *h = (struct alias *) value;
11694
  symbolS *sym = symbol_find (h->name);
11695
 
11696
  if (sym == NULL)
11697
    {
11698
#ifdef TE_VMS
11699
      /* Uses .alias extensively to alias CRTL functions to same with
11700
         decc$ prefix. Sometimes function gets optimized away and a
11701
         warning results, which should be suppressed.  */
11702
      if (strncmp (alias, "decc$", 5) != 0)
11703
#endif
11704
        as_warn_where (h->file, h->line,
11705
                       _("symbol `%s' aliased to `%s' is not used"),
11706
                       h->name, alias);
11707
    }
11708
    else
11709
      S_SET_NAME (sym, (char *) alias);
11710
}
11711
 
11712
/* Called from write_object_file.  */
11713
void
11714
ia64_adjust_symtab (void)
11715
{
11716
  hash_traverse (alias_hash, do_alias);
11717
}
11718
 
11719
/* It renames the original section name to its alias.  */
11720
static void
11721
do_secalias (const char *alias, void *value)
11722
{
11723
  struct alias *h = (struct alias *) value;
11724
  segT sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (stdoutput, h->name);
11725
 
11726
  if (sec == NULL)
11727
    as_warn_where (h->file, h->line,
11728
                   _("section `%s' aliased to `%s' is not used"),
11729
                   h->name, alias);
11730
  else
11731
    sec->name = alias;
11732
}
11733
 
11734
/* Called from write_object_file.  */
11735
void
11736
ia64_frob_file (void)
11737
{
11738
  hash_traverse (secalias_hash, do_secalias);
11739
}
11740
 
11741
#ifdef TE_VMS
11742
#define NT_VMS_MHD 1
11743
#define NT_VMS_LNM 2
11744
 
11745
/* Integrity VMS 8.x identifies it's ELF modules with a standard ELF
11746
   .note section.  */
11747
 
11748
/* Manufacture a VMS-like time string.  */
11749
static void
11750
get_vms_time (char *Now)
11751
{
11752
  char *pnt;
11753
  time_t timeb;
11754
 
11755
  time (&timeb);
11756
  pnt = ctime (&timeb);
11757
  pnt[3] = 0;
11758
  pnt[7] = 0;
11759
  pnt[10] = 0;
11760
  pnt[16] = 0;
11761
  pnt[24] = 0;
11762
  sprintf (Now, "%2s-%3s-%s %s", pnt + 8, pnt + 4, pnt + 20, pnt + 11);
11763
}
11764
 
11765
void
11766
ia64_vms_note (void)
11767
{
11768
  char *p;
11769
  asection *seg = now_seg;
11770
  subsegT subseg = now_subseg;
11771
  asection *secp = NULL;
11772
  char *bname;
11773
  char buf [256];
11774
  symbolS *sym;
11775
 
11776
  /* Create the .note section.  */
11777
 
11778
  secp = subseg_new (".note", 0);
11779
  bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput,
11780
                         secp,
11781
                         SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
11782
 
11783
  /* Module header note (MHD).  */
11784
  bname = xstrdup (lbasename (out_file_name));
11785
  if ((p = strrchr (bname, '.')))
11786
    *p = '\0';
11787
 
11788
  /* VMS note header is 24 bytes long.  */
11789
  p = frag_more (8 + 8 + 8);
11790
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 0, 8, 8);
11791
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 8, 40 + strlen (bname), 8);
11792
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 16, NT_VMS_MHD, 8);
11793
 
11794
  p = frag_more (8);
11795
  strcpy (p, "IPF/VMS");
11796
 
11797
  p = frag_more (17 + 17 + strlen (bname) + 1 + 5);
11798
  get_vms_time (p);
11799
  strcpy (p + 17, "24-FEB-2005 15:00");
11800
  p += 17 + 17;
11801
  strcpy (p, bname);
11802
  p += strlen (bname) + 1;
11803
  free (bname);
11804
  strcpy (p, "V1.0");
11805
 
11806
  frag_align (3, 0, 0);
11807
 
11808
  /* Language processor name note.  */
11809
  sprintf (buf, "GNU assembler version %s (%s) using BFD version %s",
11810
           VERSION, TARGET_ALIAS, BFD_VERSION_STRING);
11811
 
11812
  p = frag_more (8 + 8 + 8);
11813
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 0, 8, 8);
11814
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 8, strlen (buf) + 1, 8);
11815
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p + 16, NT_VMS_LNM, 8);
11816
 
11817
  p = frag_more (8);
11818
  strcpy (p, "IPF/VMS");
11819
 
11820
  p = frag_more (strlen (buf) + 1);
11821
  strcpy (p, buf);
11822
 
11823
  frag_align (3, 0, 0);
11824
 
11825
  secp = subseg_new (".vms_display_name_info", 0);
11826
  bfd_set_section_flags (stdoutput,
11827
                         secp,
11828
                         SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
11829
 
11830
  /* This symbol should be passed on the command line and be variable
11831
     according to language.  */
11832
  sym = symbol_new ("__gnat_vms_display_name@gnat_demangler_rtl",
11833
                    absolute_section, 0, &zero_address_frag);
11834
  symbol_table_insert (sym);
11835
  symbol_get_bfdsym (sym)->flags |= BSF_DEBUGGING | BSF_DYNAMIC;
11836
 
11837
  p = frag_more (4);
11838
  /* Format 3 of VMS demangler Spec.  */
11839
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p, 3, 4);
11840
 
11841
  p = frag_more (4);
11842
  /* Place holder for symbol table index of above symbol.  */
11843
  number_to_chars_littleendian (p, -1, 4);
11844
 
11845
  frag_align (3, 0, 0);
11846
 
11847
  /* We probably can't restore the current segment, for there likely
11848
     isn't one yet...  */
11849
  if (seg && subseg)
11850
    subseg_set (seg, subseg);
11851
}
11852
 
11853
#endif /* TE_VMS */

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.